2009-01-23 Pedro Alves <pedro@codesourcery.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @copying
47 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
48 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
49 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
50
51 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
52 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
53 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
54 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
55 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
56 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
57
58 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
59 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
60 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
61 @end copying
62
63 @ifnottex
64 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
65
66 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
67 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
68 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
69 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
70 @end ifset
71 Version @value{GDBVN}.
72
73 @insertcopying
74 @end ifnottex
75
76 @titlepage
77 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
79 @sp 1
80 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
82 @sp 1
83 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
84 @end ifset
85 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
86 @page
87 @tex
88 {\parskip=0pt
89 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
90 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
91 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
92 }
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
97 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
98 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
99 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
100
101 @insertcopying
102 @page
103 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
104 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
105 software in general. We will miss him.
106 @end titlepage
107 @page
108
109 @ifnottex
110 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
111
112 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
113
114 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
115
116 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
117 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
118 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
119 @end ifset
120 Version @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
137 * Stack:: Examining the stack
138 * Source:: Examining source files
139 * Data:: Examining data
140 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
141 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
142 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
143
144 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
145
146 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
147 * Altering:: Altering execution
148 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
149 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
150 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
151 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
152 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
153 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
154 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
155 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
156 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
157 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
158 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
159
160 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
161
162 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
163 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
164 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
165 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
166 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
167 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
168 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
169 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
170 @value{GDBN}
171 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
172 the operating system
173 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
174 how you can copy and share GDB
175 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
176 * Index:: Index
177 @end menu
178
179 @end ifnottex
180
181 @contents
182
183 @node Summary
184 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
185
186 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
187 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
188 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
189
190 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
191 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
192
193 @itemize @bullet
194 @item
195 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
196
197 @item
198 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
199
200 @item
201 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
202
203 @item
204 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
205 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
206 @end itemize
207
208 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
209 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
210 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
211
212 @cindex Modula-2
213 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
214 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
215
216 @cindex Pascal
217 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
218 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
219 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
220 syntax.
221
222 @cindex Fortran
223 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
224 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
225 underscore.
226
227 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
228 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
229
230 @menu
231 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
232 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
233 @end menu
234
235 @node Free Software
236 @unnumberedsec Free Software
237
238 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
239 General Public License
240 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
241 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
242 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
243 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
244 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
245 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
246
247 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
248 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
249 from anyone else.
250
251 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
252
253 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
254 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
255 include with the free software. Many of our most important
256 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
257 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
258 when an important free software package does not come with a free
259 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
260 gaps today.
261
262 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
263 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
264 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
265 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
266 them from the free software world.
267
268 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
269 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
270 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
271 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
272 contract to make it non-free.
273
274 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
275 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
276 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
277 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
278 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
279 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
280 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
281
282 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
283 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
284 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
285 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
286
287 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
288 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
289 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
290 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
291 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
292 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
293 community.
294
295 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
296 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
297 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
298 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
299 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
300 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
301 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
302 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
303 of the manual.
304
305 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
306 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
307 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
308 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
309 manual to replace it.
310
311 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
312 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
313 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
314 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
315 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
316 the free software community.
317
318 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
319 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
320 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
321 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
322 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
323 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
324 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
325 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
326 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
327
328 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
329 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
330 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
331 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
332 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
333 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
334 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
335 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
336
337 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
338 published by other publishers, at
339 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
340
341 @node Contributors
342 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
343
344 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
345 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
346 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
347 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
348 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
349 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
350 blow-by-blow account.
351
352 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
353
354 @quotation
355 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
356 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
357 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
358 @end quotation
359
360 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
361 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
362 releases:
363 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
364 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
365 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
366 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
367 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
368 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
369 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
370 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
371 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
372
373 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
374 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
375
376 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
377 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
378 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
379 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
380 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
381
382 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
383 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
384 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
385
386 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
387 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
388
389 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
390
391 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
392 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
393 support.
394 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
395 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
396 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
397 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
398 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
399 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
400 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
401 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
402 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
403 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
404 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
405 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
406 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
407 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
408 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
409 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
410
411 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
412
413 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
414 libraries.
415
416 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
417 about several machine instruction sets.
418
419 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
420 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
421 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
422 and RDI targets, respectively.
423
424 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
425 command-line editing and command history.
426
427 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
428 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
429
430 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
431 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
432 symbols.
433
434 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
435 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
436
437 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
438
439 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
440 processors.
441
442 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
443
444 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
445
446 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
447
448 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
449 watchpoints.
450
451 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
452
453 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
454
455 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
456 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
457
458 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
459 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
460 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
461 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
462 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
463 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
464 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
465
466 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
467 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
468
469 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
470 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
471 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
472 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
473 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
474 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
475 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
476 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
477 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
478 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
479 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
480 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
481 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
482 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
483 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
484
485 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
486 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
487
488 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
489 Hat.
490
491 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
492 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
493 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
494 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
495 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
496 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
497
498 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
499 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
500 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
501 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
502 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
503 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
504 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
505 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
506 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
507 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
508 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
509 Weigand.
510
511 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
512 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
513 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
514 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
515
516 @node Sample Session
517 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
518
519 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
520 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
521 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
522
523 @iftex
524 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
525 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
526 @end iftex
527
528 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
529 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
530
531 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
532 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
533 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
534 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
535 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
536 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
537 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
538 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
539 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
540
541 @smallexample
542 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
543 $ @b{./m4}
544 @b{define(foo,0000)}
545
546 @b{foo}
547 0000
548 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
549
550 @b{bar}
551 0000
552 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
553
554 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
555 @b{baz}
556 @b{Ctrl-d}
557 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
558 @end smallexample
559
560 @noindent
561 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
562
563 @smallexample
564 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
565 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
566 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
567 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
568 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
569 the conditions.
570 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
571 for details.
572
573 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
574 (@value{GDBP})
575 @end smallexample
576
577 @noindent
578 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
579 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
580 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
581 that examples fit in this manual.
582
583 @smallexample
584 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
585 @end smallexample
586
587 @noindent
588 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
589 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
590 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
591 @code{break} command.
592
593 @smallexample
594 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
595 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
600 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
601 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
602
603 @smallexample
604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
605 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
606 @b{define(foo,0000)}
607
608 @b{foo}
609 0000
610 @end smallexample
611
612 @noindent
613 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
614 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
615 context where it stops.
616
617 @smallexample
618 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
619
620 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
621 at builtin.c:879
622 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
627 the next line of the current function.
628
629 @smallexample
630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
632 : nil,
633 @end smallexample
634
635 @noindent
636 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
637 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
638 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
639 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
643 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
644 at input.c:530
645 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
646 @end smallexample
647
648 @noindent
649 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
650 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
651 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
652 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
653 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
654 stack frame for each active subroutine.
655
656 @smallexample
657 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
658 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
659 at input.c:530
660 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
661 at builtin.c:882
662 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
663 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
664 at macro.c:71
665 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
666 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
671 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
672 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
678 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
679 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
682 : xstrdup(rq);
683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
684 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
685 @end smallexample
686
687 @noindent
688 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
689 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
690 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
691 (@code{print}) to see their values.
692
693 @smallexample
694 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
695 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
697 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
698 @end smallexample
699
700 @noindent
701 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
702 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
703 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
704
705 @smallexample
706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
707 533 xfree(rquote);
708 534
709 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
710 : xstrdup (lq);
711 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
712 : xstrdup (rq);
713 537
714 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
715 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
716 540 @}
717 541
718 542 void
719 @end smallexample
720
721 @noindent
722 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
723 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
724
725 @smallexample
726 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
727 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
728 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
729 540 @}
730 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
731 $3 = 9
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
733 $4 = 7
734 @end smallexample
735
736 @noindent
737 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
738 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
739 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
740 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
741 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
742 assignments.
743
744 @smallexample
745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
746 $5 = 7
747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
748 $6 = 9
749 @end smallexample
750
751 @noindent
752 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
753 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
754 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
755 example that caused trouble initially:
756
757 @smallexample
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
759 Continuing.
760
761 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
762
763 baz
764 0000
765 @end smallexample
766
767 @noindent
768 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
769 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
770 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
771
772 @smallexample
773 @b{Ctrl-d}
774 Program exited normally.
775 @end smallexample
776
777 @noindent
778 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
779 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
780 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
784 @end smallexample
785
786 @node Invocation
787 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
788
789 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
790 The essentials are:
791 @itemize @bullet
792 @item
793 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
794 @item
795 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
796 @end itemize
797
798 @menu
799 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
800 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
801 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
802 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
803 @end menu
804
805 @node Invoking GDB
806 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
807
808 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
809 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
810
811 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
812 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
813
814 The command-line options described here are designed
815 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
816 options may effectively be unavailable.
817
818 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
819 specifying an executable program:
820
821 @smallexample
822 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
823 @end smallexample
824
825 @noindent
826 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
827 specified:
828
829 @smallexample
830 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
831 @end smallexample
832
833 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
834 to debug a running process:
835
836 @smallexample
837 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
838 @end smallexample
839
840 @noindent
841 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
842 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
843
844 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
845 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
846 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
847 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
848 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
849
850 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
851 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
852 option processing.
853 @smallexample
854 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
855 @end smallexample
856 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
857 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
858
859 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
860 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} -silent
864 @end smallexample
865
866 @noindent
867 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
868 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
869
870 @noindent
871 Type
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} -help
875 @end smallexample
876
877 @noindent
878 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
879 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
880
881 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
882 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
883 @samp{-x} option is used.
884
885
886 @menu
887 * File Options:: Choosing files
888 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
889 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
890 @end menu
891
892 @node File Options
893 @subsection Choosing Files
894
895 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
896 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
897 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
898 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
899 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
900 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
901 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
902 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
903 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
904 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
905 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
906 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
907 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
908
909 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
910 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
911 argument and ignore it.
912
913 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
914 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
915 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
916 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
917 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
918
919 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
920 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
921 @c it.
922
923 @table @code
924 @item -symbols @var{file}
925 @itemx -s @var{file}
926 @cindex @code{--symbols}
927 @cindex @code{-s}
928 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
929
930 @item -exec @var{file}
931 @itemx -e @var{file}
932 @cindex @code{--exec}
933 @cindex @code{-e}
934 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
935 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
936
937 @item -se @var{file}
938 @cindex @code{--se}
939 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
940 file.
941
942 @item -core @var{file}
943 @itemx -c @var{file}
944 @cindex @code{--core}
945 @cindex @code{-c}
946 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
947
948 @item -pid @var{number}
949 @itemx -p @var{number}
950 @cindex @code{--pid}
951 @cindex @code{-p}
952 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
953
954 @item -command @var{file}
955 @itemx -x @var{file}
956 @cindex @code{--command}
957 @cindex @code{-x}
958 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
959 Files,, Command files}.
960
961 @item -eval-command @var{command}
962 @itemx -ex @var{command}
963 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
964 @cindex @code{-ex}
965 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
966
967 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
968 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
969
970 @smallexample
971 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
972 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
973 @end smallexample
974
975 @item -directory @var{directory}
976 @itemx -d @var{directory}
977 @cindex @code{--directory}
978 @cindex @code{-d}
979 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
980
981 @item -r
982 @itemx -readnow
983 @cindex @code{--readnow}
984 @cindex @code{-r}
985 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
986 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
987 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
988
989 @end table
990
991 @node Mode Options
992 @subsection Choosing Modes
993
994 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
995 batch mode or quiet mode.
996
997 @table @code
998 @item -nx
999 @itemx -n
1000 @cindex @code{--nx}
1001 @cindex @code{-n}
1002 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1003 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1004 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1005 Files}.
1006
1007 @item -quiet
1008 @itemx -silent
1009 @itemx -q
1010 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1011 @cindex @code{--silent}
1012 @cindex @code{-q}
1013 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1014 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1015
1016 @item -batch
1017 @cindex @code{--batch}
1018 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1019 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1020 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1021 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1022 in the command files.
1023
1024 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1025 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1026 make this more useful, the message
1027
1028 @smallexample
1029 Program exited normally.
1030 @end smallexample
1031
1032 @noindent
1033 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1034 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1035 mode.
1036
1037 @item -batch-silent
1038 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1039 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1040 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1041 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1042 for an interactive session.
1043
1044 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1045 messages, for example.
1046
1047 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1048 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1049
1050 @item -return-child-result
1051 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1052 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1053 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1054
1055 @itemize @bullet
1056 @item
1057 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1058 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1059 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1060 @item
1061 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1062 @item
1063 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1064 the exit code will be -1.
1065 @end itemize
1066
1067 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1068 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1069 interface.
1070
1071 @item -nowindows
1072 @itemx -nw
1073 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1074 @cindex @code{-nw}
1075 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1076 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1077 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1078
1079 @item -windows
1080 @itemx -w
1081 @cindex @code{--windows}
1082 @cindex @code{-w}
1083 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1084 used if possible.
1085
1086 @item -cd @var{directory}
1087 @cindex @code{--cd}
1088 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1089 instead of the current directory.
1090
1091 @item -fullname
1092 @itemx -f
1093 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1094 @cindex @code{-f}
1095 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1096 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1097 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1098 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1099 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1100 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1101 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1102 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1103 frame.
1104
1105 @item -epoch
1106 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1107 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1108 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1109 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1110 separate window.
1111
1112 @item -annotate @var{level}
1113 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1114 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1115 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1116 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1117 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1118 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1119 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1120 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1121 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1122
1123 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1124 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1125
1126 @item --args
1127 @cindex @code{--args}
1128 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1129 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1130 This option stops option processing.
1131
1132 @item -baud @var{bps}
1133 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1134 @cindex @code{--baud}
1135 @cindex @code{-b}
1136 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1137 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1138
1139 @item -l @var{timeout}
1140 @cindex @code{-l}
1141 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1142 for remote debugging.
1143
1144 @item -tty @var{device}
1145 @itemx -t @var{device}
1146 @cindex @code{--tty}
1147 @cindex @code{-t}
1148 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1149 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1150
1151 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1152 @item -tui
1153 @cindex @code{--tui}
1154 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1155 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1156 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1157 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1158 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1159 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1160 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1161
1162 @c @item -xdb
1163 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1164 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1165 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1166 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1167 @c systems.
1168
1169 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1170 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1171 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1172 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1173 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1174 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1175
1176 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1177 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1178 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1179 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1180 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1181 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1182
1183 @item -write
1184 @cindex @code{--write}
1185 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1186 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1187 (@pxref{Patching}).
1188
1189 @item -statistics
1190 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1191 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1192 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1193
1194 @item -version
1195 @cindex @code{--version}
1196 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1197 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1198
1199 @end table
1200
1201 @node Startup
1202 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1203 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1204
1205 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1206
1207 @enumerate
1208 @item
1209 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1210 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1211
1212 @item
1213 @cindex init file
1214 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1215 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1216 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1217 that file.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Processes command line options and operands.
1221
1222 @item
1223 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1224 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1225 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1226 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1227 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1228 @value{GDBN}.
1229
1230 @item
1231 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1232 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1233
1234 @item
1235 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1236 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1237 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1238 @end enumerate
1239
1240 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1241 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1242 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1243 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1244 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1245 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1246
1247 @cindex init file name
1248 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1249 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1250 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1251 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1252 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1253 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1254 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1255 the file to the standard name.
1256
1257
1258 @node Quitting GDB
1259 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1260 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1261 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1262
1263 @table @code
1264 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1265 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1266 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1267 @itemx q
1268 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1269 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1270 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1271 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1272 error code.
1273 @end table
1274
1275 @cindex interrupt
1276 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1277 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1278 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1279 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1280 until a time when it is safe.
1281
1282 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1283 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1284 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1285
1286 @node Shell Commands
1287 @section Shell Commands
1288
1289 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1290 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1291 just use the @code{shell} command.
1292
1293 @table @code
1294 @kindex shell
1295 @cindex shell escape
1296 @item shell @var{command string}
1297 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1298 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1299 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1300 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1301 @end table
1302
1303 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1304 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1305 @value{GDBN}:
1306
1307 @table @code
1308 @kindex make
1309 @cindex calling make
1310 @item make @var{make-args}
1311 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1312 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1313 @end table
1314
1315 @node Logging Output
1316 @section Logging Output
1317 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1318 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1319
1320 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1321 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1322
1323 @table @code
1324 @kindex set logging
1325 @item set logging on
1326 Enable logging.
1327 @item set logging off
1328 Disable logging.
1329 @cindex logging file name
1330 @item set logging file @var{file}
1331 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1332 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1334 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1335 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1336 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1337 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1338 @kindex show logging
1339 @item show logging
1340 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1341 @end table
1342
1343 @node Commands
1344 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1345
1346 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1347 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1348 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1349 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1350 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1351
1352 @menu
1353 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1354 * Completion:: Command completion
1355 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1356 @end menu
1357
1358 @node Command Syntax
1359 @section Command Syntax
1360
1361 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1362 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1363 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1364 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1365 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1366 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1367
1368 @cindex abbreviation
1369 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1370 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1371 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1372 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1373 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1374 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1375 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1376
1377 @cindex repeating commands
1378 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1379 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1380 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1381 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1382 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1383 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1384 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1385
1386 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1387 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1388 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1389
1390 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1391 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1392 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1393 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1394 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1395
1396 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1397 @cindex comment
1398 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1399 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1400 Files,,Command Files}).
1401
1402 @cindex repeating command sequences
1403 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1404 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1405 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1406 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1407 for editing.
1408
1409 @node Completion
1410 @section Command Completion
1411
1412 @cindex completion
1413 @cindex word completion
1414 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1415 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1416 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1417 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1418
1419 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1420 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1421 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1422 enter it). For example, if you type
1423
1424 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1425 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1426 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1427 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1428 @smallexample
1429 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1430 @end smallexample
1431
1432 @noindent
1433 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1434 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1435
1436 @smallexample
1437 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1438 @end smallexample
1439
1440 @noindent
1441 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1442 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1443 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1444 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1445 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1446 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1447
1448 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1449 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1450 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1451 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1452 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1453 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1454 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1455 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1456 example:
1457
1458 @smallexample
1459 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1460 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1461 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1462 make_abs_section make_function_type
1463 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1464 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1465 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1466 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1467 @end smallexample
1468
1469 @noindent
1470 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1471 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1472 command.
1473
1474 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1475 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1476 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1477 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1478 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1479
1480 @cindex quotes in commands
1481 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1482 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1483 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1484 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1485 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1486 @value{GDBN} commands.
1487
1488 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1489 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1490 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1491 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1492 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1493 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1494 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1495 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1496 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1497 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1498 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1499
1500 @smallexample
1501 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1502 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1503 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1504 @end smallexample
1505
1506 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1507 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1508 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1509 place:
1510
1511 @smallexample
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1513 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1514 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1515 @end smallexample
1516
1517 @noindent
1518 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1519 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1520 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1521
1522 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1523 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1524 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1525 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1526
1527 @cindex completion of structure field names
1528 @cindex structure field name completion
1529 @cindex completion of union field names
1530 @cindex union field name completion
1531 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1532 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1533 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1534 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1535 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1536 left-hand-side:
1537
1538 @smallexample
1539 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1540 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1541 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1542 @end smallexample
1543
1544 @noindent
1545 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1546 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1547 follows:
1548
1549 @smallexample
1550 struct ui_file
1551 @{
1552 int *magic;
1553 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1554 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1555 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1556 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1557 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1558 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1559 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1560 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1561 void *to_data;
1562 @}
1563 @end smallexample
1564
1565
1566 @node Help
1567 @section Getting Help
1568 @cindex online documentation
1569 @kindex help
1570
1571 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1572 using the command @code{help}.
1573
1574 @table @code
1575 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1576 @item help
1577 @itemx h
1578 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1579 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1580
1581 @smallexample
1582 (@value{GDBP}) help
1583 List of classes of commands:
1584
1585 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1586 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1587 data -- Examining data
1588 files -- Specifying and examining files
1589 internals -- Maintenance commands
1590 obscure -- Obscure features
1591 running -- Running the program
1592 stack -- Examining the stack
1593 status -- Status inquiries
1594 support -- Support facilities
1595 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1596 stopping the program
1597 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1598
1599 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1600 commands in that class.
1601 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1602 documentation.
1603 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1604 (@value{GDBP})
1605 @end smallexample
1606 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1607
1608 @item help @var{class}
1609 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1610 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1611 help display for the class @code{status}:
1612
1613 @smallexample
1614 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1615 Status inquiries.
1616
1617 List of commands:
1618
1619 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1620 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1621 info -- Generic command for showing things
1622 about the program being debugged
1623 show -- Generic command for showing things
1624 about the debugger
1625
1626 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1627 documentation.
1628 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1629 (@value{GDBP})
1630 @end smallexample
1631
1632 @item help @var{command}
1633 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1634 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1635
1636 @kindex apropos
1637 @item apropos @var{args}
1638 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1639 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1640 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1641
1642 @smallexample
1643 apropos reload
1644 @end smallexample
1645
1646 @noindent
1647 results in:
1648
1649 @smallexample
1650 @c @group
1651 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1652 multiple times in one run
1653 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1654 multiple times in one run
1655 @c @end group
1656 @end smallexample
1657
1658 @kindex complete
1659 @item complete @var{args}
1660 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1661 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1662 command you want completed. For example:
1663
1664 @smallexample
1665 complete i
1666 @end smallexample
1667
1668 @noindent results in:
1669
1670 @smallexample
1671 @group
1672 if
1673 ignore
1674 info
1675 inspect
1676 @end group
1677 @end smallexample
1678
1679 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1680 @end table
1681
1682 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1683 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1684 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1685 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1686 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1687 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1688
1689 @c @group
1690 @table @code
1691 @kindex info
1692 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1693 @item info
1694 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1695 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1696 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1697 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1698 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1699 @w{@code{help info}}.
1700
1701 @kindex set
1702 @item set
1703 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1704 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1705 @code{set prompt $}.
1706
1707 @kindex show
1708 @item show
1709 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1710 @value{GDBN} itself.
1711 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1712 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1713 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1714 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1715
1716 @kindex info set
1717 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1718 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1719 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1720 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1721 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1722 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1723 @end table
1724 @c @end group
1725
1726 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1727 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1728
1729 @table @code
1730 @kindex show version
1731 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1732 @item show version
1733 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1734 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1735 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1736 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1737 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1738 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1739 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1740 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1741 @value{GDBN}.
1742
1743 @kindex show copying
1744 @kindex info copying
1745 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1746 @item show copying
1747 @itemx info copying
1748 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1749
1750 @kindex show warranty
1751 @kindex info warranty
1752 @item show warranty
1753 @itemx info warranty
1754 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1755 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1756
1757 @end table
1758
1759 @node Running
1760 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1761
1762 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1763 debugging information when you compile it.
1764
1765 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1766 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1767 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1768 kill a child process.
1769
1770 @menu
1771 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1772 * Starting:: Starting your program
1773 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1774 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1775
1776 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1777 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1778 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1779 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1780
1781 * Inferiors:: Debugging multiple inferiors
1782 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1783 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1784 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1785 @end menu
1786
1787 @node Compilation
1788 @section Compiling for Debugging
1789
1790 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1791 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1792 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1793 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1794 and addresses in the executable code.
1795
1796 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1797 the compiler.
1798
1799 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1800 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1801 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1802 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1803 executables containing debugging information.
1804
1805 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1806 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1807 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1808 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1809 in pushing your luck.
1810
1811 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1812 @cindex debugging optimized code
1813 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1814 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1815 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1816 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1817 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1818 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1819
1820 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1821 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1822 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1823 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1824 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1825
1826 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1827 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1828 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1829
1830 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1831 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1832 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1833 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1834 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1835 provides macro information if you specify the options
1836 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1837 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1838 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1839 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1840 @option{-g} alone.
1841
1842 @need 2000
1843 @node Starting
1844 @section Starting your Program
1845 @cindex starting
1846 @cindex running
1847
1848 @table @code
1849 @kindex run
1850 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1851 @item run
1852 @itemx r
1853 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1854 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1855 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1856 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1857 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1858
1859 @end table
1860
1861 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1862 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1863 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1864 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1865 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1866 message like this one:
1867
1868 @smallexample
1869 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1870 Try "help target" or "continue".
1871 @end smallexample
1872
1873 @noindent
1874 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1875 first (@pxref{load}).
1876
1877 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1878 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1879 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1880 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1881 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1882 divided into four categories:
1883
1884 @table @asis
1885 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1886 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1887 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1888 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1889 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1890 the arguments.
1891 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1892 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1893 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1894
1895 @item The @emph{environment.}
1896 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1897 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1898 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1899 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1900
1901 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1902 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1903 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1904 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1905
1906 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1907 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1908 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1909 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1910 set a different device for your program.
1911 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1912
1913 @cindex pipes
1914 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1915 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1916 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1917 wrong program.
1918 @end table
1919
1920 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1921 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1922 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1923 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1924 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1925
1926 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1927 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1928 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1929 your current breakpoints.
1930
1931 @table @code
1932 @kindex start
1933 @item start
1934 @cindex run to main procedure
1935 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1936 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1937 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1938 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1939 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1940 procedure, depending on the language used.
1941
1942 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1943 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1944 the @samp{run} command.
1945
1946 @cindex elaboration phase
1947 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1948 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1949 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1950 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1951 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1952 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1953 will remain to halt execution.
1954
1955 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1956 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1957 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1958 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1959 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1960
1961 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1962 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1963 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1964 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1965 elaboration code before running your program.
1966
1967 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1968 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1969 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1970 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1971 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1972 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1973 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1974 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1975 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1976 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1977 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1978
1979 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1980 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1981 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1982 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1983
1984 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1985 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1986 environment:
1987
1988 @smallexample
1989 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1990 (@value{GDBP}) run
1991 @end smallexample
1992
1993 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
1994 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
1995
1996 @kindex set disable-randomization
1997 @item set disable-randomization
1998 @itemx set disable-randomization on
1999 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2000 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2001 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2002 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2003
2004 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2005 behavior using
2006
2007 @smallexample
2008 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2009 @end smallexample
2010
2011 @item set disable-randomization off
2012 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2013 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2014 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2015 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2016 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2017 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2018
2019 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2020 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2021 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2022 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2023 a code at its expected addresses.
2024
2025 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2026 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2027 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2028 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2029 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2030 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2031 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2032 a randomly chosen address.
2033
2034 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2035 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2036 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2037 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2038 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2039
2040 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2041 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2042
2043 @item show disable-randomization
2044 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2045 the virtual address space of the started program.
2046
2047 @end table
2048
2049 @node Arguments
2050 @section Your Program's Arguments
2051
2052 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2053 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2054 @code{run} command.
2055 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2056 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2057 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2058 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2059 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2060
2061 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2062 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2063 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2064 the program, not by the shell.
2065
2066 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2067 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2068
2069 @table @code
2070 @kindex set args
2071 @item set args
2072 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2073 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2074 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2075 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2076 it again without arguments.
2077
2078 @kindex show args
2079 @item show args
2080 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2081 @end table
2082
2083 @node Environment
2084 @section Your Program's Environment
2085
2086 @cindex environment (of your program)
2087 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2088 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2089 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2090 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2091 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2092 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2093 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2094
2095 @table @code
2096 @kindex path
2097 @item path @var{directory}
2098 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2099 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2100 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2101 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2102 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2103 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2104 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2105
2106 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2107 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2108 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2109 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2110 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2111 @var{directory} to the search path.
2112 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2113 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2114
2115 @kindex show paths
2116 @item show paths
2117 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2118 environment variable).
2119
2120 @kindex show environment
2121 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2122 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2123 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2124 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2125 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2126
2127 @kindex set environment
2128 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2129 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2130 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2131 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2132 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2133 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2134 null value.
2135 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2136 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2137
2138 For example, this command:
2139
2140 @smallexample
2141 set env USER = foo
2142 @end smallexample
2143
2144 @noindent
2145 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2146 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2147 are not actually required.)
2148
2149 @kindex unset environment
2150 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2151 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2152 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2153 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2154 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2155 @end table
2156
2157 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2158 the shell indicated
2159 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2160 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2161 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2162 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2163 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2164 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2165 @file{.profile}.
2166
2167 @node Working Directory
2168 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2169
2170 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2171 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2172 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2173 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2174 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2175 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2176
2177 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2178 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2179 Specify Files}.
2180
2181 @table @code
2182 @kindex cd
2183 @cindex change working directory
2184 @item cd @var{directory}
2185 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2186
2187 @kindex pwd
2188 @item pwd
2189 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2190 @end table
2191
2192 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2193 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2194 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2195 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2196 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2197 current working directory of the debuggee.
2198
2199 @node Input/Output
2200 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2201
2202 @cindex redirection
2203 @cindex i/o
2204 @cindex terminal
2205 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2206 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2207 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2208 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2209 running your program.
2210
2211 @table @code
2212 @kindex info terminal
2213 @item info terminal
2214 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2215 program is using.
2216 @end table
2217
2218 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2219 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2220
2221 @smallexample
2222 run > outfile
2223 @end smallexample
2224
2225 @noindent
2226 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2227
2228 @kindex tty
2229 @cindex controlling terminal
2230 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2231 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2232 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2233 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2234 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2235
2236 @smallexample
2237 tty /dev/ttyb
2238 @end smallexample
2239
2240 @noindent
2241 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2242 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2243 that as their controlling terminal.
2244
2245 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2246 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2247 terminal.
2248
2249 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2250 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2251 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2252 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2253
2254 @cindex inferior tty
2255 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2256 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2257 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2258 program.
2259
2260 @table @code
2261 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2262 @kindex set inferior-tty
2263 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2264
2265 @item show inferior-tty
2266 @kindex show inferior-tty
2267 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2268 @end table
2269
2270 @node Attach
2271 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2272 @kindex attach
2273 @cindex attach
2274
2275 @table @code
2276 @item attach @var{process-id}
2277 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2278 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2279 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2280 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2281 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2282
2283 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2284 executing the command.
2285 @end table
2286
2287 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2288 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2289 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2290 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2291
2292 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2293 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2294 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2295 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2296 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2297 Specify Files}.
2298
2299 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2300 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2301 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2302 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2303 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2304 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2305 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2306
2307 @table @code
2308 @kindex detach
2309 @item detach
2310 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2311 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2312 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2313 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2314 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2315 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2316 executing the command.
2317 @end table
2318
2319 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2320 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2321 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2322 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2323 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2324 Messages}).
2325
2326 @node Kill Process
2327 @section Killing the Child Process
2328
2329 @table @code
2330 @kindex kill
2331 @item kill
2332 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2333 @end table
2334
2335 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2336 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2337 is running.
2338
2339 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2340 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2341 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2342 outside the debugger.
2343
2344 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2345 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2346 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2347 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2348 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2349 breakpoint settings).
2350
2351 @node Inferiors
2352 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2353
2354 Some @value{GDBN} targets are able to run multiple processes created
2355 from a single executable. This can happen, for instance, with an
2356 embedded system reporting back several processes via the remote
2357 protocol.
2358
2359 @cindex inferior
2360 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2361 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2362 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2363 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2364 may (in future) be retained after a process exits. Each run of an
2365 executable creates a new inferior, as does each attachment to an
2366 existing process. Inferiors have unique identifiers that are
2367 different from process ids, and may optionally be named as well.
2368 Usually each inferior will also have its own distinct address space,
2369 although some embedded targets may have several inferiors running in
2370 different parts of a single space.
2371
2372 Each inferior may in turn have multiple threads running in it.
2373
2374 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @code{info inferiors}:
2375
2376 @table @code
2377 @kindex info inferiors
2378 @item info inferiors
2379 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2380
2381 @kindex set print inferior-events
2382 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2383 @item set print inferior-events
2384 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2385 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2386 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2387 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2388 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2389 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2390
2391 @kindex show print inferior-events
2392 @item show print inferior-events
2393 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2394 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2395 @end table
2396
2397 @node Threads
2398 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2399
2400 @cindex threads of execution
2401 @cindex multiple threads
2402 @cindex switching threads
2403 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2404 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2405 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2406 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2407 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2408 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2409 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2410
2411 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2412 programs:
2413
2414 @itemize @bullet
2415 @item automatic notification of new threads
2416 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2417 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2418 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2419 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2420 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2421 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2422 messages on thread start and exit.
2423 @end itemize
2424
2425 @quotation
2426 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2427 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2428 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2429 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2430 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2431 like this:
2432
2433 @smallexample
2434 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2435 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2436 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2437 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2438 @end smallexample
2439 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2440 @c doesn't support threads"?
2441 @end quotation
2442
2443 @cindex focus of debugging
2444 @cindex current thread
2445 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2446 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2447 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2448 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2449 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2450
2451 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2452 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2453 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2454 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2455 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2456 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2457 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2458 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2459 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2460 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2468 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2469 further qualifier.
2470
2471 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2472 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2473 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2474 @c program?
2475 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2476 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2477 @c threads ab initio?
2478
2479 @cindex thread number
2480 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2481 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2482 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2483
2484 @table @code
2485 @kindex info threads
2486 @item info threads
2487 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2488 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2489
2490 @enumerate
2491 @item
2492 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2493
2494 @item
2495 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2496
2497 @item
2498 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2499 @end enumerate
2500
2501 @noindent
2502 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2503 indicates the current thread.
2504
2505 For example,
2506 @end table
2507 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2508
2509 @smallexample
2510 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2511 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2512 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2513 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2514 at threadtest.c:68
2515 @end smallexample
2516
2517 On HP-UX systems:
2518
2519 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2520 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2521 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2522 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2523 thread in your program.
2524
2525 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2526 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2527 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2528 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2529 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2530 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2531 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2532 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2533 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2534 HP-UX, you see
2535
2536 @smallexample
2537 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2538 @end smallexample
2539
2540 @noindent
2541 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2545 @item info threads
2546 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2547 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2548
2549 @enumerate
2550 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2551
2552 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2553
2554 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2555 @end enumerate
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2559 indicates the current thread.
2560
2561 For example,
2562 @end table
2563 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2564
2565 @smallexample
2566 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2567 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2568 at quicksort.c:137
2569 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2570 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2571 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2572 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2573 @end smallexample
2574
2575 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2576 Solaris-specific command:
2577
2578 @table @code
2579 @item maint info sol-threads
2580 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2581 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2582 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2583 @end table
2584
2585 @table @code
2586 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2587 @item thread @var{threadno}
2588 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2589 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2590 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2591 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2592 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2593
2594 @smallexample
2595 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2596 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2597 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2598 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2599 @end smallexample
2600
2601 @noindent
2602 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2603 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2604 threads.
2605
2606 @kindex thread apply
2607 @cindex apply command to several threads
2608 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2609 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2610 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2611 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2612 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2613 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2614 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2615 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2616
2617 @kindex set print thread-events
2618 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2619 @item set print thread-events
2620 @itemx set print thread-events on
2621 @itemx set print thread-events off
2622 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2623 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2624 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2625 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2626 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2627
2628 @kindex show print thread-events
2629 @item show print thread-events
2630 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2631 have started and exited.
2632 @end table
2633
2634 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2635 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2636 programs with multiple threads.
2637
2638 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2639 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2640
2641 @node Processes
2642 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2643
2644 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2645 @cindex multiple processes
2646 @cindex processes, multiple
2647 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2648 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2649 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2650 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2651 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2652 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2653 will cause it to terminate.
2654
2655 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2656 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2657 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2658 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2659 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2660 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2661 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2662 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2663 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2664 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2665
2666 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2667 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2668 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2669 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2670
2671 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2672 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2673
2674 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2675 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2676
2677 @table @code
2678 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2679 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2680 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2681 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2682 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2683
2684 @table @code
2685 @item parent
2686 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2687 unimpeded. This is the default.
2688
2689 @item child
2690 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2691 unimpeded.
2692
2693 @end table
2694
2695 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2696 @item show follow-fork-mode
2697 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2698 @end table
2699
2700 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2701 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2702 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2703
2704 @table @code
2705 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2706 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2707 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2708 retain debugger control over them both.
2709
2710 @table @code
2711 @item on
2712 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2713 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2714 independently. This is the default.
2715
2716 @item off
2717 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2718 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2719 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2720 is held suspended.
2721
2722 @end table
2723
2724 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2725 @item show detach-on-fork
2726 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2730 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2731 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2732 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2733 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2734
2735 @table @code
2736 @kindex info forks
2737 @item info forks
2738 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2739 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2740 position (program counter) of the process.
2741
2742 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2743 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2744 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2745 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2746 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2747
2748 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2749 @item process @var{process-id}
2750 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2751 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2752 @samp{info forks}.
2753
2754 @end table
2755
2756 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2757 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2758 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2759 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2760
2761 @table @code
2762 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2763 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2764 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2765 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2766 allowed to run independently.
2767
2768 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2769 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2770 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2771 and remove it from the fork list.
2772
2773 @end table
2774
2775 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2776 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2777 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2778 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2779 the child process's @code{main}.
2780
2781 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2782 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2783
2784 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2785 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2786 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2787 argument.
2788
2789 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2790 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2791 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2792
2793 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2794 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2795
2796 @cindex checkpoint
2797 @cindex restart
2798 @cindex bookmark
2799 @cindex snapshot of a process
2800 @cindex rewind program state
2801
2802 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2803 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2804 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2805 later.
2806
2807 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2808 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2809 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2810 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2811 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2812
2813 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2814 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2815 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2816 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2817 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2818 start again from there.
2819
2820 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2821 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2822
2823 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2824
2825 @table @code
2826 @kindex checkpoint
2827 @item checkpoint
2828 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2829 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2830 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2831
2832 @kindex info checkpoints
2833 @item info checkpoints
2834 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2835 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2836 listed:
2837
2838 @table @code
2839 @item Checkpoint ID
2840 @item Process ID
2841 @item Code Address
2842 @item Source line, or label
2843 @end table
2844
2845 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2846 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2847 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2848 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2849 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2850 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2851 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2852
2853 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2854 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2855 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2856 the debugger.
2857
2858 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2859 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2860 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2861
2862 @end table
2863
2864 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2865 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2866 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2867 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2868 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2869 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2870 previously read data can be read again.
2871
2872 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2873 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2874 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2875 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2876 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2877 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2878
2879 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2880 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2881 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2882 different execution path this time.
2883
2884 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2885 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2886 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2887 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2888 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2889 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2890 potentially pose a problem.
2891
2892 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2893
2894 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2895 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2896 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2897 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2898 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2899 next.
2900
2901 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2902 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2903 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2904 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2905 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2906
2907 @node Stopping
2908 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2909
2910 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2911 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2912 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2913
2914 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2915 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2916 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2917 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2918 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2919 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2920 explicitly request this information at any time.
2921
2922 @table @code
2923 @kindex info program
2924 @item info program
2925 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2926 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2927 @end table
2928
2929 @menu
2930 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2931 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2932 * Signals:: Signals
2933 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2934 @end menu
2935
2936 @node Breakpoints
2937 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2938
2939 @cindex breakpoints
2940 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2941 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2942 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2943 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2944 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2945 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2946 program.
2947
2948 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2949 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2950 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2951 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2952 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2953 call).
2954
2955 @cindex watchpoints
2956 @cindex data breakpoints
2957 @cindex memory tracing
2958 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2959 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2960 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2961 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2962 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2963 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2964 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2965 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2966 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2967 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2968 same commands.
2969
2970 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2971 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2972 Automatic Display}.
2973
2974 @cindex catchpoints
2975 @cindex breakpoint on events
2976 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2977 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2978 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2979 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2980 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2981 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2982 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2983
2984 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2985 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2986 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2987 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2988 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2989 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2990 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2991 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2992 enable it again.
2993
2994 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2995 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2996 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2997 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2998 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2999 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3000 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3001
3002 @menu
3003 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3004 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3005 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3006 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3007 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3008 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3009 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3010 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3011 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3012 @end menu
3013
3014 @node Set Breaks
3015 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3016
3017 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3018 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3019 @c
3020 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3021
3022 @kindex break
3023 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3024 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3025 @cindex latest breakpoint
3026 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3027 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3028 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3029 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3030 convenience variables.
3031
3032 @table @code
3033 @item break @var{location}
3034 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3035 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3036 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3037 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3038 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3039
3040 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3041 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3042 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3043 that situation.
3044
3045 @item break
3046 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3047 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3048 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3049 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3050 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3051 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3052 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3053 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3054 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3055 inside loops.
3056
3057 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3058 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3059 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3060 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3061 existed when your program stopped.
3062
3063 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3064 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3065 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3066 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3067 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3068 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3069 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3070
3071 @kindex tbreak
3072 @item tbreak @var{args}
3073 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3074 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3075 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3076 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3077
3078 @kindex hbreak
3079 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3080 @item hbreak @var{args}
3081 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3082 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3083 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3084 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3085 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3086 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3087 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3088 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3089 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3090 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3091 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3092 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3093 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3094 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3095 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3096 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3097 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3098 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3099
3100 @kindex thbreak
3101 @item thbreak @var{args}
3102 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3103 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3104 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3105 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3106 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3107 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3108 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3109 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3110
3111 @kindex rbreak
3112 @cindex regular expression
3113 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3114 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3115 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3116 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3117 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3118 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3119 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3120 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3121 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3122
3123 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3124 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3125 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3126 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3127 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3128 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3129
3130 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3131 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3132 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3133 classes.
3134
3135 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3136 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3137 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3138
3139 @smallexample
3140 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3141 @end smallexample
3142
3143 @kindex info breakpoints
3144 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3145 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3146 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3147 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3148 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3149 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3150 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3151 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3152
3153 @table @emph
3154 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3155 @item Type
3156 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3157 @item Disposition
3158 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3159 @item Enabled or Disabled
3160 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3161 that are not enabled.
3162 @item Address
3163 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3164 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3165 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3166 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3167 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3168 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3169 @item What
3170 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3171 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3172 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3173 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3174 @end table
3175
3176 @noindent
3177 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3178 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3179 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3180 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3181 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3182 valid location.
3183
3184 @noindent
3185 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3186 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3187 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3188 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3189 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3190
3191 @noindent
3192 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3193 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3194 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3195 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3196 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3197 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3198 @end table
3199
3200 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3201 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3202 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3203 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3204
3205 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3206 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3207 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3208 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3209
3210 @itemize @bullet
3211 @item
3212 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3213 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3214
3215 @item
3216 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3217 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3218
3219 @item
3220 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3221 several places where that function is inlined.
3222 @end itemize
3223
3224 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3225 the relevant locations@footnote{
3226 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3227 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3228 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3229 info with line numbers for them.}.
3230
3231 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3232 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3233 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3234 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3235 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3236 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3237 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3238
3239 For example:
3240
3241 @smallexample
3242 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3243 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3244 stop only if i==1
3245 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3246 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3247 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3248 @end smallexample
3249
3250 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3251 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3252 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3253 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3254 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3255 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3256 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3257 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3258 that belong to that breakpoint.
3259
3260 @cindex pending breakpoints
3261 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3262 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3263 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3264 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3265 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3266 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3267 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3268 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3269 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3270 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3271 is not yet resolved.
3272
3273 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3274 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3275 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3276 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3277 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3278 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3279
3280 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3281 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3282 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3283 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3284
3285 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3286 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3287 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3288
3289 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3290 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3291 address specification to an address:
3292
3293 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3294 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3295 @table @code
3296 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3297 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3298 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3299
3300 @item set breakpoint pending on
3301 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3302 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3303
3304 @item set breakpoint pending off
3305 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3306 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3307 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3308
3309 @item show breakpoint pending
3310 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3311 @end table
3312
3313 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3314 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3315 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3316
3317 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3318 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3319 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3320 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3321 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3322 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3323 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3324 breakpoints.
3325
3326 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3327
3328 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3329 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3330 @table @code
3331 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3332 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3333 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3334 breakpoint must be used.
3335
3336 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3337 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3338 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3339 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3340 @end table
3341
3342 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3343 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3344 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3345 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3346 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3347 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3348 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3349 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3350 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3351
3352 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3353 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3354 @table @code
3355 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3356 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3357 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3358 removed from the target when it stops.
3359
3360 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3361 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3362 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3363 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3364 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3365
3366 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3367 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3368 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3369 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3370 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3371 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3372 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3373 @end table
3374
3375 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3376 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3377 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3378 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3379 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3380 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3381 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3382 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3383
3384
3385 @node Set Watchpoints
3386 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3387
3388 @cindex setting watchpoints
3389 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3390 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3391 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3392 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3393 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3394
3395 @itemize @bullet
3396 @item
3397 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3398
3399 @item
3400 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3401 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3402 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3403
3404 @item
3405 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3406 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3407 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3408 @end itemize
3409
3410 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3411 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3412 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3413 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3414 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3415 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3416 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3417 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3418 the expression changes.
3419
3420 @cindex software watchpoints
3421 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3422 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3423 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3424 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3425 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3426 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3427 culprit.)
3428
3429 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3430 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3431 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3432
3433 @table @code
3434 @kindex watch
3435 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3436 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3437 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3438 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3439 to watch the value of a single variable:
3440
3441 @smallexample
3442 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3443 @end smallexample
3444
3445 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3446 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3447 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3448 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3449 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3450 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3451
3452 @kindex rwatch
3453 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3454 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3455 by the program.
3456
3457 @kindex awatch
3458 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3459 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3460 or written into by the program.
3461
3462 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3463 @item info watchpoints
3464 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3465 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3466 @end table
3467
3468 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3469 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3470 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3471 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3472 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3473 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3474
3475 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3476 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3477 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3478 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3479 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3480 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3481 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3482 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3483
3484 @table @code
3485 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3486 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3487 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3488
3489 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3490 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3491 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3492 @end table
3493
3494 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3495 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3496 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3497
3498 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3499
3500 @smallexample
3501 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3502 @end smallexample
3503
3504 @noindent
3505 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3506
3507 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3508 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3509 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3510 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3511 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3512 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3513 will print a message like this:
3514
3515 @smallexample
3516 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3517 @end smallexample
3518
3519 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3520 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3521 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3522 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3523 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3524 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3525 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3526 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3527
3528 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3529 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3530 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3531 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3532 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3533 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3534
3535 @smallexample
3536 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3537 @end smallexample
3538
3539 @noindent
3540 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3541
3542 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3543 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3544 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3545 expression with separately allocated resources.
3546
3547 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3548 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3549 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3550
3551 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3552 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3553 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3554 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3555 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3556 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3557 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3558 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3559 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3560
3561 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3562 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3563 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3564 watched expression from every thread.
3565
3566 @quotation
3567 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3568 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3569 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3570 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3571 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3572 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3573 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3574 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3575 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3576 @end quotation
3577
3578 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3579
3580 @node Set Catchpoints
3581 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3582 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3583 @cindex exception handlers
3584 @cindex event handling
3585
3586 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3587 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3588 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3589
3590 @table @code
3591 @kindex catch
3592 @item catch @var{event}
3593 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3594 @table @code
3595 @item throw
3596 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3597 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3598
3599 @item catch
3600 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3601
3602 @item exception
3603 @cindex Ada exception catching
3604 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3605 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3606 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3607 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3608 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3609
3610 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3611 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3612 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3613 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3614 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3615 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3616 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3617 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3618
3619 @item exception unhandled
3620 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3621
3622 @item assert
3623 A failed Ada assertion.
3624
3625 @item exec
3626 @cindex break on fork/exec
3627 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3628 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3629
3630 @item fork
3631 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3632 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3633
3634 @item vfork
3635 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3636 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3637
3638 @end table
3639
3640 @item tcatch @var{event}
3641 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3642 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3643
3644 @end table
3645
3646 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3647
3648 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3649 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3650
3651 @itemize @bullet
3652 @item
3653 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3654 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3655 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3656 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3657 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3658 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3659 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3660 disabled within interactive calls.
3661
3662 @item
3663 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3664
3665 @item
3666 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3667 @end itemize
3668
3669 @cindex raise exceptions
3670 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3671 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3672 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3673 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3674 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3675 out where the exception was raised.
3676
3677 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3678 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3679 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3680 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3681
3682 @smallexample
3683 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3684 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3685 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3686 @end smallexample
3687
3688 @noindent
3689 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3690 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3691 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3692
3693 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3694 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3695 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3696 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3697 raised.
3698
3699
3700 @node Delete Breaks
3701 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3702
3703 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3704 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3705 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3706 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3707 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3708 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3709
3710 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3711 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3712 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3713 their breakpoint numbers.
3714
3715 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3716 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3717 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3718
3719 @table @code
3720 @kindex clear
3721 @item clear
3722 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3723 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3724 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3725 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3726
3727 @item clear @var{location}
3728 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3729 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3730 most useful ones are listed below:
3731
3732 @table @code
3733 @item clear @var{function}
3734 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3735 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3736
3737 @item clear @var{linenum}
3738 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3739 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3740 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3741 @end table
3742
3743 @cindex delete breakpoints
3744 @kindex delete
3745 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3746 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3747 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3748 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3749 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3750 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3751 @end table
3752
3753 @node Disabling
3754 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3755
3756 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3757 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3758 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3759 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3760 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3761
3762 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3763 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3764 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3765 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3766 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3767
3768 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3769 affects all of its locations.
3770
3771 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3772 states of enablement:
3773
3774 @itemize @bullet
3775 @item
3776 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3777 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3778 @item
3779 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3780 @item
3781 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3782 disabled.
3783 @item
3784 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3785 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3786 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3787 @end itemize
3788
3789 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3790 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3791
3792 @table @code
3793 @kindex disable
3794 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3795 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3796 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3797 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3798 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3799 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3800 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3801
3802 @kindex enable
3803 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3804 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3805 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3806
3807 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3808 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3809 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3810
3811 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3812 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3813 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3814 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3815 @end table
3816
3817 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3818 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3819 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3820 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3821 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3822 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3823 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3824 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3825 Stepping}.)
3826
3827 @node Conditions
3828 @subsection Break Conditions
3829 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3830 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3831
3832 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3833 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3834 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3835 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3836 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3837 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3838 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3839 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3840
3841 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3842 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3843 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3844 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3845 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3846
3847 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3848 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3849 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3850 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3851 one.
3852
3853 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3854 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3855 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3856 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3857 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3858 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3859 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3860 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3861 conditions for the
3862 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3863 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3864
3865 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3866 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3867 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3868 with the @code{condition} command.
3869
3870 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3871 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3872 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3873 catchpoint.
3874
3875 @table @code
3876 @kindex condition
3877 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3878 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3879 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3880 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3881 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3882 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3883 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3884 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3885 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3886 prints an error message:
3887
3888 @smallexample
3889 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3890 @end smallexample
3891
3892 @noindent
3893 @value{GDBN} does
3894 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3895 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3896 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3897
3898 @item condition @var{bnum}
3899 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3900 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3901 @end table
3902
3903 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3904 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3905 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3906 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3907 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3908 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3909 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3910 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3911 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3912 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3913 your program reaches it.
3914
3915 @table @code
3916 @kindex ignore
3917 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3918 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3919 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3920 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3921 takes no action.
3922
3923 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3924 a count of zero.
3925
3926 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3927 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3928 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3929 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3930
3931 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3932 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3933 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3934
3935 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3936 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3937 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3938 Variables}.
3939 @end table
3940
3941 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3942
3943
3944 @node Break Commands
3945 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3946
3947 @cindex breakpoint commands
3948 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3949 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3950 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3951 enable other breakpoints.
3952
3953 @table @code
3954 @kindex commands
3955 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3956 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3957 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3958 @itemx end
3959 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3960 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3961 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3962
3963 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3964 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3965
3966 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3967 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3968 recently encountered).
3969 @end table
3970
3971 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3972 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3973
3974 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3975 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3976 that resumes execution.
3977
3978 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3979 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3980 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3981 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3982 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3983
3984 @kindex silent
3985 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3986 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3987 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3988 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3989 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3990 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3991
3992 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3993 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3994 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3995
3996 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3997 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3998
3999 @smallexample
4000 break foo if x>0
4001 commands
4002 silent
4003 printf "x is %d\n",x
4004 cont
4005 end
4006 @end smallexample
4007
4008 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4009 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4010 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4011 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4012 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4013 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4014 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4015
4016 @smallexample
4017 break 403
4018 commands
4019 silent
4020 set x = y + 4
4021 cont
4022 end
4023 @end smallexample
4024
4025 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4026 @node Error in Breakpoints
4027 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4028
4029 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4030 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4031
4032 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4033 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4034 @smallexample
4035 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4036 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4037 @end smallexample
4038
4039 @noindent
4040 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4041 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4042 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4043
4044 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4045 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4046
4047 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4048 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4049 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4050
4051 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4052 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4053 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4054 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4055
4056 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4057 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4058 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4059 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4060 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4061 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4062 first in the bundle.
4063
4064 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4065 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4066 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4067 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4068 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4069 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4070 is hit.
4071
4072 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4073 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4074
4075 @smallexample
4076 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4077 @end smallexample
4078
4079 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4080 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4081 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4082 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4083 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4084 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4085 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4086 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4087
4088 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4089 adjusted breakpoints:
4090
4091 @smallexample
4092 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4093 to 0x00010410.
4094 @end smallexample
4095
4096 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4097 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4098 frequently than expected.
4099
4100 @node Continuing and Stepping
4101 @section Continuing and Stepping
4102
4103 @cindex stepping
4104 @cindex continuing
4105 @cindex resuming execution
4106 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4107 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4108 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4109 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4110 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4111 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4112 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4113 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4114
4115 @table @code
4116 @kindex continue
4117 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4118 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4119 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4120 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4121 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4122 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4123 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4124 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4125 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4126 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4127
4128 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4129 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4130 @code{continue} is ignored.
4131
4132 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4133 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4134 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4135 @code{continue}.
4136 @end table
4137
4138 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4139 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4140 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4141 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4142
4143 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4144 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4145 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4146 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4147 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4148 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4149
4150 @table @code
4151 @kindex step
4152 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4153 @item step
4154 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4155 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4156 abbreviated @code{s}.
4157
4158 @quotation
4159 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4160 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4161 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4162 @c distinction here.
4163 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4164 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4165 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4166 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4167 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4168 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4169 below.
4170 @end quotation
4171
4172 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4173 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4174 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4175 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4176 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4177 called within the line.
4178
4179 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4180 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4181 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4182 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4183 was any debugging information about the routine.
4184
4185 @item step @var{count}
4186 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4187 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4188 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4189
4190 @kindex next
4191 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4192 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4193 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4194 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4195 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4196 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4197 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4198 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4199
4200 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4201
4202
4203 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4204 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4205 @c
4206 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4207 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4208 @c function are executed without stopping.
4209
4210 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4211 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4212 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4213
4214 @kindex set step-mode
4215 @item set step-mode
4216 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4217 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4218 @itemx set step-mode on
4219 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4220 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4221 information rather than stepping over it.
4222
4223 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4224 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4225 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4226
4227 @item set step-mode off
4228 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4229 debug information. This is the default.
4230
4231 @item show step-mode
4232 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4233 source line debug information.
4234
4235 @kindex finish
4236 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4237 @item finish
4238 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4239 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4240 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4241
4242 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4243 ,Returning from a Function}).
4244
4245 @kindex until
4246 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4247 @cindex run until specified location
4248 @item until
4249 @itemx u
4250 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4251 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4252 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4253 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4254 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4255 than the address of the jump.
4256
4257 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4258 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4259 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4260 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4261 through the next iteration.
4262
4263 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4264 stack frame.
4265
4266 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4267 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4268 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4269 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4270 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4271
4272 @smallexample
4273 (@value{GDBP}) f
4274 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4275 206 expand_input();
4276 (@value{GDBP}) until
4277 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4278 @end smallexample
4279
4280 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4281 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4282 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4283 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4284 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4285 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4286 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4287
4288 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4289 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4290 argument.
4291
4292 @item until @var{location}
4293 @itemx u @var{location}
4294 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4295 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4296 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4297 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4298 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4299 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4300 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4301 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4302 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4303 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4304 invocations have returned.
4305
4306 @smallexample
4307 94 int factorial (int value)
4308 95 @{
4309 96 if (value > 1) @{
4310 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4311 98 @}
4312 99 return (value);
4313 100 @}
4314 @end smallexample
4315
4316
4317 @kindex advance @var{location}
4318 @itemx advance @var{location}
4319 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4320 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4321 @ref{Specify Location}.
4322 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4323 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4324 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4325 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4326
4327
4328 @kindex stepi
4329 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4330 @item stepi
4331 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4332 @itemx si
4333 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4334
4335 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4336 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4337 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4338 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4339
4340 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4341
4342 @need 750
4343 @kindex nexti
4344 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4345 @item nexti
4346 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4347 @itemx ni
4348 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4349 proceed until the function returns.
4350
4351 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4352 @end table
4353
4354 @node Signals
4355 @section Signals
4356 @cindex signals
4357
4358 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4359 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4360 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4361 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4362 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4363 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4364 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4365 requested an alarm).
4366
4367 @cindex fatal signals
4368 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4369 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4370 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4371 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4372 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4373 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4374
4375 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4376 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4377 signal.
4378
4379 @cindex handling signals
4380 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4381 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4382 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4383 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4384 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4385
4386 @table @code
4387 @kindex info signals
4388 @kindex info handle
4389 @item info signals
4390 @itemx info handle
4391 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4392 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4393 the defined types of signals.
4394
4395 @item info signals @var{sig}
4396 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4397
4398 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4399
4400 @kindex handle
4401 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4402 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4403 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4404 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4405 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4406 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4407 say what change to make.
4408 @end table
4409
4410 @c @group
4411 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4412 Their full names are:
4413
4414 @table @code
4415 @item nostop
4416 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4417 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4418
4419 @item stop
4420 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4421 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4422
4423 @item print
4424 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4425
4426 @item noprint
4427 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4428 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4429
4430 @item pass
4431 @itemx noignore
4432 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4433 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4434 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4435
4436 @item nopass
4437 @itemx ignore
4438 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4439 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4440 @end table
4441 @c @end group
4442
4443 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4444 program until you
4445 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4446 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4447 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4448 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4449 program sees that signal when you continue.
4450
4451 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4452 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4453 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4454 erroneous signals.
4455
4456 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4457 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4458 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4459 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4460 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4461 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4462 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4463 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4464 Program a Signal}.
4465
4466 @node Thread Stops
4467 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4468
4469 @cindex stopped threads
4470 @cindex threads, stopped
4471
4472 @cindex continuing threads
4473 @cindex threads, continuing
4474
4475 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4476 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4477 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4478 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4479 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4480 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4481 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4482 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4483 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4484
4485 @menu
4486 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4487 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4488 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4489 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4490 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4491 @end menu
4492
4493 @node All-Stop Mode
4494 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4495
4496 @cindex all-stop mode
4497
4498 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4499 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4500 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4501 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4502 underfoot.
4503
4504 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4505 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4506 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4507
4508 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4509 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4510 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4511 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4512 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4513 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4514 stops.
4515
4516 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4517 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4518 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4519 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4520
4521 @cindex automatic thread selection
4522 @cindex switching threads automatically
4523 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4524 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4525 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4526 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4527 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4528 thread.
4529
4530 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4531 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4532
4533 @table @code
4534 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4535 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4536 @cindex lock scheduler
4537 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4538 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4539 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4540 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4541 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4542 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4543 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4544 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4545 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4546 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4547 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4548 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4549
4550 @item show scheduler-locking
4551 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4552 @end table
4553
4554 @node Non-Stop Mode
4555 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
4556
4557 @cindex non-stop mode
4558
4559 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
4560 @c with more details.
4561
4562 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
4563 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
4564 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
4565 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
4566 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
4567 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
4568
4569 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
4570 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
4571 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
4572 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
4573 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
4574 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
4575 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
4576 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
4577 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
4578 independently and simultaneously.
4579
4580 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
4581 or attach to your program:
4582
4583 @smallexample
4584 # Enable the async interface.
4585 set target-async 1
4586
4587 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
4588 set pagination off
4589
4590 # Finally, turn it on!
4591 set non-stop on
4592 @end smallexample
4593
4594 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
4595
4596 @table @code
4597 @kindex set non-stop
4598 @item set non-stop on
4599 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
4600 @item set non-stop off
4601 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
4602 @kindex show non-stop
4603 @item show non-stop
4604 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
4605 @end table
4606
4607 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
4608 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
4609 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
4610 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
4611 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
4612 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
4613 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
4614 default.
4615
4616 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
4617 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
4618 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
4619
4620 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
4621 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
4622 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
4623 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
4624 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
4625
4626 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
4627 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
4628 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
4629 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
4630 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
4631
4632 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
4633
4634 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
4635 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
4636 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
4637 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
4638 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
4639 previously current thread.
4640
4641 @node Background Execution
4642 @subsection Background Execution
4643
4644 @cindex foreground execution
4645 @cindex background execution
4646 @cindex asynchronous execution
4647 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
4648
4649 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
4650 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
4651 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
4652 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
4653 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
4654 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
4655
4656 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
4657 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
4658 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
4659 are:
4660
4661 @table @code
4662 @kindex run&
4663 @item run
4664 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
4665
4666 @item attach
4667 @kindex attach&
4668 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
4669
4670 @item step
4671 @kindex step&
4672 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
4673
4674 @item stepi
4675 @kindex stepi&
4676 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
4677
4678 @item next
4679 @kindex next&
4680 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
4681
4682 @item continue
4683 @kindex continue&
4684 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
4685
4686 @item finish
4687 @kindex finish&
4688 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
4689
4690 @item until
4691 @kindex until&
4692 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
4693
4694 @end table
4695
4696 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
4697 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
4698 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
4699 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
4700 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
4701 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
4702
4703 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
4704 using the @code{interrupt} command.
4705
4706 @table @code
4707 @kindex interrupt
4708 @item interrupt
4709 @itemx interrupt -a
4710
4711 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
4712 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
4713 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
4714 use @code{interrupt -a}.
4715 @end table
4716
4717 You may need to explicitly enable async mode before you can use background
4718 execution commands, with the @code{set target-async 1} command. If the
4719 target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error message
4720 if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
4721
4722 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4723 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4724
4725 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4726 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4727 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4728
4729 @table @code
4730 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4731 @cindex thread breakpoints
4732 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4733 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4734 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4735 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4736 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4737 specify some source line.
4738
4739 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4740 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4741 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4742 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4743 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4744
4745 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4746 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4747 program.
4748
4749 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4750 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4751 breakpoint condition, like this:
4752
4753 @smallexample
4754 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4755 @end smallexample
4756
4757 @end table
4758
4759 @node Interrupted System Calls
4760 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
4761
4762 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4763 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4764 @cindex premature return from system calls
4765 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
4766 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
4767 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4768 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4769 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4770 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4771 stop execution.
4772
4773 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4774 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4775 style anyways.
4776
4777 For example, do not write code like this:
4778
4779 @smallexample
4780 sleep (10);
4781 @end smallexample
4782
4783 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4784 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4785
4786 Instead, write this:
4787
4788 @smallexample
4789 int unslept = 10;
4790 while (unslept > 0)
4791 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4792 @end smallexample
4793
4794 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4795 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4796 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4797 @value{GDBN}.
4798
4799 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4800 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4801 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4802 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4803
4804
4805 @node Reverse Execution
4806 @chapter Running programs backward
4807 @cindex reverse execution
4808 @cindex running programs backward
4809
4810 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
4811 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
4812 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
4813 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
4814
4815 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
4816 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
4817 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
4818 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
4819 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
4820 all target environments can support reverse execution.
4821
4822 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
4823 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
4824 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
4825 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
4826 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
4827 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
4828 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
4829 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
4830 prior values@footnote{
4831 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
4832 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
4833 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
4834
4835 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
4836 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
4837 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
4838 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
4839 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
4840 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
4841 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
4842 }.
4843
4844 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
4845 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
4846
4847 @table @code
4848 @kindex reverse-continue
4849 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
4850 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4851 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4852 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
4853 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
4854 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
4855 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
4856
4857 @kindex reverse-step
4858 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
4859 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4860 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
4861 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
4862
4863 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
4864 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
4865 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
4866 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
4867 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
4868 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
4869
4870 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
4871 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
4872
4873 @kindex reverse-stepi
4874 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
4875 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4876 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
4877 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
4878 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
4879 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
4880 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
4881
4882 @kindex reverse-next
4883 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
4884 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4885 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
4886 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
4887 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
4888 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
4889 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
4890 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
4891 line of a function back to its return to its caller
4892 @footnote{Unles the code is too heavily optimized.}.
4893
4894 @kindex reverse-nexti
4895 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
4896 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4897 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
4898 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
4899 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
4900 another instruction, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
4901 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
4902 frame) is reached.
4903
4904 @kindex reverse-finish
4905 @item reverse-finish
4906 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
4907 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
4908 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
4909 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
4910
4911 @kindex set exec-direction
4912 @item set exec-direction
4913 Set the direction of target execution.
4914 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
4915 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
4916 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
4917 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
4918 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
4919 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
4920 @item set exec-direction forward
4921 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
4922 This is the default.
4923 @end table
4924
4925
4926 @node Stack
4927 @chapter Examining the Stack
4928
4929 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4930 stopped and how it got there.
4931
4932 @cindex call stack
4933 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4934 is generated.
4935 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4936 the arguments of the call,
4937 and the local variables of the function being called.
4938 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4939 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4940 stack}.
4941
4942 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4943 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4944
4945 @cindex selected frame
4946 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4947 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4948 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4949 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4950 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4951 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4952
4953 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4954 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4955 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4956
4957 @menu
4958 * Frames:: Stack frames
4959 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4960 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4961 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4962
4963 @end menu
4964
4965 @node Frames
4966 @section Stack Frames
4967
4968 @cindex frame, definition
4969 @cindex stack frame
4970 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4971 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4972 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4973 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4974 which the function is executing.
4975
4976 @cindex initial frame
4977 @cindex outermost frame
4978 @cindex innermost frame
4979 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4980 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4981 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4982 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4983 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4984 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4985 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4986 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4987
4988 @cindex frame pointer
4989 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4990 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4991 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4992 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4993 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4994 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4995
4996 @cindex frame number
4997 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4998 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4999 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5000 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5001 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5002
5003 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5004 @c underflow problems.
5005 @cindex frameless execution
5006 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5007 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5008 @smallexample
5009 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5010 @end smallexample
5011 generates functions without a frame.)
5012 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5013 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5014 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5015 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5016 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5017 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5018 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5019
5020 @table @code
5021 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5022 @cindex current stack frame
5023 @item frame @var{args}
5024 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5025 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5026 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5027 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5028
5029 @kindex select-frame
5030 @cindex selecting frame silently
5031 @item select-frame
5032 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5033 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5034 @code{frame}.
5035 @end table
5036
5037 @node Backtrace
5038 @section Backtraces
5039
5040 @cindex traceback
5041 @cindex call stack traces
5042 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5043 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5044 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5045 stack.
5046
5047 @table @code
5048 @kindex backtrace
5049 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5050 @item backtrace
5051 @itemx bt
5052 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5053 frames in the stack.
5054
5055 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5056 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5057
5058 @item backtrace @var{n}
5059 @itemx bt @var{n}
5060 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5061
5062 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5063 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5064 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5065
5066 @item backtrace full
5067 @itemx bt full
5068 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5069 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5070 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5071 number of frames to print, as described above.
5072 @end table
5073
5074 @kindex where
5075 @kindex info stack
5076 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5077 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5078
5079 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5080 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5081 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5082 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5083 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5084 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5085 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5086 multi-threaded program.
5087
5088 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5089 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5090 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5091 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5092 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5093 line number.
5094
5095 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5096 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5097
5098 @smallexample
5099 @group
5100 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5101 at builtin.c:993
5102 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
5103 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5104 at macro.c:71
5105 (More stack frames follow...)
5106 @end group
5107 @end smallexample
5108
5109 @noindent
5110 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5111 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5112 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5113
5114 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5115 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5116 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5117 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5118 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5119 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5120 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5121 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5122 such a backtrace might look like:
5123
5124 @smallexample
5125 @group
5126 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5127 at builtin.c:993
5128 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5129 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5130 at macro.c:71
5131 (More stack frames follow...)
5132 @end group
5133 @end smallexample
5134
5135 @noindent
5136 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5137 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5138
5139 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5140 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5141 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5142
5143 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5144 @cindex program entry point
5145 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5146 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5147 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5148 @code{main}@footnote{
5149 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5150 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5151 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5152 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5153 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5154 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5155
5156 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5157 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5158
5159 @table @code
5160 @item set backtrace past-main
5161 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5162 @kindex set backtrace
5163 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5164
5165 @item set backtrace past-main off
5166 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5167 default.
5168
5169 @item show backtrace past-main
5170 @kindex show backtrace
5171 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5172
5173 @item set backtrace past-entry
5174 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5175 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5176 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5177 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5178
5179 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5180 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5181 application. This is the default.
5182
5183 @item show backtrace past-entry
5184 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5185
5186 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5187 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5188 @cindex backtrace limit
5189 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5190 unlimited.
5191
5192 @item show backtrace limit
5193 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5194 @end table
5195
5196 @node Selection
5197 @section Selecting a Frame
5198
5199 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5200 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5201 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5202 of the stack frame just selected.
5203
5204 @table @code
5205 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5206 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5207 @item frame @var{n}
5208 @itemx f @var{n}
5209 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5210 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5211 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5212 @code{main}.
5213
5214 @item frame @var{addr}
5215 @itemx f @var{addr}
5216 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5217 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5218 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5219 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5220 switches between them.
5221
5222 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5223 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5224
5225 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5226 pointer and a program counter.
5227
5228 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5229 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5230
5231 @kindex up
5232 @item up @var{n}
5233 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5234 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5235 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5236
5237 @kindex down
5238 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5239 @item down @var{n}
5240 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5241 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5242 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5243 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5244 @end table
5245
5246 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5247 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5248 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5249 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5250
5251 @need 1000
5252 For example:
5253
5254 @smallexample
5255 @group
5256 (@value{GDBP}) up
5257 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5258 at env.c:10
5259 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5260 @end group
5261 @end smallexample
5262
5263 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5264 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5265 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5266 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5267 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5268 for details.
5269
5270 @table @code
5271 @kindex down-silently
5272 @kindex up-silently
5273 @item up-silently @var{n}
5274 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5275 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5276 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5277 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5278 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5279 distracting.
5280 @end table
5281
5282 @node Frame Info
5283 @section Information About a Frame
5284
5285 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5286 stack frame.
5287
5288 @table @code
5289 @item frame
5290 @itemx f
5291 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5292 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5293 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5294 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5295 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5296
5297 @kindex info frame
5298 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5299 @item info frame
5300 @itemx info f
5301 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5302 including:
5303
5304 @itemize @bullet
5305 @item
5306 the address of the frame
5307 @item
5308 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5309 @item
5310 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5311 @item
5312 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5313 @item
5314 the address of the frame's arguments
5315 @item
5316 the address of the frame's local variables
5317 @item
5318 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5319 @item
5320 which registers were saved in the frame
5321 @end itemize
5322
5323 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5324 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5325 the usual conventions.
5326
5327 @item info frame @var{addr}
5328 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5329 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5330 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5331 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5332 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5333 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5334
5335 @kindex info args
5336 @item info args
5337 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5338
5339 @item info locals
5340 @kindex info locals
5341 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5342 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5343 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5344
5345 @kindex info catch
5346 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5347 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5348 @item info catch
5349 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5350 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5351 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5352 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5353 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5354
5355 @end table
5356
5357
5358 @node Source
5359 @chapter Examining Source Files
5360
5361 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5362 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5363 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5364 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5365 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5366 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5367 source files by explicit command.
5368
5369 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5370 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5371 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5372
5373 @menu
5374 * List:: Printing source lines
5375 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5376 * Edit:: Editing source files
5377 * Search:: Searching source files
5378 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5379 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5380 @end menu
5381
5382 @node List
5383 @section Printing Source Lines
5384
5385 @kindex list
5386 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5387 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5388 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5389 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5390 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5391
5392 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5393
5394 @table @code
5395 @item list @var{linenum}
5396 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5397 current source file.
5398
5399 @item list @var{function}
5400 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5401 @var{function}.
5402
5403 @item list
5404 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5405 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5406 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5407 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5408 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5409
5410 @item list -
5411 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5412 @end table
5413
5414 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5415 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5416 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5417
5418 @table @code
5419 @kindex set listsize
5420 @item set listsize @var{count}
5421 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5422 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5423
5424 @kindex show listsize
5425 @item show listsize
5426 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5427 @end table
5428
5429 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5430 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5431 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5432 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5433 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5434
5435 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5436 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5437 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5438 to specify some source line.
5439
5440 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5441
5442 @table @code
5443 @item list @var{linespec}
5444 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5445
5446 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5447 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5448 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5449 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5450 the same source file as the first linespec.
5451
5452 @item list ,@var{last}
5453 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5454
5455 @item list @var{first},
5456 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5457
5458 @item list +
5459 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5460
5461 @item list -
5462 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5463
5464 @item list
5465 As described in the preceding table.
5466 @end table
5467
5468 @node Specify Location
5469 @section Specifying a Location
5470 @cindex specifying location
5471 @cindex linespec
5472
5473 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5474 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5475 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5476 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5477
5478 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5479 @value{GDBN} understands:
5480
5481 @table @code
5482 @item @var{linenum}
5483 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5484
5485 @item -@var{offset}
5486 @itemx +@var{offset}
5487 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5488 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5489 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5490 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5491 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5492 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5493 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5494 linespec.
5495
5496 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5497 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5498
5499 @item @var{function}
5500 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5501 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5502
5503 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5504 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5505 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5506 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5507 functions in different source files.
5508
5509 @item *@var{address}
5510 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5511 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5512 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5513 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5514 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5515 source files.
5516
5517 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5518 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5519 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5520 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5521 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5522 of @var{address}:
5523
5524 @table @code
5525 @item @var{expression}
5526 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5527
5528 @item @var{funcaddr}
5529 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5530 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5531 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5532 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5533 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5534 (although the Pascal form also works).
5535
5536 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5537 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5538
5539 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5540 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5541 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5542 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5543 functions with identical names in different source files.
5544 @end table
5545
5546 @end table
5547
5548
5549 @node Edit
5550 @section Editing Source Files
5551 @cindex editing source files
5552
5553 @kindex edit
5554 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5555 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5556 The editing program of your choice
5557 is invoked with the current line set to
5558 the active line in the program.
5559 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5560 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5561
5562 @table @code
5563 @item edit @var{location}
5564 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5565 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5566 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5567 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5568 command most commonly used:
5569
5570 @table @code
5571 @item edit @var{number}
5572 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5573
5574 @item edit @var{function}
5575 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5576 @end table
5577
5578 @end table
5579
5580 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5581 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5582 @footnote{
5583 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5584 following command-line syntax:
5585 @smallexample
5586 ex +@var{number} file
5587 @end smallexample
5588 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5589 the file where to start editing.}.
5590 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5591 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5592 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5593 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5594 @smallexample
5595 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5596 export EDITOR
5597 gdb @dots{}
5598 @end smallexample
5599 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5600 @smallexample
5601 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5602 gdb @dots{}
5603 @end smallexample
5604
5605 @node Search
5606 @section Searching Source Files
5607 @cindex searching source files
5608
5609 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5610 regular expression.
5611
5612 @table @code
5613 @kindex search
5614 @kindex forward-search
5615 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5616 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5617 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5618 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5619 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5620 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5621 @code{fo}.
5622
5623 @kindex reverse-search
5624 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5625 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5626 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5627 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5628 this command as @code{rev}.
5629 @end table
5630
5631 @node Source Path
5632 @section Specifying Source Directories
5633
5634 @cindex source path
5635 @cindex directories for source files
5636 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5637 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5638 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5639 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5640 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5641 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5642 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5643
5644 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5645 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5646 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5647 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5648 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5649 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5650 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5651 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5652 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5653 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5654 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5655
5656 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5657 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5658 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5659 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5660 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5661 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5662
5663 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5664 source files.
5665
5666 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5667 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5668 each line is in the file.
5669
5670 @kindex directory
5671 @kindex dir
5672 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5673 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5674 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5675
5676 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5677 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5678
5679 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5680 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5681 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5682 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5683 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5684 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5685 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5686 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5687 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5688 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5689 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5690 name to look up the sources.
5691
5692 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5693 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5694 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5695 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5696 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5697 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5698 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5699 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5700
5701 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5702 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5703 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5704 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5705 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5706 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5707 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5708
5709 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5710 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5711 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5712 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5713 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5714 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5715 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5716 command.
5717
5718 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5719 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5720 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5721 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5722 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5723 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5724 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5725
5726 @table @code
5727 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5728 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5729 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5730 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5731 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5732 part of absolute file names) or
5733 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5734 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5735
5736 @kindex cdir
5737 @kindex cwd
5738 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5739 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5740 @cindex compilation directory
5741 @cindex current directory
5742 @cindex working directory
5743 @cindex directory, current
5744 @cindex directory, compilation
5745 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5746 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5747 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5748 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5749 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5750 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5751
5752 @item directory
5753 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5754
5755 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5756 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5757
5758 @item show directories
5759 @kindex show directories
5760 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5761
5762 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5763 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5764 @kindex set substitute-path
5765 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5766 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5767 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5768
5769 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5770 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5771
5772 @smallexample
5773 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5774 @end smallexample
5775
5776 @noindent
5777 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5778 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5779 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5780
5781 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5782 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5783 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5784 the substitution.
5785
5786 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5787
5788 @smallexample
5789 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5790 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5791 @end smallexample
5792
5793 @noindent
5794 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5795 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5796 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5797 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5798
5799
5800 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5801 @kindex unset substitute-path
5802 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5803 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5804 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5805
5806 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5807
5808 @item show substitute-path [path]
5809 @kindex show substitute-path
5810 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5811 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5812
5813 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5814 rules.
5815
5816 @end table
5817
5818 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5819 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5820 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5821
5822 @enumerate
5823 @item
5824 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5825
5826 @item
5827 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5828 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5829 directories in one command.
5830 @end enumerate
5831
5832 @node Machine Code
5833 @section Source and Machine Code
5834 @cindex source line and its code address
5835
5836 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5837 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5838 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5839 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5840 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5841 well as hex.
5842
5843 @table @code
5844 @kindex info line
5845 @item info line @var{linespec}
5846 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5847 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5848 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5849 @end table
5850
5851 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5852 the object code for the first line of function
5853 @code{m4_changequote}:
5854
5855 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5856 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5857 @smallexample
5858 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5859 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5860 @end smallexample
5861
5862 @noindent
5863 @cindex code address and its source line
5864 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5865 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5866 @smallexample
5867 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5868 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5869 @end smallexample
5870
5871 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5872 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5873 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5874 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5875 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5876 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5877 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5878 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5879 Variables}).
5880
5881 @table @code
5882 @kindex disassemble
5883 @cindex assembly instructions
5884 @cindex instructions, assembly
5885 @cindex machine instructions
5886 @cindex listing machine instructions
5887 @item disassemble
5888 @itemx disassemble /m
5889 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5890 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
5891 the @code{/m} modifier.
5892 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5893 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5894 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5895 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5896 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5897 @end table
5898
5899 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5900 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5901
5902 @smallexample
5903 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5904 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5905 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5906 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5907 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5908 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5909 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5910 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5911 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5912 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5913 End of assembler dump.
5914 @end smallexample
5915
5916 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
5917
5918 @smallexample
5919 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
5920 Dump of assembler code for function main:
5921 5 @{
5922 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
5923 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
5924 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
5925 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
5926 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
5927
5928 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
5929 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
5930 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
5931
5932 7 return 0;
5933 8 @}
5934 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
5935 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
5936 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
5937
5938 End of assembler dump.
5939 @end smallexample
5940
5941 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5942 mnemonics or other syntax.
5943
5944 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5945 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5946 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5947 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5948 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5949
5950 @table @code
5951 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5952 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5953 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5954 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5955 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5956 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5957
5958 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5959 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5960 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5961 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5962
5963 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5964 @item show disassembly-flavor
5965 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5966 @end table
5967
5968
5969 @node Data
5970 @chapter Examining Data
5971
5972 @cindex printing data
5973 @cindex examining data
5974 @kindex print
5975 @kindex inspect
5976 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5977 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5978 @c different window or something like that.
5979 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5980 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5981 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5982 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5983 Different Languages}).
5984
5985 @table @code
5986 @item print @var{expr}
5987 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5988 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5989 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5990 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5991 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5992 Formats}.
5993
5994 @item print
5995 @itemx print /@var{f}
5996 @cindex reprint the last value
5997 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5998 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5999 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6000 @end table
6001
6002 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6003 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6004 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6005
6006 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6007 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6008 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6009 Table}.
6010
6011 @menu
6012 * Expressions:: Expressions
6013 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6014 * Variables:: Program variables
6015 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6016 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6017 * Memory:: Examining memory
6018 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6019 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6020 * Value History:: Value history
6021 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6022 * Registers:: Registers
6023 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6024 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6025 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6026 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6027 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6028 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6029 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6030 character set than GDB does
6031 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6032 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6033 @end menu
6034
6035 @node Expressions
6036 @section Expressions
6037
6038 @cindex expressions
6039 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6040 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6041 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6042 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6043 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6044 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6045 @ref{Compilation}.
6046
6047 @cindex arrays in expressions
6048 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6049 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6050 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6051 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6052 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6053 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6054
6055 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6056 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6057 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6058 languages.
6059
6060 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6061 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6062
6063 @cindex casts, in expressions
6064 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6065 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6066 at that address in memory.
6067 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6068
6069 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6070 to programming languages:
6071
6072 @table @code
6073 @item @@
6074 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6075 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6076
6077 @item ::
6078 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6079 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6080
6081 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6082 @cindex type casting memory
6083 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6084 @cindex casts, to view memory
6085 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6086 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6087 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6088 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6089 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6090 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6091 @end table
6092
6093 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6094 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6095 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6096
6097 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6098 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6099 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6100 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6101 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6102 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6103 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6104
6105 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6106 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6107 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6108 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6109 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6110 as well.
6111
6112 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6113 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6114 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6115 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6116 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6117 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6118 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6119 choices.
6120
6121 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6122 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6123 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6124
6125 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6126 @smallexample
6127 @group
6128 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6129 [0] cancel
6130 [1] all
6131 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6132 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6133 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6134 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6135 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6136 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6137 > 2 4 6
6138 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6139 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6140 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6141 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6142 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6143 breakpoints.
6144 (@value{GDBP})
6145 @end group
6146 @end smallexample
6147
6148 @table @code
6149 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6150 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6151 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6152
6153 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6154 is ambiguous.
6155
6156 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6157 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6158 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6159 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6160 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6161 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6162 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6163 in the use of the menu.
6164
6165 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6166 when an ambiguity is detected.
6167
6168 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6169 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6170
6171 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6172 @item show multiple-symbols
6173 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6174 @end table
6175
6176 @node Variables
6177 @section Program Variables
6178
6179 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6180 in your program.
6181
6182 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6183 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6184
6185 @itemize @bullet
6186 @item
6187 global (or file-static)
6188 @end itemize
6189
6190 @noindent or
6191
6192 @itemize @bullet
6193 @item
6194 visible according to the scope rules of the
6195 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6196 @end itemize
6197
6198 @noindent This means that in the function
6199
6200 @smallexample
6201 foo (a)
6202 int a;
6203 @{
6204 bar (a);
6205 @{
6206 int b = test ();
6207 bar (b);
6208 @}
6209 @}
6210 @end smallexample
6211
6212 @noindent
6213 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6214 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6215 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6216 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6217
6218 @cindex variable name conflict
6219 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6220 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6221 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6222 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6223 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6224 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6225 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6226
6227 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6228 @ifnotinfo
6229 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6230 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6231 @end ifnotinfo
6232 @smallexample
6233 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6234 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6235 @end smallexample
6236
6237 @noindent
6238 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6239 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6240 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6241 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6242
6243 @smallexample
6244 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6245 @end smallexample
6246
6247 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6248 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6249 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6250 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6251 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6252 @c conflict?? --mew
6253
6254 @cindex wrong values
6255 @cindex variable values, wrong
6256 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6257 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6258 @quotation
6259 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6260 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6261 scope, and just before exit.
6262 @end quotation
6263 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6264 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6265 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6266 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6267 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6268 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6269 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6270 variable definitions may be gone.
6271
6272 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6273 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6274 when compiling.
6275
6276 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6277 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6278 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6279 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6280 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6281 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6282 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6283
6284 @smallexample
6285 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6286 @end smallexample
6287
6288 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6289 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6290 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6291 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6292 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6293 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6294 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6295 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6296 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6297 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6298 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6299
6300 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6301 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6302 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6303 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6304
6305 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6306 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6307 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6308 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6309 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6310 For program code
6311
6312 @smallexample
6313 char var0[] = "A";
6314 signed char var1[] = "A";
6315 @end smallexample
6316
6317 You get during debugging
6318 @smallexample
6319 (gdb) print var0
6320 $1 = "A"
6321 (gdb) print var1
6322 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6323 @end smallexample
6324
6325 @node Arrays
6326 @section Artificial Arrays
6327
6328 @cindex artificial array
6329 @cindex arrays
6330 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
6331 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
6332 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
6333 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
6334 program.
6335
6336 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
6337 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6338 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6339 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6340 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6341 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6342 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6343 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6344 example. If a program says
6345
6346 @smallexample
6347 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6348 @end smallexample
6349
6350 @noindent
6351 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6352
6353 @smallexample
6354 p *array@@len
6355 @end smallexample
6356
6357 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6358 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6359 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6360 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6361 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6362
6363 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6364 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6365 The value need not be in memory:
6366 @smallexample
6367 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6368 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6369 @end smallexample
6370
6371 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6372 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6373 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6374 @smallexample
6375 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6376 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6377 @end smallexample
6378
6379 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6380 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6381 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6382 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6383 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6384 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6385 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6386 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6387 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6388 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6389
6390 @smallexample
6391 set $i = 0
6392 p dtab[$i++]->fv
6393 @key{RET}
6394 @key{RET}
6395 @dots{}
6396 @end smallexample
6397
6398 @node Output Formats
6399 @section Output Formats
6400
6401 @cindex formatted output
6402 @cindex output formats
6403 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6404 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6405 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6406 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6407 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6408
6409 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6410 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6411 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6412 letters supported are:
6413
6414 @table @code
6415 @item x
6416 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6417 hexadecimal.
6418
6419 @item d
6420 Print as integer in signed decimal.
6421
6422 @item u
6423 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6424
6425 @item o
6426 Print as integer in octal.
6427
6428 @item t
6429 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6430 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6431 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6432 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6433
6434 @item a
6435 @cindex unknown address, locating
6436 @cindex locate address
6437 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6438 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6439 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6440
6441 @smallexample
6442 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6443 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6444 @end smallexample
6445
6446 @noindent
6447 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6448 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6449
6450 @item c
6451 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6452 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6453 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6454 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6455
6456 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6457 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6458 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6459 data.
6460
6461 @item f
6462 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6463 using typical floating point syntax.
6464
6465 @item s
6466 @cindex printing strings
6467 @cindex printing byte arrays
6468 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6469 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6470 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6471 natural types.
6472
6473 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6474 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6475 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6476 array.
6477 @end table
6478
6479 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6480
6481 @smallexample
6482 p/x $pc
6483 @end smallexample
6484
6485 @noindent
6486 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6487 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6488
6489 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6490 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6491 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6492
6493 @node Memory
6494 @section Examining Memory
6495
6496 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6497 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6498
6499 @cindex examining memory
6500 @table @code
6501 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6502 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6503 @itemx x @var{addr}
6504 @itemx x
6505 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6506 @end table
6507
6508 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6509 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6510 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6511 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6512 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6513
6514 @table @r
6515 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6516 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6517 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6518 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6519 @c 4.1.2.
6520
6521 @item @var{f}, the display format
6522 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6523 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6524 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6525 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6526 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6527
6528 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6529 The unit size is any of
6530
6531 @table @code
6532 @item b
6533 Bytes.
6534 @item h
6535 Halfwords (two bytes).
6536 @item w
6537 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6538 @item g
6539 Giant words (eight bytes).
6540 @end table
6541
6542 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6543 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6544 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6545
6546 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6547 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6548 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6549 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6550 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6551 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6552 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6553 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6554 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6555 a value from memory).
6556 @end table
6557
6558 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6559 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6560 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6561 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6562 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6563
6564 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6565 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6566 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6567 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6568 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6569
6570 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6571 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6572 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6573 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6574 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6575 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6576 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6577 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6578 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6579
6580 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6581 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6582 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6583 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6584 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6585 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6586 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6587
6588 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6589 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6590 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6591 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6592 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6593 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6594 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6595 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6596 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6597
6598 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6599 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6600 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6601
6602 @cindex remote memory comparison
6603 @cindex verify remote memory image
6604 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6605 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6606 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6607 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6608 situations.
6609
6610 @table @code
6611 @kindex compare-sections
6612 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6613 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6614 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6615 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6616 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6617 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6618 remote request.
6619 @end table
6620
6621 @node Auto Display
6622 @section Automatic Display
6623 @cindex automatic display
6624 @cindex display of expressions
6625
6626 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6627 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6628 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6629 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6630 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6631 The automatic display looks like this:
6632
6633 @smallexample
6634 2: foo = 38
6635 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6636 @end smallexample
6637
6638 @noindent
6639 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6640 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6641 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6642 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6643 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6644 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6645
6646 @table @code
6647 @kindex display
6648 @item display @var{expr}
6649 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6650 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6651
6652 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6653
6654 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6655 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6656 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6657 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6658 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6659
6660 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6661 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6662 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6663 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6664 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6665 @end table
6666
6667 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6668 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6669 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6670
6671 @table @code
6672 @kindex delete display
6673 @kindex undisplay
6674 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6675 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6676 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6677
6678 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6679 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6680
6681 @kindex disable display
6682 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6683 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6684 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6685 enabled again later.
6686
6687 @kindex enable display
6688 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6689 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6690 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6691
6692 @item display
6693 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6694 done when your program stops.
6695
6696 @kindex info display
6697 @item info display
6698 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6699 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6700 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6701 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6702 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6703 @end table
6704
6705 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6706 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6707 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6708 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6709 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6710 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6711 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6712 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6713 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6714 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6715 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6716
6717 @node Print Settings
6718 @section Print Settings
6719
6720 @cindex format options
6721 @cindex print settings
6722 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6723 and symbols are printed.
6724
6725 @noindent
6726 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6727
6728 @table @code
6729 @kindex set print
6730 @item set print address
6731 @itemx set print address on
6732 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6733 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6734 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6735 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6736 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6737 @code{set print address on}:
6738
6739 @smallexample
6740 @group
6741 (@value{GDBP}) f
6742 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6743 at input.c:530
6744 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6745 @end group
6746 @end smallexample
6747
6748 @item set print address off
6749 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6750 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6751
6752 @smallexample
6753 @group
6754 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6755 (@value{GDBP}) f
6756 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6757 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6758 @end group
6759 @end smallexample
6760
6761 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6762 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6763 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6764 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6765
6766 @kindex show print
6767 @item show print address
6768 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6769 @end table
6770
6771 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6772 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6773 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6774 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6775 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6776 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6777 it prints a symbolic address:
6778
6779 @table @code
6780 @item set print symbol-filename on
6781 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6782 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6783 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6784 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6785
6786 @item set print symbol-filename off
6787 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6788 default.
6789
6790 @item show print symbol-filename
6791 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6792 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6793 @end table
6794
6795 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6796 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6797 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6798
6799 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6800 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6801
6802 @table @code
6803 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6804 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6805 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6806 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6807 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6808 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6809
6810 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6811 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6812 symbolic address.
6813 @end table
6814
6815 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6816 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6817 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6818 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6819 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6820 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6821 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6822 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6823
6824 @smallexample
6825 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6826 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6827 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6828 @end smallexample
6829
6830 @quotation
6831 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6832 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6833 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6834 @end quotation
6835
6836 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6837
6838 @table @code
6839 @item set print array
6840 @itemx set print array on
6841 @cindex pretty print arrays
6842 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6843 but uses more space. The default is off.
6844
6845 @item set print array off
6846 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6847
6848 @item show print array
6849 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6850 arrays.
6851
6852 @cindex print array indexes
6853 @item set print array-indexes
6854 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6855 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6856 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6857 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6858
6859 @item set print array-indexes off
6860 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6861
6862 @item show print array-indexes
6863 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6864 arrays.
6865
6866 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6867 @cindex number of array elements to print
6868 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6869 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6870 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6871 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6872 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6873 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6874 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6875
6876 @item show print elements
6877 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6878 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6879
6880 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6881 @cindex printing frame argument values
6882 @cindex print all frame argument values
6883 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6884 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6885 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6886 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6887 values are:
6888
6889 @table @code
6890 @item all
6891 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6892
6893 @item scalars
6894 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6895 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6896 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6897
6898 @smallexample
6899 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6900 at frame-args.c:23
6901 @end smallexample
6902
6903 @item none
6904 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6905 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6906
6907 @smallexample
6908 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6909 at frame-args.c:23
6910 @end smallexample
6911 @end table
6912
6913 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6914 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6915 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6916 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6917 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6918 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6919 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6920 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6921
6922 @item show print frame-arguments
6923 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6924
6925 @item set print repeats
6926 @cindex repeated array elements
6927 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6928 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6929 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6930 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6931 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6932 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6933 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6934
6935 @item show print repeats
6936 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6937 elements.
6938
6939 @item set print null-stop
6940 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6941 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6942 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6943 contain only short strings.
6944 The default is off.
6945
6946 @item show print null-stop
6947 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6948 @sc{null} character.
6949
6950 @item set print pretty on
6951 @cindex print structures in indented form
6952 @cindex indentation in structure display
6953 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6954 per line, like this:
6955
6956 @smallexample
6957 @group
6958 $1 = @{
6959 next = 0x0,
6960 flags = @{
6961 sweet = 1,
6962 sour = 1
6963 @},
6964 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6965 @}
6966 @end group
6967 @end smallexample
6968
6969 @item set print pretty off
6970 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6971
6972 @smallexample
6973 @group
6974 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6975 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6976 @end group
6977 @end smallexample
6978
6979 @noindent
6980 This is the default format.
6981
6982 @item show print pretty
6983 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6984
6985 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6986 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6987 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6988 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6989 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6990 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6991 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6992 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6993
6994 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6995 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6996 international character sets, and is the default.
6997
6998 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6999 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7000
7001 @item set print union on
7002 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7003 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7004 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7005
7006 @item set print union off
7007 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7008 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7009 instead.
7010
7011 @item show print union
7012 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7013 structures and other unions.
7014
7015 For example, given the declarations
7016
7017 @smallexample
7018 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7019 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7020 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7021 Bug_forms;
7022
7023 struct thing @{
7024 Species it;
7025 union @{
7026 Tree_forms tree;
7027 Bug_forms bug;
7028 @} form;
7029 @};
7030
7031 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7032 @end smallexample
7033
7034 @noindent
7035 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7036
7037 @smallexample
7038 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7039 @end smallexample
7040
7041 @noindent
7042 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7043
7044 @smallexample
7045 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7046 @end smallexample
7047
7048 @noindent
7049 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7050 and in Pascal.
7051 @end table
7052
7053 @need 1000
7054 @noindent
7055 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7056
7057 @table @code
7058 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7059 @item set print demangle
7060 @itemx set print demangle on
7061 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7062 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7063 linkage. The default is on.
7064
7065 @item show print demangle
7066 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7067
7068 @item set print asm-demangle
7069 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
7070 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7071 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7072 The default is off.
7073
7074 @item show print asm-demangle
7075 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7076 or demangled form.
7077
7078 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7079 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7080 @kindex set demangle-style
7081 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7082 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7083 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7084
7085 @table @code
7086 @item auto
7087 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7088
7089 @item gnu
7090 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7091 This is the default.
7092
7093 @item hp
7094 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7095
7096 @item lucid
7097 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7098
7099 @item arm
7100 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7101 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7102 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7103 require further enhancement to permit that.
7104
7105 @end table
7106 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7107
7108 @item show demangle-style
7109 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7110
7111 @item set print object
7112 @itemx set print object on
7113 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7114 @cindex display derived types
7115 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7116 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7117 the virtual function table.
7118
7119 @item set print object off
7120 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7121 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7122
7123 @item show print object
7124 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7125
7126 @item set print static-members
7127 @itemx set print static-members on
7128 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7129 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7130
7131 @item set print static-members off
7132 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7133
7134 @item show print static-members
7135 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7136
7137 @item set print pascal_static-members
7138 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7139 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7140 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7141 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7142
7143 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7144 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7145
7146 @item show print pascal_static-members
7147 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7148
7149 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7150 @item set print vtbl
7151 @itemx set print vtbl on
7152 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7153 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7154 @cindex VTBL display
7155 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7156 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7157 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7158
7159 @item set print vtbl off
7160 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7161
7162 @item show print vtbl
7163 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7164 @end table
7165
7166 @node Value History
7167 @section Value History
7168
7169 @cindex value history
7170 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7171 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7172 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7173 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7174 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7175 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7176 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7177 symbol table.
7178
7179 @cindex @code{$}
7180 @cindex @code{$$}
7181 @cindex history number
7182 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7183 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7184 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7185 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7186 history number.
7187
7188 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7189 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7190 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7191 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7192 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7193 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7194 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7195
7196 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7197 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7198
7199 @smallexample
7200 p *$
7201 @end smallexample
7202
7203 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7204 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7205
7206 @smallexample
7207 p *$.next
7208 @end smallexample
7209
7210 @noindent
7211 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7212 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7213
7214 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7215 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7216
7217 @smallexample
7218 print x
7219 set x=5
7220 @end smallexample
7221
7222 @noindent
7223 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7224 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7225
7226 @table @code
7227 @kindex show values
7228 @item show values
7229 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7230 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7231 values} does not change the history.
7232
7233 @item show values @var{n}
7234 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7235
7236 @item show values +
7237 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7238 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7239 @end table
7240
7241 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7242 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7243
7244 @node Convenience Vars
7245 @section Convenience Variables
7246
7247 @cindex convenience variables
7248 @cindex user-defined variables
7249 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7250 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7251 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7252 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7253 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7254
7255 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7256 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7257 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7258 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7259 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7260
7261 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7262 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7263 For example:
7264
7265 @smallexample
7266 set $foo = *object_ptr
7267 @end smallexample
7268
7269 @noindent
7270 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7271 @code{object_ptr}.
7272
7273 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7274 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7275 value with another assignment at any time.
7276
7277 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7278 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7279 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7280 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7281
7282 @table @code
7283 @kindex show convenience
7284 @cindex show all user variables
7285 @item show convenience
7286 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7287 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7288
7289 @kindex init-if-undefined
7290 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7291 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7292 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7293 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7294 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7295 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7296 override default values used in a command script.
7297
7298 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7299 any side-effects do not occur.
7300 @end table
7301
7302 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
7303 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
7304 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
7305
7306 @smallexample
7307 set $i = 0
7308 print bar[$i++]->contents
7309 @end smallexample
7310
7311 @noindent
7312 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
7313
7314 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
7315 values likely to be useful.
7316
7317 @table @code
7318 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
7319 @item $_
7320 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
7321 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
7322 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
7323 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
7324 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
7325 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
7326 to the type of @code{$__}.
7327
7328 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
7329 @item $__
7330 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
7331 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
7332 to match the format in which the data was printed.
7333
7334 @item $_exitcode
7335 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
7336 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
7337 the program being debugged terminates.
7338 @end table
7339
7340 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7341 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7342 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7343
7344 @node Registers
7345 @section Registers
7346
7347 @cindex registers
7348 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7349 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7350 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7351 your machine.
7352
7353 @table @code
7354 @kindex info registers
7355 @item info registers
7356 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7357 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7358
7359 @kindex info all-registers
7360 @cindex floating point registers
7361 @item info all-registers
7362 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7363 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7364
7365 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7366 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7367 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7368 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7369 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7370 @end table
7371
7372 @cindex stack pointer register
7373 @cindex program counter register
7374 @cindex process status register
7375 @cindex frame pointer register
7376 @cindex standard registers
7377 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7378 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7379 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7380 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7381 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7382 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7383 register that contains the processor status. For example,
7384 you could print the program counter in hex with
7385
7386 @smallexample
7387 p/x $pc
7388 @end smallexample
7389
7390 @noindent
7391 or print the instruction to be executed next with
7392
7393 @smallexample
7394 x/i $pc
7395 @end smallexample
7396
7397 @noindent
7398 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7399 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7400 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7401 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7402 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7403 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7404 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7405
7406 @smallexample
7407 set $sp += 4
7408 @end smallexample
7409
7410 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7411 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7412 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7413 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7414 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7415 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7416 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7417
7418 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7419 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7420 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7421 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7422 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7423 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7424 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7425
7426 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7427 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7428 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7429 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7430 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7431 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7432 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7433 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7434 prints the data in both formats.
7435
7436 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7437 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7438 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7439 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7440 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7441 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7442 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7443
7444 @smallexample
7445 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7446 $1 = @{
7447 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7448 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7449 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7450 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7451 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7452 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7453 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7454 @}
7455 @end smallexample
7456
7457 @noindent
7458 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7459 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7460 value to a @code{struct} member:
7461
7462 @smallexample
7463 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7464 @end smallexample
7465
7466 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7467 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7468 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7469 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7470 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7471 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7472
7473 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7474 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7475 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7476 frame makes no difference.
7477
7478 @node Floating Point Hardware
7479 @section Floating Point Hardware
7480 @cindex floating point
7481
7482 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7483 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7484
7485 @table @code
7486 @kindex info float
7487 @item info float
7488 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7489 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7490 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7491 the ARM and x86 machines.
7492 @end table
7493
7494 @node Vector Unit
7495 @section Vector Unit
7496 @cindex vector unit
7497
7498 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7499 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7500
7501 @table @code
7502 @kindex info vector
7503 @item info vector
7504 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7505 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7506 @end table
7507
7508 @node OS Information
7509 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7510 @cindex OS information
7511
7512 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7513 you debug your program.
7514
7515 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7516 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7517 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7518 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7519 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7520 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7521 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7522 structure.
7523
7524 @table @code
7525 @item info udot
7526 @kindex info udot
7527 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7528 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7529 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7530 the @code{examine} command.
7531 @end table
7532
7533 @cindex auxiliary vector
7534 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7535 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7536 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7537 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7538 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7539 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7540 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7541 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7542 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7543 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7544 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7545 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7546
7547 @table @code
7548 @kindex info auxv
7549 @item info auxv
7550 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7551 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7552 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7553 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7554 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7555 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7556 an unrecognized tag.
7557 @end table
7558
7559 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
7560 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
7561 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
7562 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
7563
7564 @table @code
7565 @kindex info os processes
7566 @item info os processes
7567 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
7568 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
7569 the command corresponding to the process.
7570 @end table
7571
7572 @node Memory Region Attributes
7573 @section Memory Region Attributes
7574 @cindex memory region attributes
7575
7576 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7577 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7578 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7579 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7580 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7581 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7582 user can override the fetched regions.
7583
7584 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7585 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7586 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7587 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7588 all memory.
7589
7590 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7591 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7592
7593 @table @code
7594 @kindex mem
7595 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7596 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7597 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7598 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7599 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7600 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7601
7602 @item mem auto
7603 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7604 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7605
7606 @kindex delete mem
7607 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7608 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7609 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7610
7611 @kindex disable mem
7612 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7613 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7614 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7615 It may be enabled again later.
7616
7617 @kindex enable mem
7618 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7619 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7620
7621 @kindex info mem
7622 @item info mem
7623 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7624 for each region:
7625
7626 @table @emph
7627 @item Memory Region Number
7628 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7629 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7630 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7631
7632 @item Lo Address
7633 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7634
7635 @item Hi Address
7636 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7637
7638 @item Attributes
7639 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7640 @end table
7641 @end table
7642
7643
7644 @subsection Attributes
7645
7646 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7647 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7648 write accesses to a memory region.
7649
7650 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7651 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7652 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7653
7654 @table @code
7655 @item ro
7656 Memory is read only.
7657 @item wo
7658 Memory is write only.
7659 @item rw
7660 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7661 @end table
7662
7663 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7664 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7665 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7666 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7667 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7668
7669 @table @code
7670 @item 8
7671 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7672 @item 16
7673 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7674 @item 32
7675 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7676 @item 64
7677 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7678 @end table
7679
7680 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7681 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7682 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7683 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7684 @c
7685 @c @table @code
7686 @c @item hwbreak
7687 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7688 @c @item swbreak (default)
7689 @c @end table
7690
7691 @subsubsection Data Cache
7692 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7693 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7694 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7695 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7696 registers.
7697
7698 @table @code
7699 @item cache
7700 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7701 @item nocache
7702 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7703 @end table
7704
7705 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7706 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7707 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7708 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7709 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7710
7711 @table @code
7712 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7713 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7714 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7715 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7716 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7717 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7718 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7719 The default value is @code{on}.
7720 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7721 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7722 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7723 @end table
7724
7725
7726 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7727 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7728 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7729 @c
7730 @c @table @code
7731 @c @item verify
7732 @c @item noverify (default)
7733 @c @end table
7734
7735 @node Dump/Restore Files
7736 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7737 @cindex dump/restore files
7738 @cindex append data to a file
7739 @cindex dump data to a file
7740 @cindex restore data from a file
7741
7742 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7743 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7744 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7745 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7746 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7747 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7748 files.
7749
7750 @table @code
7751
7752 @kindex dump
7753 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7754 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7755 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7756 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7757
7758 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7759 @table @code
7760 @item binary
7761 Raw binary form.
7762 @item ihex
7763 Intel hex format.
7764 @item srec
7765 Motorola S-record format.
7766 @item tekhex
7767 Tektronix Hex format.
7768 @end table
7769
7770 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7771 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7772 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7773 form.
7774
7775 @kindex append
7776 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7777 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7778 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7779 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7780 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7781
7782 @kindex restore
7783 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7784 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7785 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7786 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7787 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7788
7789 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7790 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7791 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7792 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7793 from that location.
7794
7795 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7796 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7797 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7798 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7799
7800 @end table
7801
7802 @node Core File Generation
7803 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7804 @cindex dump core from inferior
7805
7806 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7807 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7808 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7809 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7810 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7811 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7812 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7813
7814 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7815 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7816 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7817
7818 @table @code
7819 @kindex gcore
7820 @kindex generate-core-file
7821 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7822 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7823 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7824 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7825 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7826 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7827
7828 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7829 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7830 @end table
7831
7832 @node Character Sets
7833 @section Character Sets
7834 @cindex character sets
7835 @cindex charset
7836 @cindex translating between character sets
7837 @cindex host character set
7838 @cindex target character set
7839
7840 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7841 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7842 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7843 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7844 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7845 @dfn{target character set}.
7846
7847 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7848 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7849 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7850 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7851 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7852 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7853 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7854 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7855 character and string literals in expressions.
7856
7857 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7858 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7859 target-charset} command, described below.
7860
7861 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7862 support:
7863
7864 @table @code
7865 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7866 @kindex set target-charset
7867 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7868 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7869 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7870 list the target character sets it supports.
7871 @end table
7872
7873 @table @code
7874 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7875 @kindex set host-charset
7876 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7877
7878 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7879 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7880 @code{set host-charset} command.
7881
7882 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7883 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7884 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7885 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7886 list the host character sets it supports.
7887
7888 @item set charset @var{charset}
7889 @kindex set charset
7890 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7891 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7892 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7893 for both host and target.
7894
7895
7896 @item show charset
7897 @kindex show charset
7898 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7899
7900 @itemx show host-charset
7901 @kindex show host-charset
7902 Show the name of the current host charset.
7903
7904 @itemx show target-charset
7905 @kindex show target-charset
7906 Show the name of the current target charset.
7907
7908 @end table
7909
7910 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7911 sets:
7912
7913 @table @code
7914
7915 @item ASCII
7916 @cindex ASCII character set
7917 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7918 character set.
7919
7920 @item ISO-8859-1
7921 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7922 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7923 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7924 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7925 this as its host character set.
7926
7927 @item EBCDIC-US
7928 @itemx IBM1047
7929 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7930 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7931 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7932 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7933 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7934
7935 @end table
7936
7937 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7938 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7939 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7940
7941 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7942 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7943 @file{charset-test.c}:
7944
7945 @smallexample
7946 #include <stdio.h>
7947
7948 char ascii_hello[]
7949 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7950 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7951 char ibm1047_hello[]
7952 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7953 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7954
7955 main ()
7956 @{
7957 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7958 @}
7959 @end smallexample
7960
7961 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7962 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7963 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7964
7965 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7966
7967 @smallexample
7968 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7969 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7970 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7971 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7972 @dots{}
7973 (@value{GDBP})
7974 @end smallexample
7975
7976 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7977 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7978 strings:
7979
7980 @smallexample
7981 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7982 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7983 (@value{GDBP})
7984 @end smallexample
7985
7986 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7987 initial character set:
7988 @smallexample
7989 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7990 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7991 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7992 (@value{GDBP})
7993 @end smallexample
7994
7995 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7996 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7997 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7998 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7999 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8000
8001 @smallexample
8002 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8003 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8004 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8005 $2 = 72 'H'
8006 (@value{GDBP})
8007 @end smallexample
8008
8009 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8010 literals you use in expressions:
8011
8012 @smallexample
8013 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8014 $3 = 43 '+'
8015 (@value{GDBP})
8016 @end smallexample
8017
8018 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8019 character.
8020
8021 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8022 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8023 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8024
8025 @smallexample
8026 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8027 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8028 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8029 $5 = 200 '\310'
8030 (@value{GDBP})
8031 @end smallexample
8032
8033 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8034 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8035
8036 @smallexample
8037 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8038 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8039 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8040 @end smallexample
8041
8042 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8043 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8044 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8045 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8046 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8047
8048 @smallexample
8049 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8050 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8051 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8052 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8053 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8054 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8055 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8056 $7 = 72 '\110'
8057 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8058 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8059 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8060 $9 = 200 'H'
8061 (@value{GDBP})
8062 @end smallexample
8063
8064 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8065 string literals you use in expressions:
8066
8067 @smallexample
8068 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8069 $10 = 78 '+'
8070 (@value{GDBP})
8071 @end smallexample
8072
8073 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8074 character.
8075
8076 @node Caching Remote Data
8077 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8078 @cindex caching data of remote targets
8079
8080 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
8081 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8082 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8083 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
8084 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
8085 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
8086 volatile registers are in use.
8087
8088 @table @code
8089 @kindex set remotecache
8090 @item set remotecache on
8091 @itemx set remotecache off
8092 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
8093 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
8094
8095 @kindex show remotecache
8096 @item show remotecache
8097 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
8098
8099 @kindex info dcache
8100 @item info dcache
8101 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8102 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
8103 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
8104 state (invalid, dirty, valid). This command is useful for debugging
8105 the data cache operation.
8106 @end table
8107
8108 @node Searching Memory
8109 @section Search Memory
8110 @cindex searching memory
8111
8112 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8113 @code{find} command.
8114
8115 @table @code
8116 @kindex find
8117 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8118 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8119 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8120 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8121 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8122 @end table
8123
8124 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8125 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8126
8127 @table @r
8128 @item @var{s}, search query size
8129 The size of each search query value.
8130
8131 @table @code
8132 @item b
8133 bytes
8134 @item h
8135 halfwords (two bytes)
8136 @item w
8137 words (four bytes)
8138 @item g
8139 giant words (eight bytes)
8140 @end table
8141
8142 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8143 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8144 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8145
8146 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8147 value's type in the current language.
8148 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8149 pattern as a mixture of types.
8150 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8151 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8152 which is typically four bytes.
8153
8154 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8155 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8156 @end table
8157
8158 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8159 (@code{"}).
8160 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8161 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8162
8163 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8164 number of matches found.
8165
8166 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8167 @samp{$_}.
8168 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8169
8170 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8171
8172 @smallexample
8173 void
8174 hello ()
8175 @{
8176 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8177 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8178 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8179 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8180 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8181 @}
8182 @end smallexample
8183
8184 @noindent
8185 you get during debugging:
8186
8187 @smallexample
8188 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8189 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8190 1 pattern found
8191 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8192 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8193 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8194 2 patterns found
8195 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8196 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8197 1 pattern found
8198 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8199 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8200 1 pattern found
8201 (gdb) print $numfound
8202 $1 = 1
8203 (gdb) print $_
8204 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8205 @end smallexample
8206
8207 @node Macros
8208 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
8209
8210 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
8211 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
8212 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
8213 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
8214 where it was defined.
8215
8216 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
8217 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
8218 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
8219 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
8220
8221 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
8222 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
8223 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
8224 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
8225 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
8226 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
8227 see @ref{List}.
8228
8229 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
8230 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
8231 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
8232
8233 @table @code
8234
8235 @kindex macro expand
8236 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
8237 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
8238 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
8239 @item macro expand @var{expression}
8240 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
8241 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
8242 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
8243 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
8244 it can be any string of tokens.
8245
8246 @kindex macro exp1
8247 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
8248 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
8249 @cindex expand macro once
8250 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
8251 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
8252 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
8253 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
8254 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
8255 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
8256 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
8257 can be any string of tokens.
8258
8259 @kindex info macro
8260 @cindex macro definition, showing
8261 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
8262 @item info macro @var{macro}
8263 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
8264 source location where that definition was established.
8265
8266 @kindex macro define
8267 @cindex user-defined macros
8268 @cindex defining macros interactively
8269 @cindex macros, user-defined
8270 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
8271 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
8272 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
8273 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
8274 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
8275 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
8276 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
8277 @var{arglist}.
8278
8279 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
8280 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
8281 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
8282 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
8283 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
8284
8285 @kindex macro undef
8286 @item macro undef @var{macro}
8287 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
8288 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
8289 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
8290 in the program being debugged.
8291
8292 @kindex macro list
8293 @item macro list
8294 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
8295 @end table
8296
8297 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
8298 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
8299 show our source files:
8300
8301 @smallexample
8302 $ cat sample.c
8303 #include <stdio.h>
8304 #include "sample.h"
8305
8306 #define M 42
8307 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8308
8309 main ()
8310 @{
8311 #define N 28
8312 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8313 #undef N
8314 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8315 #define N 1729
8316 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8317 @}
8318 $ cat sample.h
8319 #define Q <
8320 $
8321 @end smallexample
8322
8323 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
8324 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
8325 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
8326 information.
8327
8328 @smallexample
8329 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
8330 $
8331 @end smallexample
8332
8333 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
8334
8335 @smallexample
8336 $ gdb -nw sample
8337 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
8338 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8339 GDB is free software, @dots{}
8340 (@value{GDBP})
8341 @end smallexample
8342
8343 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8344 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8345 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8346
8347 @smallexample
8348 (@value{GDBP}) list main
8349 3
8350 4 #define M 42
8351 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8352 6
8353 7 main ()
8354 8 @{
8355 9 #define N 28
8356 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8357 11 #undef N
8358 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8359 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8360 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8361 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8362 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8363 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8364 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8365 #define Q <
8366 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8367 expands to: (42 + 1)
8368 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8369 expands to: once (M + 1)
8370 (@value{GDBP})
8371 @end smallexample
8372
8373 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
8374 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8375 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8376 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8377
8378 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8379 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8380
8381 @smallexample
8382 (@value{GDBP}) break main
8383 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8384 (@value{GDBP}) run
8385 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8386
8387 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
8388 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8389 (@value{GDBP})
8390 @end smallexample
8391
8392 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8393
8394 @smallexample
8395 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8396 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8397 #define N 28
8398 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8399 expands to: 28 < 42
8400 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8401 $1 = 1
8402 (@value{GDBP})
8403 @end smallexample
8404
8405 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8406 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8407 thereof) in force at each point:
8408
8409 @smallexample
8410 (@value{GDBP}) next
8411 Hello, world!
8412 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8413 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8414 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8415 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8416 (@value{GDBP}) next
8417 We're so creative.
8418 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8419 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8420 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8421 #define N 1729
8422 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8423 expands to: 1729 < 42
8424 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8425 $2 = 0
8426 (@value{GDBP})
8427 @end smallexample
8428
8429
8430 @node Tracepoints
8431 @chapter Tracepoints
8432 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8433 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8434
8435 @cindex tracepoints
8436 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8437 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8438 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8439 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8440 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8441 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8442 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8443
8444 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8445 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8446 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8447 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8448 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8449 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8450 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8451 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8452 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8453 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8454 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8455
8456 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8457 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8458 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8459 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8460 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8461 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8462 Packets}.
8463
8464 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8465
8466 @menu
8467 * Set Tracepoints::
8468 * Analyze Collected Data::
8469 * Tracepoint Variables::
8470 @end menu
8471
8472 @node Set Tracepoints
8473 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8474
8475 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8476 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
8477 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
8478 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
8479 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
8480 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
8481 work on.
8482
8483 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8484 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8485 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8486 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8487 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8488 tracepoint was hit.
8489
8490 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8491 conditions and actions.
8492
8493 @menu
8494 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8495 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8496 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8497 * Tracepoint Actions::
8498 * Listing Tracepoints::
8499 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8500 @end menu
8501
8502 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8503 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8504
8505 @table @code
8506 @cindex set tracepoint
8507 @kindex trace
8508 @item trace
8509 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8510 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
8511 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
8512 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
8513 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
8514 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
8515 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
8516 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
8517 running.
8518
8519 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8520
8521 @smallexample
8522 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8523
8524 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8525
8526 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8527
8528 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8529
8530 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8531 @end smallexample
8532
8533 @noindent
8534 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8535
8536 @vindex $tpnum
8537 @cindex last tracepoint number
8538 @cindex recent tracepoint number
8539 @cindex tracepoint number
8540 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8541 of the most recently set tracepoint.
8542
8543 @kindex delete tracepoint
8544 @cindex tracepoint deletion
8545 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8546 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8547 default is to delete all tracepoints.
8548
8549 Examples:
8550
8551 @smallexample
8552 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8553
8554 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8555 @end smallexample
8556
8557 @noindent
8558 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8559 @end table
8560
8561 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8562 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8563
8564 @table @code
8565 @kindex disable tracepoint
8566 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8567 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8568 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8569 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8570 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8571
8572 @kindex enable tracepoint
8573 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8574 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8575 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8576 run.
8577 @end table
8578
8579 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8580 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8581
8582 @table @code
8583 @kindex passcount
8584 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8585 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8586 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8587 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8588 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8589 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8590 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8591 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8592 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8593 user.
8594
8595 Examples:
8596
8597 @smallexample
8598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8599 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8600
8601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8602 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8603 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8605 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8606 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8607 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8608 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8609 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8610 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8611 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8612 @end smallexample
8613 @end table
8614
8615 @node Tracepoint Actions
8616 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8617
8618 @table @code
8619 @kindex actions
8620 @cindex tracepoint actions
8621 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8622 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8623 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8624 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8625 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8626 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8627 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8628 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8629 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8630 @code{while-stepping}.
8631
8632 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8633 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8634 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8635
8636 @smallexample
8637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8638
8639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8640
8641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8642 @end smallexample
8643
8644 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8645 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8646 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8647 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8648 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8649 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8650 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8651 @code{end} command.
8652
8653 @smallexample
8654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8655 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8656 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8657 > collect bar,baz
8658 > collect $regs
8659 > while-stepping 12
8660 > collect $fp, $sp
8661 > end
8662 end
8663 @end smallexample
8664
8665 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8666 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8667 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8668 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8669 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8670 special arguments are supported:
8671
8672 @table @code
8673 @item $regs
8674 collect all registers
8675
8676 @item $args
8677 collect all function arguments
8678
8679 @item $locals
8680 collect all local variables.
8681 @end table
8682
8683 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8684 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8685 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8686
8687 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8688 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8689
8690 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8691 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8692 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8693 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8694 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8695 its own @code{end} command):
8696
8697 @smallexample
8698 > while-stepping 12
8699 > collect $regs, myglobal
8700 > end
8701 >
8702 @end smallexample
8703
8704 @noindent
8705 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8706 @code{stepping}.
8707 @end table
8708
8709 @node Listing Tracepoints
8710 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8711
8712 @table @code
8713 @kindex info tracepoints
8714 @kindex info tp
8715 @cindex information about tracepoints
8716 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8717 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8718 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8719 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8720 shown:
8721
8722 @itemize @bullet
8723 @item
8724 its number
8725 @item
8726 whether it is enabled or disabled
8727 @item
8728 its address
8729 @item
8730 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8731 @item
8732 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8733 @item
8734 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8735 @item
8736 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8737 @end itemize
8738
8739 @smallexample
8740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8741 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8742 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8743 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8744 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8745 (@value{GDBP})
8746 @end smallexample
8747
8748 @noindent
8749 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8750 @end table
8751
8752 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8753 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8754
8755 @table @code
8756 @kindex tstart
8757 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8758 @cindex collected data discarded
8759 @item tstart
8760 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8761 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8762 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8763 experiment.
8764
8765 @kindex tstop
8766 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8767 @item tstop
8768 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8769 stops collecting data.
8770
8771 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8772 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8773 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8774
8775 @kindex tstatus
8776 @cindex status of trace data collection
8777 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8778 @item tstatus
8779 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8780 collection.
8781 @end table
8782
8783 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8784
8785 @smallexample
8786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8787 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8788 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8789 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8790 > while-stepping 11
8791 > collect $regs
8792 > end
8793 > end
8794 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8795 [time passes @dots{}]
8796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8797 @end smallexample
8798
8799
8800 @node Analyze Collected Data
8801 @section Using the Collected Data
8802
8803 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8804 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8805 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8806 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8807 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8808 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8809 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8810 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8811 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8812 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8813 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8814 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8815 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8816 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8817 the buffer will fail.
8818
8819 @menu
8820 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8821 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8822 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8823 @end menu
8824
8825 @node tfind
8826 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8827
8828 @kindex tfind
8829 @cindex select trace snapshot
8830 @cindex find trace snapshot
8831 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8832 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8833 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8834 snapshot is selected.
8835
8836 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8837
8838 @table @code
8839 @item tfind start
8840 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8841 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8842
8843 @item tfind none
8844 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8845
8846 @item tfind end
8847 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8848
8849 @item tfind
8850 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8851
8852 @item tfind -
8853 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8854 retracing earlier steps.
8855
8856 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8857 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8858 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8859 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8860 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8861
8862 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8863 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8864 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8865 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8866 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8867
8868 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8869 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8870 addresses.
8871
8872 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8873 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8874 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8875
8876 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8877 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8878 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8879 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8880 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8881 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8882 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8883 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8884 @end table
8885
8886 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8887 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8888 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8889 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8890 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8891 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8892 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8893 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8894 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8895 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8896 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8897 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8898 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8899 tracepoint as the current one.
8900
8901 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8902 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8903 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8904 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8905 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8906
8907 @smallexample
8908 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8909 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8910 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8911 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8912 > tfind
8913 > end
8914
8915 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8916 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8917 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8918 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8919 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8920 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8921 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8922 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8923 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8924 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8925 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8926 @end smallexample
8927
8928 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8929 the buffer:
8930
8931 @smallexample
8932 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8933 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8934 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8935 > tfind line
8936 > end
8937
8938 Frame 0, X = 1
8939 Frame 7, X = 2
8940 Frame 13, X = 255
8941 @end smallexample
8942
8943 @node tdump
8944 @subsection @code{tdump}
8945 @kindex tdump
8946 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8947 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8948
8949 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8950 the current trace snapshot.
8951
8952 @smallexample
8953 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8954 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8955 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8956 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8957 > end
8958
8959 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8960
8961 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8962 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8963 at gdb_test.c:444
8964 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8965
8966 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8967 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8968 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8969 d1 0x18 24
8970 d2 0x80 128
8971 d3 0x33 51
8972 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8973 d5 0x22 34
8974 d6 0xe0 224
8975 d7 0x380035 3670069
8976 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8977 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8978 a2 0x100 256
8979 a3 0x322000 3284992
8980 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8981 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8982 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8983 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8984 ps 0x0 0
8985 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8986 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8987 fpstatus 0x0 0
8988 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8989 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8990 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8991 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8992 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8993 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8994 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8995 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8996 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8997
8998 (@value{GDBP})
8999 @end smallexample
9000
9001 @node save-tracepoints
9002 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
9003 @kindex save-tracepoints
9004 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
9005
9006 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
9007 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
9008 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
9009 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
9010 Files}).
9011
9012 @node Tracepoint Variables
9013 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
9014 @cindex tracepoint variables
9015 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
9016
9017 @table @code
9018 @vindex $trace_frame
9019 @item (int) $trace_frame
9020 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
9021 snapshot is selected.
9022
9023 @vindex $tracepoint
9024 @item (int) $tracepoint
9025 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
9026
9027 @vindex $trace_line
9028 @item (int) $trace_line
9029 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
9030
9031 @vindex $trace_file
9032 @item (char []) $trace_file
9033 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
9034
9035 @vindex $trace_func
9036 @item (char []) $trace_func
9037 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
9038 @end table
9039
9040 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
9041 use @code{output} instead.
9042
9043 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
9044 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
9045 data.
9046
9047 @smallexample
9048 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9049
9050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
9051 > output $trace_file
9052 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
9053 > tfind
9054 > end
9055 @end smallexample
9056
9057 @node Overlays
9058 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
9059 @cindex overlays
9060
9061 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
9062 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
9063 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
9064 use overlays.
9065
9066 @menu
9067 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
9068 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
9069 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
9070 mapped by asking the inferior.
9071 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
9072 @end menu
9073
9074 @node How Overlays Work
9075 @section How Overlays Work
9076 @cindex mapped overlays
9077 @cindex unmapped overlays
9078 @cindex load address, overlay's
9079 @cindex mapped address
9080 @cindex overlay area
9081
9082 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
9083 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
9084 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
9085 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
9086 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
9087
9088 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
9089 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
9090 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
9091 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
9092 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
9093 largest overlay as well.
9094
9095 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
9096 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
9097 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
9098 there.
9099
9100 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
9101 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
9102 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
9103
9104 @smallexample
9105 @group
9106 Data Instruction Larger
9107 Address Space Address Space Address Space
9108 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
9109 | | | | | |
9110 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
9111 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
9112 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
9113 | and heap | | | | | |
9114 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
9115 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
9116 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
9117 | | | | | |
9118 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
9119 address | | | | | |
9120 | overlay | <-' | | |
9121 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
9122 | | <---. | | load address
9123 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
9124 | | | |
9125 +-----------+ | |
9126 +-----------+
9127 | |
9128 +-----------+
9129
9130 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
9131 @end group
9132 @end smallexample
9133
9134 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
9135 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
9136 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
9137 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
9138 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
9139 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
9140 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
9141 program and the overlay area.
9142
9143 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
9144 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
9145 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
9146 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
9147 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
9148 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
9149 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
9150
9151 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
9152 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
9153 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
9154
9155 @itemize @bullet
9156
9157 @item
9158 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
9159 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
9160 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
9161 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
9162
9163 @item
9164 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
9165 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
9166 your program's performance.
9167
9168 @item
9169 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
9170 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
9171 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
9172 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
9173 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
9174 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
9175 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
9176
9177 @item
9178 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
9179 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
9180 instruction and data spaces.
9181
9182 @end itemize
9183
9184 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
9185 improved in many ways:
9186
9187 @itemize @bullet
9188
9189 @item
9190 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
9191 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
9192 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
9193 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
9194 area in the usual way.
9195
9196 @item
9197 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
9198 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
9199
9200 @item
9201 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
9202 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
9203 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
9204 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
9205 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
9206 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
9207 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
9208
9209 @end itemize
9210
9211
9212 @node Overlay Commands
9213 @section Overlay Commands
9214
9215 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
9216 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
9217 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
9218 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
9219 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
9220 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
9221
9222 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
9223 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
9224
9225 @table @code
9226 @item overlay off
9227 @kindex overlay
9228 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
9229 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
9230 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
9231 overlay support is disabled.
9232
9233 @item overlay manual
9234 @cindex manual overlay debugging
9235 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9236 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
9237 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
9238 commands described below.
9239
9240 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
9241 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
9242 @cindex map an overlay
9243 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
9244 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
9245 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
9246 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
9247 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
9248 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
9249
9250 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
9251 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
9252 @cindex unmap an overlay
9253 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
9254 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
9255 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
9256 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
9257
9258 @item overlay auto
9259 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9260 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
9261 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
9262 Overlay Debugging}.
9263
9264 @item overlay load-target
9265 @itemx overlay load
9266 @cindex reloading the overlay table
9267 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
9268 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
9269 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
9270 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
9271 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
9272
9273 @item overlay list-overlays
9274 @itemx overlay list
9275 @cindex listing mapped overlays
9276 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
9277 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
9278
9279 @end table
9280
9281 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
9282 of the function the address falls in:
9283
9284 @smallexample
9285 (@value{GDBP}) print main
9286 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
9287 @end smallexample
9288 @noindent
9289 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
9290 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
9291 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
9292 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
9293
9294 @smallexample
9295 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9296 No sections are mapped.
9297 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9298 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
9299 @end smallexample
9300 @noindent
9301 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
9302 name normally:
9303
9304 @smallexample
9305 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9306 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
9307 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
9308 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9309 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
9310 @end smallexample
9311
9312 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
9313 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
9314 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
9315 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
9316 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
9317
9318 @itemize @bullet
9319 @item
9320 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
9321 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
9322 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
9323 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
9324 @item
9325 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
9326 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
9327 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
9328 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
9329 breakpoints properly.
9330 @end itemize
9331
9332
9333 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
9334 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
9335 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
9336
9337 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
9338 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
9339 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
9340 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
9341 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
9342 current state of the overlays.
9343
9344 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9345 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9346
9347 @table @asis
9348
9349 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
9350 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9351
9352 @smallexample
9353 struct
9354 @{
9355 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9356 unsigned long vma;
9357
9358 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9359 unsigned long size;
9360
9361 /* The overlay's load address. */
9362 unsigned long lma;
9363
9364 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9365 zero otherwise. */
9366 unsigned long mapped;
9367 @}
9368 @end smallexample
9369
9370 @item @code{_novlys}:
9371 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9372 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9373
9374 @end table
9375
9376 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9377 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9378 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9379 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9380 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9381 currently mapped.
9382
9383 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9384 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9385 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9386 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9387 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9388 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9389 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9390 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9391 are not being executed.
9392
9393 @node Overlay Sample Program
9394 @section Overlay Sample Program
9395 @cindex overlay example program
9396
9397 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9398 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9399 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9400 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9401 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9402 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9403 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9404
9405 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9406 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9407 suite. The program consists of the following files from
9408 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9409
9410 @table @file
9411 @item overlays.c
9412 The main program file.
9413 @item ovlymgr.c
9414 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9415 @item foo.c
9416 @itemx bar.c
9417 @itemx baz.c
9418 @itemx grbx.c
9419 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9420 @item d10v.ld
9421 @itemx m32r.ld
9422 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9423 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9424 @end table
9425
9426 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9427 cross-compiler like this:
9428
9429 @smallexample
9430 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9431 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9432 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9433 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9434 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9435 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9436 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9437 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9438 @end smallexample
9439
9440 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9441 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9442 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9443
9444
9445 @node Languages
9446 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9447 @cindex languages
9448
9449 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9450 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9451 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9452 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9453 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9454 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9455
9456 @cindex working language
9457 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9458 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9459 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9460 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9461 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9462 language}.
9463
9464 @menu
9465 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9466 * Show:: Displaying the language
9467 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9468 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9469 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9470 @end menu
9471
9472 @node Setting
9473 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9474
9475 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9476 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9477 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9478 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9479 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9480 are printed, etc.
9481
9482 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9483 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9484 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9485 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9486 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9487 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9488 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9489 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9490 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9491 Displaying the Language}.
9492
9493 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9494 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9495 another language. In that case, make the
9496 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9497 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9498 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9499
9500 @menu
9501 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9502 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9503 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9504 @end menu
9505
9506 @node Filenames
9507 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9508
9509 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9510 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9511
9512 @table @file
9513 @item .ada
9514 @itemx .ads
9515 @itemx .adb
9516 @itemx .a
9517 Ada source file.
9518
9519 @item .c
9520 C source file
9521
9522 @item .C
9523 @itemx .cc
9524 @itemx .cp
9525 @itemx .cpp
9526 @itemx .cxx
9527 @itemx .c++
9528 C@t{++} source file
9529
9530 @item .m
9531 Objective-C source file
9532
9533 @item .f
9534 @itemx .F
9535 Fortran source file
9536
9537 @item .mod
9538 Modula-2 source file
9539
9540 @item .s
9541 @itemx .S
9542 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9543 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9544 @end table
9545
9546 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9547 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9548
9549 @node Manually
9550 @subsection Setting the Working Language
9551
9552 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9553 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9554 your program.
9555
9556 @kindex set language
9557 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9558 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9559 a language, such as
9560 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9561 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9562
9563 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9564 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9565 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9566 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9567 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9568 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9569 command such as:
9570
9571 @smallexample
9572 print a = b + c
9573 @end smallexample
9574
9575 @noindent
9576 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9577 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9578 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9579 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9580
9581 @node Automatically
9582 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9583
9584 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9585 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9586 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9587 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9588 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9589 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9590 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9591 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9592 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9593
9594 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9595 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9596 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9597 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9598 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9599
9600 @node Show
9601 @section Displaying the Language
9602
9603 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9604 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9605
9606 @table @code
9607 @item show language
9608 @kindex show language
9609 Display the current working language. This is the
9610 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9611 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9612
9613 @item info frame
9614 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9615 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9616 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9617 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9618 information listed here.
9619
9620 @item info source
9621 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9622 Display the source language of this source file.
9623 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9624 information listed here.
9625 @end table
9626
9627 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9628 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9629 with a language explicitly:
9630
9631 @table @code
9632 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9633 @kindex set extension-language
9634 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9635 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9636
9637 @item info extensions
9638 @kindex info extensions
9639 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9640 @end table
9641
9642 @node Checks
9643 @section Type and Range Checking
9644
9645 @quotation
9646 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9647 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9648 section documents the intended facilities.
9649 @end quotation
9650 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9651
9652 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9653 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9654 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9655 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9656 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9657 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9658 errors when your program is running.
9659
9660 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9661 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9662 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9663 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9664 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9665 automatically based on your program's source language.
9666 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9667 settings of supported languages.
9668
9669 @menu
9670 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9671 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9672 @end menu
9673
9674 @cindex type checking
9675 @cindex checks, type
9676 @node Type Checking
9677 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9678
9679 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9680 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9681 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9682 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9683
9684 @smallexample
9685 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9686 @exdent but
9687 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9688 @end smallexample
9689
9690 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9691 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9692
9693 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9694 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9695 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9696 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9697 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9698 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9699 also issues a warning.
9700
9701 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9702 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9703 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9704 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9705 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9706 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9707
9708 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9709 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9710 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9711 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9712 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9713 details on specific languages.
9714
9715 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9716
9717 @kindex set check type
9718 @kindex show check type
9719 @table @code
9720 @item set check type auto
9721 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9722 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9723 each language.
9724
9725 @item set check type on
9726 @itemx set check type off
9727 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9728 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9729 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9730 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9731 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9732
9733 @item set check type warn
9734 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9735 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9736 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9737 numbers and structures.
9738
9739 @item show type
9740 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9741 is setting it automatically.
9742 @end table
9743
9744 @cindex range checking
9745 @cindex checks, range
9746 @node Range Checking
9747 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9748
9749 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9750 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9751 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9752 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9753 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9754
9755 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9756 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9757 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9758 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9759
9760 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9761 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9762 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9763 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9764 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9765 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9766
9767 @smallexample
9768 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9769 @end smallexample
9770
9771 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9772 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9773 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9774
9775 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9776
9777 @kindex set check range
9778 @kindex show check range
9779 @table @code
9780 @item set check range auto
9781 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9782 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9783 each language.
9784
9785 @item set check range on
9786 @itemx set check range off
9787 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9788 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9789 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9790 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9791
9792 @item set check range warn
9793 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9794 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9795 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9796 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9797 systems).
9798
9799 @item show range
9800 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9801 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9802 @end table
9803
9804 @node Supported Languages
9805 @section Supported Languages
9806
9807 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9808 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9809 @c This is false ...
9810 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9811 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9812 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9813 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9814 language.
9815
9816 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9817 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9818 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9819 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9820 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9821 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9822 language reference or tutorial.
9823
9824 @menu
9825 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9826 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9827 * Fortran:: Fortran
9828 * Pascal:: Pascal
9829 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9830 * Ada:: Ada
9831 @end menu
9832
9833 @node C
9834 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9835
9836 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9837 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9838
9839 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9840 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9841 together.
9842
9843 @cindex C@t{++}
9844 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9845 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9846 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9847 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9848 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9849 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9850 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9851
9852 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9853 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9854 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9855 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9856 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9857 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9858
9859 @menu
9860 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9861 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9862 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9863 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9864 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9865 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9866 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9867 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9868 @end menu
9869
9870 @node C Operators
9871 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9872
9873 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9874
9875 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9876 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9877 often defined on groups of types.
9878
9879 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9880
9881 @itemize @bullet
9882
9883 @item
9884 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9885 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9886
9887 @item
9888 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9889 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9890
9891 @item
9892 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9893
9894 @item
9895 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9896
9897 @end itemize
9898
9899 @noindent
9900 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9901 in order of increasing precedence:
9902
9903 @table @code
9904 @item ,
9905 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9906 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9907 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9908
9909 @item =
9910 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9911 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9912
9913 @item @var{op}=
9914 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9915 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9916 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9917 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9918 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9919
9920 @item ?:
9921 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9922 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9923 integral type.
9924
9925 @item ||
9926 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9927
9928 @item &&
9929 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9930
9931 @item |
9932 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9933
9934 @item ^
9935 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9936
9937 @item &
9938 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9939
9940 @item ==@r{, }!=
9941 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9942 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9943
9944 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9945 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9946 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9947 and non-zero for true.
9948
9949 @item <<@r{, }>>
9950 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9951
9952 @item @@
9953 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9954
9955 @item +@r{, }-
9956 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9957 pointer types.
9958
9959 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9960 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9961 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9962 integral types.
9963
9964 @item ++@r{, }--
9965 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9966 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9967 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9968 operation takes place.
9969
9970 @item *
9971 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9972 @code{++}.
9973
9974 @item &
9975 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9976
9977 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9978 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9979 to examine the address
9980 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9981 stored.
9982
9983 @item -
9984 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9985 precedence as @code{++}.
9986
9987 @item !
9988 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9989 @code{++}.
9990
9991 @item ~
9992 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9993 @code{++}.
9994
9995
9996 @item .@r{, }->
9997 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9998 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9999 pointer based on the stored type information.
10000 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
10001
10002 @item .*@r{, }->*
10003 Dereferences of pointers to members.
10004
10005 @item []
10006 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
10007 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10008
10009 @item ()
10010 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10011
10012 @item ::
10013 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
10014 and @code{class} types.
10015
10016 @item ::
10017 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
10018 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
10019 above.
10020 @end table
10021
10022 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
10023 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
10024 predefined meaning.
10025
10026 @node C Constants
10027 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
10028
10029 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
10030
10031 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
10032 following ways:
10033
10034 @itemize @bullet
10035 @item
10036 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
10037 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
10038 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
10039 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
10040 @code{long} value.
10041
10042 @item
10043 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
10044 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
10045 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
10046 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
10047 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
10048 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
10049 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
10050 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
10051 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
10052 constant.
10053
10054 @item
10055 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
10056 integral equivalents.
10057
10058 @item
10059 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
10060 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
10061 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
10062 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
10063 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
10064 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
10065 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
10066 @samp{\n} for newline.
10067
10068 @item
10069 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
10070 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
10071 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
10072 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
10073 characters.
10074
10075 @item
10076 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
10077 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
10078
10079 @item
10080 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
10081 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
10082 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
10083 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
10084 @end itemize
10085
10086 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
10087 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
10088
10089 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
10090 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
10091
10092 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
10093 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
10094 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
10095 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
10096 @quotation
10097 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
10098 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
10099 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
10100 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
10101 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
10102 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
10103 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
10104 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
10105 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
10106 C@t{++} code.
10107 @end quotation
10108
10109 @enumerate
10110
10111 @cindex member functions
10112 @item
10113 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
10114
10115 @smallexample
10116 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
10117 @end smallexample
10118
10119 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
10120 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
10121 @item
10122 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
10123 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
10124 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
10125 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
10126
10127 @cindex call overloaded functions
10128 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
10129 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
10130 @item
10131 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
10132 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
10133 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
10134 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
10135 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
10136 default arguments.
10137
10138 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
10139 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
10140 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
10141 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
10142 number of function arguments.
10143
10144 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
10145 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
10146 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
10147
10148 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
10149 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
10150 @smallexample
10151 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
10152 @end smallexample
10153
10154 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
10155 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
10156
10157 @cindex reference declarations
10158 @item
10159 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
10160 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
10161 dereferenced.
10162
10163 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
10164 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
10165 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
10166 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
10167 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
10168
10169 @item
10170 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
10171 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
10172 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
10173 necessary, for example in an expression like
10174 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
10175 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
10176 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
10177 @end enumerate
10178
10179 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
10180 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
10181 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
10182 invoking user-defined operators.
10183
10184 @node C Defaults
10185 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
10186
10187 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
10188
10189 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
10190 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
10191 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10192 selects the working language.
10193
10194 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
10195 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
10196 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
10197 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
10198 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
10199 for further details.
10200
10201 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
10202 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
10203 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
10204
10205 @node C Checks
10206 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
10207
10208 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
10209
10210 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
10211 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
10212 considers two variables type equivalent if:
10213
10214 @itemize @bullet
10215 @item
10216 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
10217 enumerated tag.
10218
10219 @item
10220 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
10221 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
10222
10223 @ignore
10224 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
10225 @c FIXME--beers?
10226 @item
10227 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
10228 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
10229 compilers.)
10230 @end ignore
10231 @end itemize
10232
10233 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
10234 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
10235 that is not itself an array.
10236
10237 @node Debugging C
10238 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
10239
10240 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
10241 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
10242 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
10243 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
10244
10245 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
10246 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
10247 ,Expressions}.
10248
10249 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
10250 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
10251
10252 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
10253
10254 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
10255 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
10256
10257 @table @code
10258 @cindex break in overloaded functions
10259 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
10260 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
10261 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
10262 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
10263 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
10264
10265 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
10266 @item rbreak @var{regex}
10267 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
10268 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
10269 classes.
10270 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
10271
10272 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
10273 @item catch throw
10274 @itemx catch catch
10275 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
10276 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
10277
10278 @cindex inheritance
10279 @item ptype @var{typename}
10280 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
10281 @var{typename}.
10282 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
10283
10284 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
10285 @item set print demangle
10286 @itemx show print demangle
10287 @itemx set print asm-demangle
10288 @itemx show print asm-demangle
10289 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
10290 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
10291 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10292
10293 @item set print object
10294 @itemx show print object
10295 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
10296 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10297
10298 @item set print vtbl
10299 @itemx show print vtbl
10300 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
10301 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10302 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10303 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10304
10305 @kindex set overload-resolution
10306 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
10307 @item set overload-resolution on
10308 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
10309 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
10310 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
10311 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
10312 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
10313 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
10314
10315 @item set overload-resolution off
10316 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
10317 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10318 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
10319 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
10320 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10321 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
10322 argument types.
10323
10324 @kindex show overload-resolution
10325 @item show overload-resolution
10326 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
10327
10328 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
10329 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
10330 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
10331 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
10332 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
10333 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
10334 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
10335 @end table
10336
10337 @node Decimal Floating Point
10338 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
10339 @cindex decimal floating point format
10340
10341 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
10342 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
10343 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10344 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10345
10346 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10347 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10348 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10349 target.
10350
10351 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10352 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10353 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10354
10355 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10356 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10357 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10358
10359 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10360 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
10361 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10362
10363 @node Objective-C
10364 @subsection Objective-C
10365
10366 @cindex Objective-C
10367 This section provides information about some commands and command
10368 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10369 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10370 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10371
10372 @menu
10373 * Method Names in Commands::
10374 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
10375 @end menu
10376
10377 @node Method Names in Commands
10378 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10379
10380 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10381 names as line specifications:
10382
10383 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10384 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10385 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10386 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10387 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10388 @itemize
10389 @item @code{clear}
10390 @item @code{break}
10391 @item @code{info line}
10392 @item @code{jump}
10393 @item @code{list}
10394 @end itemize
10395
10396 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10397
10398 @smallexample
10399 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10400 @end smallexample
10401
10402 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10403 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10404 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10405 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10406 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10407 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10408 debugged, enter:
10409
10410 @smallexample
10411 break -[Fruit create]
10412 @end smallexample
10413
10414 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10415 enter:
10416
10417 @smallexample
10418 list +[NSText initialize]
10419 @end smallexample
10420
10421 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10422 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10423 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10424 is also possible to specify just a method name:
10425
10426 @smallexample
10427 break create
10428 @end smallexample
10429
10430 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10431 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10432 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10433 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10434 none apply.
10435
10436 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10437 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10438
10439 @smallexample
10440 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10441 @end smallexample
10442
10443 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10444 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10445 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10446 @kindex print-object
10447 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10448
10449 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10450
10451 @smallexample
10452 print -[@var{object} hash]
10453 @end smallexample
10454
10455 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10456 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10457 @noindent
10458 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10459 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10460 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10461 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10462 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10463 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10464
10465 @node Fortran
10466 @subsection Fortran
10467 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10468
10469 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10470 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10471
10472 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10473 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10474 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10475 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10476 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10477 underscore.
10478
10479 @menu
10480 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10481 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10482 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10483 @end menu
10484
10485 @node Fortran Operators
10486 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10487
10488 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10489
10490 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10491 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10492 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10493
10494 @table @code
10495 @item **
10496 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10497 of the second one.
10498
10499 @item :
10500 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10501 represent a section of array.
10502
10503 @item %
10504 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10505 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10506 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10507 union type.
10508 @end table
10509
10510 @node Fortran Defaults
10511 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10512
10513 @cindex Fortran Defaults
10514
10515 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10516 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10517 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10518 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10519
10520 @node Special Fortran Commands
10521 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10522
10523 @cindex Special Fortran commands
10524
10525 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10526 such as displaying common blocks.
10527
10528 @table @code
10529 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10530 @kindex info common
10531 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10532 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10533 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10534 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10535 printed.
10536 @end table
10537
10538 @node Pascal
10539 @subsection Pascal
10540
10541 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10542 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10543 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10544 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10545 syntax.
10546
10547 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10548 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10549 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10550
10551 @node Modula-2
10552 @subsection Modula-2
10553
10554 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10555
10556 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10557 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10558 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10559 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10560 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10561 table.
10562
10563 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
10564 @menu
10565 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10566 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10567 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10568 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10569 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10570 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10571 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10572 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10573 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10574 @end menu
10575
10576 @node M2 Operators
10577 @subsubsection Operators
10578 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10579
10580 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10581 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10582 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10583 following definitions hold:
10584
10585 @itemize @bullet
10586
10587 @item
10588 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10589 their subranges.
10590
10591 @item
10592 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10593
10594 @item
10595 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10596
10597 @item
10598 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10599 @var{type}}.
10600
10601 @item
10602 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10603
10604 @item
10605 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10606
10607 @item
10608 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10609 @end itemize
10610
10611 @noindent
10612 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10613 increasing precedence:
10614
10615 @table @code
10616 @item ,
10617 Function argument or array index separator.
10618
10619 @item :=
10620 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10621 @var{value}.
10622
10623 @item <@r{, }>
10624 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10625 types.
10626
10627 @item <=@r{, }>=
10628 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10629 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10630 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10631
10632 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10633 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10634 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10635 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10636 comment character.
10637
10638 @item IN
10639 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10640 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10641
10642 @item OR
10643 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10644
10645 @item AND@r{, }&
10646 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10647
10648 @item @@
10649 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10650
10651 @item +@r{, }-
10652 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10653 and difference on set types.
10654
10655 @item *
10656 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10657 on set types.
10658
10659 @item /
10660 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10661 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10662
10663 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10664 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10665 precedence as @code{*}.
10666
10667 @item -
10668 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10669
10670 @item ^
10671 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10672
10673 @item NOT
10674 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10675 @code{^}.
10676
10677 @item .
10678 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10679 precedence as @code{^}.
10680
10681 @item []
10682 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10683
10684 @item ()
10685 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10686 as @code{^}.
10687
10688 @item ::@r{, }.
10689 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10690 @end table
10691
10692 @quotation
10693 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10694 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10695 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10696 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10697 @end quotation
10698
10699
10700 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10701 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10702 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10703
10704 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10705 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10706
10707 @table @var
10708
10709 @item a
10710 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10711
10712 @item c
10713 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10714
10715 @item i
10716 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10717
10718 @item m
10719 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10720 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10721 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10722
10723 @item n
10724 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10725
10726 @item r
10727 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10728
10729 @item t
10730 represents a type.
10731
10732 @item v
10733 represents a variable.
10734
10735 @item x
10736 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10737 explanation of the function for details.
10738 @end table
10739
10740 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10741
10742 @table @code
10743 @item ABS(@var{n})
10744 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10745
10746 @item CAP(@var{c})
10747 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10748 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10749
10750 @item CHR(@var{i})
10751 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10752
10753 @item DEC(@var{v})
10754 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10755
10756 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10757 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10758 new value.
10759
10760 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10761 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10762 set.
10763
10764 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10765 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10766
10767 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10768 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10769
10770 @item INC(@var{v})
10771 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10772
10773 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10774 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10775 new value.
10776
10777 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10778 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10779 there. Returns the new set.
10780
10781 @item MAX(@var{t})
10782 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10783
10784 @item MIN(@var{t})
10785 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10786
10787 @item ODD(@var{i})
10788 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10789
10790 @item ORD(@var{x})
10791 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10792 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10793 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10794 integral, character and enumerated types.
10795
10796 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10797 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10798
10799 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10800 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10801
10802 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10803 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10804
10805 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10806 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10807 @end table
10808
10809 @quotation
10810 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10811 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10812 an error.
10813 @end quotation
10814
10815 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10816 @node M2 Constants
10817 @subsubsection Constants
10818
10819 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10820 ways:
10821
10822 @itemize @bullet
10823
10824 @item
10825 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10826 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10827 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10828 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10829
10830 @item
10831 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10832 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10833 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10834 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10835 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10836 digits.
10837
10838 @item
10839 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10840 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10841 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10842 followed by a @samp{C}.
10843
10844 @item
10845 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10846 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10847 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10848 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10849 sequences.
10850
10851 @item
10852 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10853
10854 @item
10855 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10856 @code{FALSE}.
10857
10858 @item
10859 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10860
10861 @item
10862 Set constants are not yet supported.
10863 @end itemize
10864
10865 @node M2 Types
10866 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10867 @cindex Modula-2 types
10868
10869 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10870 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10871 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10872 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10873 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10874 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10875
10876 The first example contains the following section of code:
10877
10878 @smallexample
10879 VAR
10880 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10881 r: [20..40] ;
10882 @end smallexample
10883
10884 @noindent
10885 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10886 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10887
10888 @smallexample
10889 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10890 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10891 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10892 SET OF CHAR
10893 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10894 21
10895 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10896 [20..40]
10897 @end smallexample
10898
10899 @noindent
10900 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10901
10902 @smallexample
10903 VAR
10904 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10905 @end smallexample
10906
10907 @noindent
10908 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10909
10910 @smallexample
10911 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10912 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10913 @end smallexample
10914
10915 @noindent
10916 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10917 expressions using the debugger.
10918
10919 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10920 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10921
10922 @smallexample
10923 VAR
10924 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10925 @end smallexample
10926
10927 @smallexample
10928 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10929 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10930 @end smallexample
10931
10932 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10933 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10934 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10935 above.
10936
10937 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10938
10939 @smallexample
10940 TYPE
10941 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10942 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10943 VAR
10944 s: t ;
10945 BEGIN
10946 s := blue ;
10947 @end smallexample
10948
10949 @noindent
10950 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10951 and value of a variable.
10952
10953 @smallexample
10954 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10955 $1 = blue
10956 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10957 type = [blue..yellow]
10958 @end smallexample
10959
10960 @noindent
10961 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10962 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10963 their @code{C} counterparts.
10964
10965 @smallexample
10966 VAR
10967 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10968 BEGIN
10969 s[1] := 1 ;
10970 @end smallexample
10971
10972 @smallexample
10973 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10974 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10975 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10976 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10977 @end smallexample
10978
10979 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10980 pointer types as shown in this example:
10981
10982 @smallexample
10983 VAR
10984 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10985 BEGIN
10986 NEW(s) ;
10987 s^[1] := 1 ;
10988 @end smallexample
10989
10990 @noindent
10991 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10992
10993 @smallexample
10994 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10995 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10996 @end smallexample
10997
10998 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10999 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
11000 types:
11001
11002 @smallexample
11003 TYPE
11004 foo = RECORD
11005 f1: CARDINAL ;
11006 f2: CHAR ;
11007 f3: myarray ;
11008 END ;
11009
11010 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
11011 myrange = [-2..2] ;
11012 VAR
11013 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
11014 @end smallexample
11015
11016 @noindent
11017 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
11018 below.
11019
11020 @smallexample
11021 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11022 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
11023 f1 : CARDINAL;
11024 f2 : CHAR;
11025 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
11026 END
11027 @end smallexample
11028
11029 @node M2 Defaults
11030 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
11031 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
11032
11033 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
11034 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
11035 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11036 selected the working language.
11037
11038 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
11039 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
11040 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
11041 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
11042
11043 @node Deviations
11044 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
11045 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
11046
11047 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
11048 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
11049
11050 @itemize @bullet
11051 @item
11052 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
11053 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
11054 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
11055 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
11056 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
11057 returned a pointer.)
11058
11059 @item
11060 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
11061 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
11062 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
11063 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
11064
11065 @item
11066 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
11067 argument.
11068
11069 @item
11070 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
11071 @end itemize
11072
11073 @node M2 Checks
11074 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
11075 @cindex Modula-2 checks
11076
11077 @quotation
11078 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
11079 range checking.
11080 @end quotation
11081 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
11082
11083 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
11084
11085 @itemize @bullet
11086 @item
11087 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
11088 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
11089
11090 @item
11091 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
11092 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
11093 @end itemize
11094
11095 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
11096 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
11097
11098 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
11099 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
11100
11101 @node M2 Scope
11102 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11103 @cindex scope
11104 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
11105 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
11106 @ifinfo
11107 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
11108 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
11109 @end ifinfo
11110 @ifnotinfo
11111 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
11112 @end ifnotinfo
11113
11114 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
11115 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
11116 similar syntax:
11117
11118 @smallexample
11119
11120 @var{module} . @var{id}
11121 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
11122 @end smallexample
11123
11124 @noindent
11125 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
11126 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
11127 identifier within your program, except another module.
11128
11129 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
11130 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
11131 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
11132 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
11133
11134 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
11135 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
11136 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
11137 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
11138 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
11139 @var{module}.
11140
11141 @node GDB/M2
11142 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11143
11144 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
11145 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
11146 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
11147 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
11148 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
11149 analogue in Modula-2.
11150
11151 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
11152 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
11153 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
11154 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
11155 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
11156 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
11157
11158 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
11159 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
11160 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
11161
11162 @node Ada
11163 @subsection Ada
11164 @cindex Ada
11165
11166 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
11167 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
11168 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
11169 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11170 to be difficult.
11171
11172
11173 @cindex expressions in Ada
11174 @menu
11175 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
11176 and semantics supported by Ada mode
11177 in @value{GDBN}.
11178 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
11179 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
11180 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
11181 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
11182 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11183 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
11184 @end menu
11185
11186 @node Ada Mode Intro
11187 @subsubsection Introduction
11188 @cindex Ada mode, general
11189
11190 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
11191 syntax, with some extensions.
11192 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
11193
11194 @itemize @bullet
11195 @item
11196 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
11197 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
11198 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
11199 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
11200
11201 @item
11202 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
11203 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11204
11205 @item
11206 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11207 @end itemize
11208
11209 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
11210 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
11211 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
11212 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
11213 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
11214
11215 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
11216 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
11217 was translated from an Ada source file.
11218
11219 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
11220 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
11221 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
11222 middle (to allow based literals).
11223
11224 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
11225 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
11226 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
11227 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
11228 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
11229 functions to procedures elsewhere.
11230
11231 @node Omissions from Ada
11232 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
11233 @cindex Ada, omissions from
11234
11235 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
11236
11237 @itemize @bullet
11238 @item
11239 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
11240
11241 @itemize @minus
11242 @item
11243 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
11244 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
11245
11246 @item
11247 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
11248
11249 @item
11250 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
11251
11252 @item
11253 @t{'Tag}.
11254
11255 @item
11256 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
11257 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
11258
11259 @item
11260 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
11261 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
11262
11263 @item
11264 @t{'Address}.
11265 @end itemize
11266
11267 @item
11268 The names in
11269 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
11270 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
11271 not currently available.
11272
11273 @item
11274 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
11275 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
11276 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
11277 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
11278 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
11279 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
11280 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
11281 indeterminate values.
11282
11283 @item
11284 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
11285 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
11286 are not implemented.
11287
11288 @item
11289 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
11290 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
11291 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
11292 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
11293 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
11294
11295 @smallexample
11296 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
11297 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
11298 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
11299 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
11300 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
11301 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
11302 @end smallexample
11303
11304 Changing a
11305 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
11306 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
11307 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
11308 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
11309 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
11310 declared to have a type such as:
11311
11312 @smallexample
11313 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
11314 Id : Integer;
11315 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
11316 end record;
11317 @end smallexample
11318
11319 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
11320 assignments:
11321
11322 @smallexample
11323 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
11324 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
11325 @end smallexample
11326
11327 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
11328 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
11329 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
11330 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
11331 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
11332 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
11333 redundant component associations, although which component values are
11334 assigned in such cases is not defined.
11335
11336 @item
11337 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
11338
11339 @item
11340 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
11341 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
11342 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
11343 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
11344 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
11345 the proper resolution.
11346
11347 @item
11348 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11349
11350 @item
11351 Entry calls are not implemented.
11352
11353 @item
11354 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11355 formats are not supported.
11356
11357 @item
11358 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11359
11360 @item
11361 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
11362 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
11363 context.
11364 Should your program
11365 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
11366 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
11367 @end itemize
11368
11369 @node Additions to Ada
11370 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
11371 @cindex Ada, deviations from
11372
11373 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11374 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11375
11376 @itemize @bullet
11377 @item
11378 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11379 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11380 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11381 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11382 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11383 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11384 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11385 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11386
11387 @item
11388 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11389 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11390 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11391
11392 @item
11393 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11394 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11395
11396 @item
11397 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11398 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11399 @end itemize
11400
11401 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11402 additions specific to Ada:
11403
11404 @itemize @bullet
11405 @item
11406 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11407 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11408
11409 @smallexample
11410 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
11411 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
11412 @end smallexample
11413
11414 @item
11415 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11416 the value of its right-hand operand.
11417 This allows, for example,
11418 complex conditional breaks:
11419
11420 @smallexample
11421 (@value{GDBP}) break f
11422 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11423 @end smallexample
11424
11425 @item
11426 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11427 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11428 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11429 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11430 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11431 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11432 in strings. For example,
11433 @smallexample
11434 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11435 @end smallexample
11436 @noindent
11437 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11438 after each period.
11439
11440 @item
11441 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11442 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11443 to write
11444
11445 @smallexample
11446 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
11447 @end smallexample
11448
11449 @item
11450 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11451 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11452 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11453 of 3 might print as
11454
11455 @smallexample
11456 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11457 @end smallexample
11458
11459 @noindent
11460 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11461 clause.
11462
11463 @item
11464 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11465 multi-character subsequence of
11466 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11467 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11468 in place of @t{a'length}.
11469
11470 @item
11471 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11472 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11473 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11474 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11475 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11476 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11477 For example,
11478 @smallexample
11479 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11480 @end smallexample
11481
11482 @item
11483 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11484 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11485 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11486 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11487 object.
11488
11489 @end itemize
11490
11491 @node Stopping Before Main Program
11492 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11493
11494 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11495 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11496 before reaching the main procedure.
11497 As defined in the Ada Reference
11498 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11499 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11500 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11501 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11502
11503 @node Ada Tasks
11504 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
11505 @cindex Ada, tasking
11506
11507 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
11508 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
11509
11510 @table @code
11511 @kindex info tasks
11512 @item info tasks
11513 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
11514
11515
11516 @smallexample
11517 @iftex
11518 @leftskip=0.5cm
11519 @end iftex
11520 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11521 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11522 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11523 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
11524 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
11525 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Running c
11526
11527 @end smallexample
11528
11529 @noindent
11530 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
11531 task currently being inspected.
11532
11533 @table @asis
11534 @item ID
11535 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
11536
11537 @item TID
11538 The Ada task ID.
11539
11540 @item P-ID
11541 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
11542
11543 @item Pri
11544 The base priority of the task.
11545
11546 @item State
11547 Current state of the task.
11548
11549 @table @code
11550 @item Unactivated
11551 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
11552 executing.
11553
11554 @item Running
11555 The task currently running.
11556
11557 @item Runnable
11558 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
11559 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
11560
11561 @item Terminated
11562 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
11563 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
11564 terminated themselves.
11565
11566 @item Child Activation Wait
11567 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
11568
11569 @item Accept Statement
11570 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
11571
11572 @item Waiting on entry call
11573 The task is waiting on an entry call.
11574
11575 @item Async Select Wait
11576 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
11577 select statement.
11578
11579 @item Delay Sleep
11580 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
11581 alternative open.
11582
11583 @item Child Termination Wait
11584 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
11585 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
11586 waiting on a terminate Phase.
11587
11588 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
11589 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
11590 finish terminating.
11591
11592 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
11593 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
11594 @end table
11595
11596 @item Name
11597 Name of the task in the program.
11598
11599 @end table
11600
11601 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
11602 @item info task @var{taskno}
11603 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
11604 the following example:
11605 @smallexample
11606 @iftex
11607 @leftskip=0.5cm
11608 @end iftex
11609 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11610 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11611 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11612 * 2 807c468 1 15 Running task_1
11613 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
11614 Ada Task: 0x807c468
11615 Name: task_1
11616 Thread: 0x807f378
11617 Parent: 1 (main_task)
11618 Base Priority: 15
11619 State: Runnable
11620 @end smallexample
11621
11622 @item task
11623 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
11624 @cindex current Ada task ID
11625 This command prints the ID of the current task.
11626
11627 @smallexample
11628 @iftex
11629 @leftskip=0.5cm
11630 @end iftex
11631 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11632 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11633 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11634 * 2 807c458 1 15 Running t
11635 (@value{GDBP}) task
11636 [Current task is 2]
11637 @end smallexample
11638
11639 @item task @var{taskno}
11640 @cindex Ada task switching
11641 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
11642 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
11643 from the current task to the given task.
11644
11645 @smallexample
11646 @iftex
11647 @leftskip=0.5cm
11648 @end iftex
11649 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11650 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11651 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11652 * 2 807c458 1 15 Running t
11653 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
11654 [Switching to task 1]
11655 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11656 (@value{GDBP}) bt
11657 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11658 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
11659 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
11660 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
11661 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
11662 @end smallexample
11663
11664 @end table
11665
11666 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
11667 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11668 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
11669
11670 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
11671 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
11672 the platform being used.
11673 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
11674 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
11675 as usual.
11676
11677 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
11678 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
11679 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
11680 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
11681 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
11682 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
11683
11684 @node Ada Glitches
11685 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11686 @cindex Ada, problems
11687
11688 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11689 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11690 @value{GDBN},
11691 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11692 and the GNU Ada compiler.
11693
11694 @itemize @bullet
11695 @item
11696 Currently, the debugger
11697 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11698 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11699 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11700 to get it printed properly.
11701
11702 @item
11703 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
11704 storage are invisible to the debugger.
11705
11706 @item
11707 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
11708 argument lists are treated as positional).
11709
11710 @item
11711 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
11712
11713 @item
11714 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
11715 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
11716 the host machine.
11717
11718 @item
11719 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
11720 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
11721 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
11722 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
11723 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
11724 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
11725 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
11726 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
11727 you can usually resolve the confusion
11728 by qualifying the problematic names with package
11729 @code{Standard} explicitly.
11730 @end itemize
11731
11732 @node Unsupported Languages
11733 @section Unsupported Languages
11734
11735 @cindex unsupported languages
11736 @cindex minimal language
11737 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
11738 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
11739 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
11740 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
11741 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
11742 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
11743
11744 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
11745 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
11746 language.
11747
11748 @node Symbols
11749 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
11750
11751 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
11752 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
11753 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
11754 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
11755 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
11756 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
11757 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
11758
11759 @cindex symbol names
11760 @cindex names of symbols
11761 @cindex quoting names
11762 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11763 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11764 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11765 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11766 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11767 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11768 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11769 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11770
11771 @smallexample
11772 p 'foo.c'::x
11773 @end smallexample
11774
11775 @noindent
11776 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11777
11778 @table @code
11779 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11780 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11781 @kindex set case-sensitive
11782 @item set case-sensitive on
11783 @itemx set case-sensitive off
11784 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
11785 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11786 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11787 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11788 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11789 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11790 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11791 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11792 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11793 case-insensitive matches.
11794
11795 @kindex show case-sensitive
11796 @item show case-sensitive
11797 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11798 lookups.
11799
11800 @kindex info address
11801 @cindex address of a symbol
11802 @item info address @var{symbol}
11803 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11804 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11805 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11806 is always stored.
11807
11808 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11809 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11810 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11811
11812 @kindex info symbol
11813 @cindex symbol from address
11814 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11815 @item info symbol @var{addr}
11816 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11817 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11818 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11819
11820 @smallexample
11821 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11822 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11823 @end smallexample
11824
11825 @noindent
11826 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11827 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11828
11829 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
11830 library containing the symbol is also printed:
11831
11832 @smallexample
11833 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
11834 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
11835 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
11836 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
11837 @end smallexample
11838
11839 @kindex whatis
11840 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
11841 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11842 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11843 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11844 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11845 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11846 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11847 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11848 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11849 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11850 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11851
11852 @kindex ptype
11853 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
11854 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11855 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11856 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11857
11858 For example, for this variable declaration:
11859
11860 @smallexample
11861 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11862 @end smallexample
11863
11864 @noindent
11865 the two commands give this output:
11866
11867 @smallexample
11868 @group
11869 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11870 type = struct complex
11871 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11872 type = struct complex @{
11873 double real;
11874 double imag;
11875 @}
11876 @end group
11877 @end smallexample
11878
11879 @noindent
11880 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11881 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11882
11883 @cindex incomplete type
11884 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11885 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11886 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11887 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11888 given these declarations:
11889
11890 @smallexample
11891 struct foo;
11892 struct foo *fooptr;
11893 @end smallexample
11894
11895 @noindent
11896 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11897
11898 @smallexample
11899 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11900 $1 = <incomplete type>
11901 @end smallexample
11902
11903 @noindent
11904 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11905 completely specified.
11906
11907 @kindex info types
11908 @item info types @var{regexp}
11909 @itemx info types
11910 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11911 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11912 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11913 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11914 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11915 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11916 name is @code{value}.
11917
11918 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11919 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11920 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11921
11922 @kindex info scope
11923 @cindex local variables
11924 @item info scope @var{location}
11925 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11926 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11927 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11928 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11929 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11930
11931 @smallexample
11932 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11933 Scope for command_line_handler:
11934 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11935 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11936 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11937 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11938 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11939 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11940 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11941 @end smallexample
11942
11943 @noindent
11944 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11945 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11946 collect}.
11947
11948 @kindex info source
11949 @item info source
11950 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11951 the function containing the current point of execution:
11952 @itemize @bullet
11953 @item
11954 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11955 @item
11956 the directory it was compiled in,
11957 @item
11958 its length, in lines,
11959 @item
11960 which programming language it is written in,
11961 @item
11962 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11963 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11964 @item
11965 whether the debugging information includes information about
11966 preprocessor macros.
11967 @end itemize
11968
11969
11970 @kindex info sources
11971 @item info sources
11972 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11973 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11974 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11975
11976 @kindex info functions
11977 @item info functions
11978 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11979
11980 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11981 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11982 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11983 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11984 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11985 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11986 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11987 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11988
11989 @kindex info variables
11990 @item info variables
11991 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11992 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11993
11994 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11995 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11996 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11997 @var{regexp}.
11998
11999 @kindex info classes
12000 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
12001 @item info classes
12002 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
12003 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
12004 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12005 expression.
12006
12007 @kindex info selectors
12008 @item info selectors
12009 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
12010 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
12011 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12012 expression.
12013
12014 @ignore
12015 This was never implemented.
12016 @kindex info methods
12017 @item info methods
12018 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
12019 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
12020 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
12021 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
12022 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
12023 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
12024 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
12025 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
12026 @end ignore
12027
12028 @cindex reloading symbols
12029 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
12030 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
12031 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
12032 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
12033 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
12034
12035 @table @code
12036 @kindex set symbol-reloading
12037 @item set symbol-reloading on
12038 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
12039 object file with a particular name is seen again.
12040
12041 @item set symbol-reloading off
12042 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
12043 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
12044 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
12045 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
12046 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
12047 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
12048 name.
12049
12050 @kindex show symbol-reloading
12051 @item show symbol-reloading
12052 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
12053 @end table
12054
12055 @cindex opaque data types
12056 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
12057 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
12058 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
12059 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
12060 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
12061 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
12062 another source file. The default is on.
12063
12064 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
12065 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
12066
12067 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
12068 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
12069 is printed as follows:
12070 @smallexample
12071 @{<no data fields>@}
12072 @end smallexample
12073
12074 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
12075 @item show opaque-type-resolution
12076 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
12077
12078 @kindex set print symbol-loading
12079 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
12080 @item set print symbol-loading
12081 @itemx set print symbol-loading on
12082 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
12083 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to enable or
12084 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12085 By default, these messages will be printed, and normally this is what
12086 you want. Disabling these messages is useful when debugging applications
12087 with lots of shared libraries where the quantity of output can be more
12088 annoying than useful.
12089
12090 @kindex show print symbol-loading
12091 @item show print symbol-loading
12092 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12093
12094 @kindex maint print symbols
12095 @cindex symbol dump
12096 @kindex maint print psymbols
12097 @cindex partial symbol dump
12098 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
12099 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
12100 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
12101 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
12102 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
12103 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
12104 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
12105 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
12106 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
12107 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
12108 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
12109 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
12110 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
12111 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
12112 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
12113 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
12114 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
12115
12116 @kindex maint info symtabs
12117 @kindex maint info psymtabs
12118 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
12119 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12120 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12121 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12122 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12123 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12124
12125 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
12126 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
12127 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
12128 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
12129 structure in more detail. For example:
12130
12131 @smallexample
12132 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
12133 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12134 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12135 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12136 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
12137 readin no
12138 fullname (null)
12139 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
12140 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
12141 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
12142 dependencies (none)
12143 @}
12144 @}
12145 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12146 (@value{GDBP})
12147 @end smallexample
12148 @noindent
12149 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
12150 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
12151 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
12152 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
12153 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
12154
12155 @smallexample
12156 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
12157 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
12158 line 1574.
12159 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12160 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12161 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12162 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12163 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
12164 dirname (null)
12165 fullname (null)
12166 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
12167 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
12168 debugformat DWARF 2
12169 @}
12170 @}
12171 (@value{GDBP})
12172 @end smallexample
12173 @end table
12174
12175
12176 @node Altering
12177 @chapter Altering Execution
12178
12179 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
12180 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
12181 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
12182 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
12183 program.
12184
12185 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
12186 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
12187 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
12188
12189 @menu
12190 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
12191 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
12192 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
12193 * Returning:: Returning from a function
12194 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
12195 * Patching:: Patching your program
12196 @end menu
12197
12198 @node Assignment
12199 @section Assignment to Variables
12200
12201 @cindex assignment
12202 @cindex setting variables
12203 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
12204 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
12205
12206 @smallexample
12207 print x=4
12208 @end smallexample
12209
12210 @noindent
12211 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
12212 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
12213 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
12214 information on operators in supported languages.
12215
12216 @kindex set variable
12217 @cindex variables, setting
12218 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
12219 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
12220 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
12221 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
12222 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
12223
12224 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
12225 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
12226 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
12227 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
12228 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
12229 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
12230 command @code{set width}:
12231
12232 @smallexample
12233 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
12234 type = double
12235 (@value{GDBP}) p width
12236 $4 = 13
12237 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
12238 Invalid syntax in expression.
12239 @end smallexample
12240
12241 @noindent
12242 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
12243 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
12244
12245 @smallexample
12246 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
12247 @end smallexample
12248
12249 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
12250 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
12251 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
12252 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
12253 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
12254 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
12255
12256 @smallexample
12257 @group
12258 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
12259 type = double
12260 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12261 $1 = 1
12262 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
12263 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12264 $2 = 1
12265 (@value{GDBP}) r
12266 The program being debugged has been started already.
12267 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
12268 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
12269 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
12270 Invalid bfd target.
12271 (@value{GDBP}) show g
12272 The current BFD target is "=4".
12273 @end group
12274 @end smallexample
12275
12276 @noindent
12277 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
12278 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
12279 @code{g}, use
12280
12281 @smallexample
12282 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
12283 @end smallexample
12284
12285 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
12286 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
12287 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
12288 same length or shorter.
12289 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
12290 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
12291
12292 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
12293 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
12294 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
12295 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
12296 and representation in memory), and
12297
12298 @smallexample
12299 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
12300 @end smallexample
12301
12302 @noindent
12303 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
12304
12305 @node Jumping
12306 @section Continuing at a Different Address
12307
12308 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
12309 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
12310 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
12311
12312 @table @code
12313 @kindex jump
12314 @item jump @var{linespec}
12315 @itemx jump @var{location}
12316 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
12317 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
12318 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
12319 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
12320 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
12321 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12322
12323 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
12324 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
12325 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
12326 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
12327 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
12328 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
12329 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
12330 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
12331 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
12332 @end table
12333
12334 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
12335 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
12336 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
12337 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
12338 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
12339 example,
12340
12341 @smallexample
12342 set $pc = 0x485
12343 @end smallexample
12344
12345 @noindent
12346 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
12347 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
12348 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
12349
12350 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
12351 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
12352 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
12353 detail.
12354
12355 @c @group
12356 @node Signaling
12357 @section Giving your Program a Signal
12358 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
12359
12360 @table @code
12361 @kindex signal
12362 @item signal @var{signal}
12363 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
12364 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
12365 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
12366 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
12367
12368 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
12369 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
12370 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
12371 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
12372 signal.
12373
12374 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
12375 after executing the command.
12376 @end table
12377 @c @end group
12378
12379 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
12380 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
12381 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
12382 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
12383 passes the signal directly to your program.
12384
12385
12386 @node Returning
12387 @section Returning from a Function
12388
12389 @table @code
12390 @cindex returning from a function
12391 @kindex return
12392 @item return
12393 @itemx return @var{expression}
12394 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
12395 command. If you give an
12396 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
12397 value.
12398 @end table
12399
12400 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
12401 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
12402 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
12403 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
12404
12405 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
12406 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
12407 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
12408 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
12409 of functions.
12410
12411 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
12412 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
12413 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
12414 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
12415 selected stack frame returns naturally.
12416
12417 @node Calling
12418 @section Calling Program Functions
12419
12420 @table @code
12421 @cindex calling functions
12422 @cindex inferior functions, calling
12423 @item print @var{expr}
12424 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
12425 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
12426 debugged.
12427
12428 @kindex call
12429 @item call @var{expr}
12430 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
12431 returned values.
12432
12433 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
12434 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
12435 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
12436 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
12437 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
12438 value history.
12439 @end table
12440
12441 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
12442 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
12443 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
12444 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
12445
12446 @table @code
12447 @item set unwindonsignal
12448 @kindex set unwindonsignal
12449 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
12450 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
12451 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
12452 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
12453 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
12454 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
12455 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
12456 received.
12457
12458 @item show unwindonsignal
12459 @kindex show unwindonsignal
12460 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
12461 @value{GDBN}.
12462 @end table
12463
12464 @cindex weak alias functions
12465 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
12466 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
12467 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
12468 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
12469 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
12470 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
12471 function instead.
12472
12473 @node Patching
12474 @section Patching Programs
12475
12476 @cindex patching binaries
12477 @cindex writing into executables
12478 @cindex writing into corefiles
12479
12480 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
12481 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
12482 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
12483 patching your program's binary.
12484
12485 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
12486 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
12487 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
12488 repairs.
12489
12490 @table @code
12491 @kindex set write
12492 @item set write on
12493 @itemx set write off
12494 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
12495 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
12496 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
12497
12498 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
12499 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
12500 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
12501
12502 @item show write
12503 @kindex show write
12504 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
12505 as well as reading.
12506 @end table
12507
12508 @node GDB Files
12509 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
12510
12511 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
12512 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
12513 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
12514 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
12515
12516 @menu
12517 * Files:: Commands to specify files
12518 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
12519 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
12520 @end menu
12521
12522 @node Files
12523 @section Commands to Specify Files
12524
12525 @cindex symbol table
12526 @cindex core dump file
12527
12528 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
12529 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
12530 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
12531 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
12532
12533 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
12534 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
12535 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
12536 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
12537 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
12538 new files are useful.
12539
12540 @table @code
12541 @cindex executable file
12542 @kindex file
12543 @item file @var{filename}
12544 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
12545 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
12546 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
12547 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
12548 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
12549 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
12550 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
12551 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
12552
12553 @cindex unlinked object files
12554 @cindex patching object files
12555 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
12556 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
12557 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
12558 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
12559 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
12560 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
12561 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
12562 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
12563
12564 @item file
12565 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
12566 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
12567
12568 @kindex exec-file
12569 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12570 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
12571 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
12572 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
12573 discard information on the executable file.
12574
12575 @kindex symbol-file
12576 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12577 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
12578 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
12579 table and program to run from the same file.
12580
12581 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
12582 program's symbol table.
12583
12584 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
12585 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
12586 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
12587 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
12588 @value{GDBN}.
12589
12590 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
12591 executing it once.
12592
12593 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
12594 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
12595 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
12596 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
12597 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
12598 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
12599 optimized code.
12600
12601 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
12602 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
12603 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
12604 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
12605 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
12606
12607 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
12608 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
12609 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
12610 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
12611 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
12612 Warnings and Messages}.)
12613
12614 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
12615 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
12616 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
12617 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
12618 in stabs format.
12619
12620 @kindex readnow
12621 @cindex reading symbols immediately
12622 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
12623 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12624 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12625 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
12626 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
12627 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
12628 entire symbol table available.
12629
12630 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
12631 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
12632 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
12633 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
12634 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
12635 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
12636 @c files.
12637
12638 @kindex core-file
12639 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
12640 @itemx core
12641 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
12642 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
12643 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
12644 executable file itself for other parts.
12645
12646 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
12647 to be used.
12648
12649 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
12650 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
12651 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
12652 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
12653 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
12654
12655 @kindex add-symbol-file
12656 @cindex dynamic linking
12657 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
12658 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12659 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
12660 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
12661 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
12662 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
12663 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
12664 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
12665 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
12666 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
12667 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
12668 @var{address} as an expression.
12669
12670 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
12671 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
12672 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
12673 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
12674 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
12675
12676 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
12677 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
12678 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
12679 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
12680 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
12681 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
12682 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
12683 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
12684 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
12685
12686 @itemize @bullet
12687 @item
12688 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
12689 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
12690 @item
12691 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
12692 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
12693 @item
12694 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
12695 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12696 @end itemize
12697
12698 @noindent
12699 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
12700 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
12701 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
12702 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
12703 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
12704 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
12705 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
12706 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
12707 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
12708 way.
12709
12710 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
12711
12712 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
12713 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
12714 @cindex load symbols from memory
12715 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
12716 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
12717 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
12718 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
12719 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
12720 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
12721 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
12722 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
12723 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
12724
12725 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
12726 @kindex assf
12727 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
12728 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
12729 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
12730 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
12731 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
12732 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
12733 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
12734 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
12735 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
12736 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
12737
12738 @kindex section
12739 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
12740 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
12741 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
12742 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
12743 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
12744 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
12745 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
12746 their addresses.
12747
12748 @kindex info files
12749 @kindex info target
12750 @item info files
12751 @itemx info target
12752 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
12753 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
12754 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
12755 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
12756 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
12757 current ones.
12758
12759 @kindex maint info sections
12760 @item maint info sections
12761 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
12762 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
12763 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
12764 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
12765 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
12766 may be arbitrarily combined):
12767
12768 @table @code
12769 @item ALLOBJ
12770 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
12771 @item @var{sections}
12772 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
12773 @item @var{section-flags}
12774 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
12775 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
12776 @table @code
12777 @item ALLOC
12778 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
12779 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
12780 @item LOAD
12781 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
12782 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
12783 @item RELOC
12784 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
12785 @item READONLY
12786 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
12787 @item CODE
12788 Section contains executable code only.
12789 @item DATA
12790 Section contains data only (no executable code).
12791 @item ROM
12792 Section will reside in ROM.
12793 @item CONSTRUCTOR
12794 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
12795 @item HAS_CONTENTS
12796 Section is not empty.
12797 @item NEVER_LOAD
12798 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
12799 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
12800 A notification to the linker that the section contains
12801 COFF shared library information.
12802 @item IS_COMMON
12803 Section contains common symbols.
12804 @end table
12805 @end table
12806 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
12807 @cindex read-only sections
12808 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
12809 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12810 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12811 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12812 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12813 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12814 enhancement to debugging performance.
12815
12816 The default is off.
12817
12818 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
12819 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12820 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12821 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12822
12823 @item show trust-readonly-sections
12824 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12825 @end table
12826
12827 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12828 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12829 name and remembers it that way.
12830
12831 @cindex shared libraries
12832 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
12833 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12834 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12835
12836 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12837 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12838
12839 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12840 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12841 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12842 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12843 debugging a core file).
12844
12845 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12846 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12847
12848 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12849 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12850 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12851
12852 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12853 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12854 particularly large or there are many of them.
12855
12856 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12857 commands:
12858
12859 @table @code
12860 @kindex set auto-solib-add
12861 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12862 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12863 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12864 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12865 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12866 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12867 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12868
12869 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
12870 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12871 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12872 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12873 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12874 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12875 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12876 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12877 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12878
12879 @kindex show auto-solib-add
12880 @item show auto-solib-add
12881 Display the current autoloading mode.
12882 @end table
12883
12884 @cindex load shared library
12885 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12886 command:
12887
12888 @table @code
12889 @kindex info sharedlibrary
12890 @kindex info share
12891 @item info share
12892 @itemx info sharedlibrary
12893 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12894
12895 @kindex sharedlibrary
12896 @kindex share
12897 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12898 @itemx share @var{regex}
12899 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12900 Unix regular expression.
12901 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12902 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12903 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12904 loaded.
12905
12906 @item nosharedlibrary
12907 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12908 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12909 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12910 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12911 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12912 discarded.
12913 @end table
12914
12915 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12916 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12917 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12918
12919 @table @code
12920 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12921 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12922 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12923 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12924 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12925 shared library.
12926
12927 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12928 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12929 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12930 library events happen.
12931 @end table
12932
12933 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12934 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
12935 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
12936 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
12937 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
12938 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12939 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12940 not.
12941
12942 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12943 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12944 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12945 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12946 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12947
12948 @table @code
12949 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12950 @cindex system root, alternate
12951 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12952 @kindex set sysroot
12953 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12954 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12955 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12956 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12957 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12958 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12959 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12960 under @var{path}.
12961
12962 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
12963 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
12964 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
12965 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
12966 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
12967 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
12968 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
12969 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
12970 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
12971
12972 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12973 sysroot}.
12974
12975 @cindex default system root
12976 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12977 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12978 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12979 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12980 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12981 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12982 location.
12983
12984 @kindex show sysroot
12985 @item show sysroot
12986 Display the current shared library prefix.
12987
12988 @kindex set solib-search-path
12989 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12990 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12991 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12992 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12993 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12994 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12995 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12996 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12997 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12998 of shared library symbols.
12999
13000 @kindex show solib-search-path
13001 @item show solib-search-path
13002 Display the current shared library search path.
13003 @end table
13004
13005
13006 @node Separate Debug Files
13007 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
13008 @cindex separate debugging information files
13009 @cindex debugging information in separate files
13010 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
13011 @cindex debugging information directory, global
13012 @cindex global debugging information directory
13013 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
13014 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
13015
13016 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
13017 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
13018 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
13019 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
13020 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
13021 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
13022 install only when they need to debug a problem.
13023
13024 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
13025 file:
13026
13027 @itemize @bullet
13028 @item
13029 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
13030 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
13031 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
13032 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
13033 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
13034 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
13035 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
13036 came from the same build.
13037
13038 @item
13039 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
13040 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
13041 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
13042 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
13043 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
13044 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
13045 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
13046 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
13047 below.
13048 @end itemize
13049
13050 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
13051 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
13052
13053 @itemize @bullet
13054 @item
13055 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
13056 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
13057 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
13058 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
13059 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
13060
13061 @item
13062 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
13063 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
13064 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
13065 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
13066 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
13067 hex characters, not 10.)
13068 @end itemize
13069
13070 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
13071 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
13072 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
13073 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
13074 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
13075 debug information files, in the indicated order:
13076
13077 @itemize @minus
13078 @item
13079 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
13080 @item
13081 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
13082 @item
13083 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
13084 @item
13085 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
13086 @end itemize
13087
13088 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
13089 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
13090
13091 @table @code
13092
13093 @kindex set debug-file-directory
13094 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
13095 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13096 information files to @var{directory}.
13097
13098 @kindex show debug-file-directory
13099 @item show debug-file-directory
13100 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13101 information files.
13102
13103 @end table
13104
13105 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
13106 @cindex debug link sections
13107 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
13108 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
13109
13110 @itemize
13111 @item
13112 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
13113 a zero byte,
13114 @item
13115 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
13116 boundary within the section, and
13117 @item
13118 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
13119 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
13120 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
13121 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
13122 @end itemize
13123
13124 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
13125 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
13126 described above.
13127
13128 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
13129 @cindex build ID sections
13130 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
13131 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
13132 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
13133 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
13134 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
13135 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
13136 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
13137 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
13138 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
13139
13140 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
13141 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
13142 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
13143 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
13144 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
13145 in an ordinary executable.
13146
13147 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
13148 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
13149 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
13150 following commands:
13151
13152 @smallexample
13153 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
13154 @kbd{strip -g foo}
13155 @end smallexample
13156
13157 @noindent
13158 These commands remove the debugging
13159 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
13160 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
13161 two files:
13162
13163 @itemize @bullet
13164 @item
13165 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
13166 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
13167
13168 @smallexample
13169 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
13170 @end smallexample
13171
13172 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
13173 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
13174 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
13175 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
13176
13177 @item
13178 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
13179 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
13180 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
13181 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
13182 @end itemize
13183
13184 @noindent
13185
13186 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
13187 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
13188 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
13189 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
13190
13191 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
13192 @smallexample
13193 unsigned long
13194 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
13195 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
13196 @{
13197 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
13198 @{
13199 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
13200 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
13201 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
13202 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
13203 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
13204 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
13205 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
13206 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
13207 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
13208 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
13209 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
13210 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
13211 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
13212 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
13213 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
13214 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
13215 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
13216 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
13217 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
13218 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
13219 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
13220 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
13221 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
13222 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
13223 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
13224 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
13225 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
13226 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
13227 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
13228 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
13229 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
13230 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
13231 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
13232 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
13233 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
13234 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
13235 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
13236 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
13237 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
13238 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
13239 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
13240 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
13241 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
13242 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
13243 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
13244 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
13245 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
13246 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
13247 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
13248 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
13249 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
13250 0x2d02ef8d
13251 @};
13252 unsigned char *end;
13253
13254 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13255 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
13256 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
13257 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13258 @}
13259 @end smallexample
13260
13261 @noindent
13262 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
13263
13264
13265 @node Symbol Errors
13266 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
13267
13268 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
13269 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
13270 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
13271 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
13272 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
13273 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
13274 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
13275 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
13276 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
13277 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13278 Messages}).
13279
13280 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
13281
13282 @table @code
13283 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
13284
13285 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
13286 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
13287 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
13288 in its outer scope blocks.
13289
13290 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
13291 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
13292 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
13293 function.
13294
13295 @item block at @var{address} out of order
13296
13297 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
13298 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
13299 do so.
13300
13301 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
13302 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
13303 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
13304 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13305 Messages}.)
13306
13307 @item bad block start address patched
13308
13309 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
13310 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
13311 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
13312
13313 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
13314 starting on the previous source line.
13315
13316 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
13317
13318 @cindex foo
13319 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
13320 larger than the size of the string table.
13321
13322 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
13323 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
13324 with this name.
13325
13326 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
13327
13328 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
13329 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
13330 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
13331
13332 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
13333 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
13334 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
13335 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
13336 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
13337 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
13338
13339 @item stub type has NULL name
13340
13341 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
13342
13343 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
13344 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
13345 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
13346 it.
13347
13348 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
13349
13350 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
13351
13352 @end table
13353
13354 @node Targets
13355 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
13356
13357 @cindex debugging target
13358 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
13359
13360 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
13361 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
13362 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
13363 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
13364 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
13365 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
13366 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
13367 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
13368
13369 @cindex target architecture
13370 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
13371 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
13372 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
13373 command.
13374
13375 @table @code
13376 @kindex set architecture
13377 @kindex show architecture
13378 @item set architecture @var{arch}
13379 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
13380 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
13381 supported architectures.
13382
13383 @item show architecture
13384 Show the current target architecture.
13385
13386 @item set processor
13387 @itemx processor
13388 @kindex set processor
13389 @kindex show processor
13390 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
13391 and @code{show architecture}.
13392 @end table
13393
13394 @menu
13395 * Active Targets:: Active targets
13396 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
13397 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
13398 @end menu
13399
13400 @node Active Targets
13401 @section Active Targets
13402
13403 @cindex stacking targets
13404 @cindex active targets
13405 @cindex multiple targets
13406
13407 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
13408 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
13409 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
13410 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
13411 a core file.
13412
13413 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
13414 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
13415 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
13416 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
13417 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
13418 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
13419 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
13420 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
13421 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
13422
13423 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
13424 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
13425 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
13426 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
13427 process target is active.
13428
13429 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
13430 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
13431 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
13432 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
13433 Process}).
13434
13435 @node Target Commands
13436 @section Commands for Managing Targets
13437
13438 @table @code
13439 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
13440 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
13441 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
13442 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
13443 protocol of the target machine.
13444
13445 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
13446 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
13447 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
13448
13449 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
13450 after executing the command.
13451
13452 @kindex help target
13453 @item help target
13454 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
13455 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
13456 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13457
13458 @item help target @var{name}
13459 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
13460 select it.
13461
13462 @kindex set gnutarget
13463 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
13464 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
13465 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
13466 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
13467 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
13468 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
13469
13470 @quotation
13471 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
13472 you must know the actual BFD name.
13473 @end quotation
13474
13475 @noindent
13476 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
13477
13478 @kindex show gnutarget
13479 @item show gnutarget
13480 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
13481 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
13482 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
13483 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
13484 @end table
13485
13486 @cindex common targets
13487 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
13488 configuration):
13489
13490 @table @code
13491 @kindex target
13492 @item target exec @var{program}
13493 @cindex executable file target
13494 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
13495 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
13496
13497 @item target core @var{filename}
13498 @cindex core dump file target
13499 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
13500 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
13501
13502 @item target remote @var{medium}
13503 @cindex remote target
13504 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
13505 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
13506 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
13507
13508 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
13509 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
13510
13511 @smallexample
13512 target remote /dev/ttya
13513 @end smallexample
13514
13515 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
13516 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
13517 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
13518 clobbered by the download.
13519
13520 @item target sim
13521 @cindex built-in simulator target
13522 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
13523 In general,
13524 @smallexample
13525 target sim
13526 load
13527 run
13528 @end smallexample
13529 @noindent
13530 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
13531 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
13532 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
13533 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
13534 Processors}.
13535
13536 @end table
13537
13538 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
13539
13540 @table @code
13541
13542 @item target nrom @var{dev}
13543 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
13544 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
13545
13546 @end table
13547
13548 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
13549 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
13550
13551 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
13552 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
13553 various aspects of this process.
13554
13555 @table @code
13556
13557 @item set hash
13558 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13559 @cindex hash mark while downloading
13560 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
13561 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
13562 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
13563 monitor.
13564
13565 @item show hash
13566 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13567 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
13568
13569 @item set debug monitor
13570 @kindex set debug monitor
13571 @cindex display remote monitor communications
13572 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
13573 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13574
13575 @item show debug monitor
13576 @kindex show debug monitor
13577 Show the current status of displaying communications between
13578 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13579 @end table
13580
13581 @table @code
13582
13583 @kindex load @var{filename}
13584 @item load @var{filename}
13585 @anchor{load}
13586 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
13587 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
13588 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
13589 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
13590 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
13591 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13592
13593 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
13594 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
13595 target is @dots{}}''
13596
13597 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
13598 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
13599 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
13600 specifies a fixed address.
13601 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
13602
13603 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
13604 load programs into flash memory.
13605
13606 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
13607 @end table
13608
13609 @node Byte Order
13610 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
13611
13612 @cindex choosing target byte order
13613 @cindex target byte order
13614
13615 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
13616 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
13617 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
13618 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
13619 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
13620 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
13621
13622 @table @code
13623 @kindex set endian
13624 @item set endian big
13625 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
13626
13627 @item set endian little
13628 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
13629
13630 @item set endian auto
13631 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
13632 executable.
13633
13634 @item show endian
13635 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
13636
13637 @end table
13638
13639 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
13640 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
13641 target system.
13642
13643
13644 @node Remote Debugging
13645 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
13646 @cindex remote debugging
13647
13648 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
13649 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
13650 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
13651 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
13652 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
13653
13654 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
13655 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
13656 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
13657 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
13658 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
13659 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
13660
13661 Other remote targets may be available in your
13662 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
13663
13664 @menu
13665 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
13666 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
13667 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
13668 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
13669 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
13670 @end menu
13671
13672 @node Connecting
13673 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
13674
13675 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
13676 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
13677 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
13678 program as the first argument.
13679
13680 @cindex @code{target remote}
13681 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
13682 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
13683 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
13684 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
13685 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
13686 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
13687
13688 @table @code
13689
13690 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
13691 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
13692 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
13693 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
13694
13695 @smallexample
13696 target remote /dev/ttyb
13697 @end smallexample
13698
13699 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
13700 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
13701 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
13702 @code{target} command.
13703
13704 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
13705 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13706 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
13707 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
13708 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
13709 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
13710 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
13711 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
13712 target.
13713
13714 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
13715 @code{manyfarms}:
13716
13717 @smallexample
13718 target remote manyfarms:2828
13719 @end smallexample
13720
13721 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
13722 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
13723 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
13724 port 1234 on your local machine:
13725
13726 @smallexample
13727 target remote :1234
13728 @end smallexample
13729 @noindent
13730
13731 Note that the colon is still required here.
13732
13733 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13734 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
13735 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
13736 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
13737
13738 @smallexample
13739 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
13740 @end smallexample
13741
13742 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
13743 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
13744 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
13745 cause havoc with your debugging session.
13746
13747 @item target remote | @var{command}
13748 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
13749 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
13750 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
13751 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
13752 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
13753 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
13754 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
13755 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
13756
13757 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
13758 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
13759 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
13760
13761 @end table
13762
13763 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
13764 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
13765 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
13766 need to use @kbd{run}.
13767
13768 @cindex interrupting remote programs
13769 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
13770 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
13771 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
13772 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
13773 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
13774 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
13775
13776 @smallexample
13777 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
13778 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
13779 @end smallexample
13780
13781 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
13782 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
13783 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
13784 goes back to waiting.
13785
13786 @table @code
13787 @kindex detach (remote)
13788 @item detach
13789 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
13790 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
13791 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
13792 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
13793 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
13794
13795 @kindex disconnect
13796 @item disconnect
13797 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
13798 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
13799 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
13800 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
13801 another target.
13802
13803 @cindex send command to remote monitor
13804 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
13805 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
13806 @kindex monitor
13807 @item monitor @var{cmd}
13808 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
13809 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
13810 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
13811 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
13812 and implement.
13813 @end table
13814
13815 @node File Transfer
13816 @section Sending files to a remote system
13817 @cindex remote target, file transfer
13818 @cindex file transfer
13819 @cindex sending files to remote systems
13820
13821 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
13822 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13823 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13824 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13825 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13826 the only way to upload or download files.
13827
13828 Not all remote targets support these commands.
13829
13830 @table @code
13831 @kindex remote put
13832 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13833 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13834 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13835
13836 @kindex remote get
13837 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13838 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13839 on the host system.
13840
13841 @kindex remote delete
13842 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13843 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13844
13845 @end table
13846
13847 @node Server
13848 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13849
13850 @kindex gdbserver
13851 @cindex remote connection without stubs
13852 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13853 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13854 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13855
13856 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13857 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
13858 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
13859 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
13860 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
13861 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
13862 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
13863 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
13864 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
13865 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
13866 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
13867 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
13868 choice for debugging.
13869
13870 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13871 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13872 protocol.
13873
13874 @quotation
13875 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13876 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13877 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13878 target system with the same privileges as the user running
13879 @code{gdbserver}.
13880 @end quotation
13881
13882 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13883 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13884
13885 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13886 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13887 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13888 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13889 system does all the symbol handling.
13890
13891 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13892 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13893 syntax is:
13894
13895 @smallexample
13896 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13897 @end smallexample
13898
13899 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13900 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13901 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13902 @file{/dev/com1}:
13903
13904 @smallexample
13905 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13906 @end smallexample
13907
13908 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13909 with it.
13910
13911 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13912
13913 @smallexample
13914 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13915 @end smallexample
13916
13917 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13918 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13919 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13920 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13921 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13922 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13923 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13924 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13925 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13926 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13927 @code{target remote} command.
13928
13929 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13930
13931 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13932 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13933
13934 @smallexample
13935 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13936 @end smallexample
13937
13938 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13939 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13940
13941 @pindex pidof
13942 @cindex attach to a program by name
13943 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13944 @code{pidof} utility:
13945
13946 @smallexample
13947 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13948 @end smallexample
13949
13950 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13951 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13952 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13953
13954 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13955 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13956 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13957
13958 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13959 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13960 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13961 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13962
13963 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13964 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13965 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13966 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13967 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13968 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13969 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13970 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13971 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13972
13973 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13974 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13975 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13976 the program you want to debug.
13977
13978 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13979 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13980 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13981
13982 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13983
13984 You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13985 @code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13986 process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13987 for bug reports to the developers.
13988
13989 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
13990 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
13991 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
13992 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
13993
13994 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
13995 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
13996 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
13997 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
13998
13999 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
14000 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
14001 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
14002 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
14003
14004 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
14005 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
14006 environment:
14007
14008 @smallexample
14009 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
14010 @end smallexample
14011
14012 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
14013
14014 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
14015
14016 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
14017 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
14018 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
14019 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
14020
14021 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
14022 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
14023 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
14024 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
14025 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
14026 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
14027 programs.
14028
14029 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14030 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
14031 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
14032 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
14033 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
14034 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
14035 already on the target.
14036
14037 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
14038 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
14039 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
14040
14041 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
14042 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
14043 Here are the available commands.
14044
14045 @table @code
14046 @item monitor help
14047 List the available monitor commands.
14048
14049 @item monitor set debug 0
14050 @itemx monitor set debug 1
14051 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
14052
14053 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
14054 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
14055 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
14056 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
14057
14058 @item monitor exit
14059 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
14060 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
14061 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
14062 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
14063 of a multi-process mode debug session.
14064
14065 @end table
14066
14067 @node Remote Configuration
14068 @section Remote Configuration
14069
14070 @kindex set remote
14071 @kindex show remote
14072 This section documents the configuration options available when
14073 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
14074 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
14075 system-call-allowed}.
14076
14077 @table @code
14078 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
14079 @cindex address size for remote targets
14080 @cindex bits in remote address
14081 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
14082 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
14083 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
14084 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
14085
14086 @item show remoteaddresssize
14087 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
14088
14089 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
14090 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
14091 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
14092 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
14093 remote targets.
14094
14095 @item show remotebaud
14096 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
14097
14098 @item set remotebreak
14099 @cindex interrupt remote programs
14100 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
14101 @anchor{set remotebreak}
14102 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
14103 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
14104 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
14105 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
14106 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
14107
14108 @item show remotebreak
14109 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
14110 interrupt the remote program.
14111
14112 @item set remoteflow on
14113 @itemx set remoteflow off
14114 @kindex set remoteflow
14115 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
14116 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
14117
14118 @item show remoteflow
14119 @kindex show remoteflow
14120 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
14121
14122 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
14123 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
14124 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
14125 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
14126 @code{ascii}.
14127
14128 @item show remotelogbase
14129 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
14130 protocol.
14131
14132 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
14133 @cindex record serial communications on file
14134 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
14135 default is not to record at all.
14136
14137 @item show remotelogfile.
14138 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
14139 serial communications.
14140
14141 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
14142 @cindex timeout for serial communications
14143 @cindex remote timeout
14144 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
14145 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
14146
14147 @item show remotetimeout
14148 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
14149 responses.
14150
14151 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14152 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
14153 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
14154 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
14155 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
14156 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
14157 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
14158 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
14159
14160 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
14161 @itemx show remote exec-file
14162 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
14163 @cindex executable file, for remote target
14164 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
14165 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
14166 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
14167 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
14168
14169 @kindex set tcp
14170 @kindex show tcp
14171 @item set tcp auto-retry on
14172 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
14173 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
14174 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
14175 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
14176 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
14177 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
14178 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
14179 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
14180
14181 @item set tcp auto-retry off
14182 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
14183
14184 @item show tcp auto-retry
14185 Show the current auto-retry setting.
14186
14187 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
14188 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
14189 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
14190 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
14191 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
14192 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
14193 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
14194 value.
14195
14196 @item show tcp connect-timeout
14197 Show the current connection timeout setting.
14198 @end table
14199
14200 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
14201 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
14202 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
14203 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
14204 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
14205 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
14206 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
14207 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
14208 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
14209
14210 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
14211 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
14212 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
14213 @value{GDBN} developers.
14214
14215 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
14216 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
14217 are:
14218
14219 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
14220 @item Command Name
14221 @tab Remote Packet
14222 @tab Related Features
14223
14224 @item @code{fetch-register}
14225 @tab @code{p}
14226 @tab @code{info registers}
14227
14228 @item @code{set-register}
14229 @tab @code{P}
14230 @tab @code{set}
14231
14232 @item @code{binary-download}
14233 @tab @code{X}
14234 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
14235
14236 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
14237 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
14238 @tab @code{info auxv}
14239
14240 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
14241 @tab @code{qSymbol}
14242 @tab Detecting multiple threads
14243
14244 @item @code{attach}
14245 @tab @code{vAttach}
14246 @tab @code{attach}
14247
14248 @item @code{verbose-resume}
14249 @tab @code{vCont}
14250 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
14251
14252 @item @code{run}
14253 @tab @code{vRun}
14254 @tab @code{run}
14255
14256 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
14257 @tab @code{Z0}
14258 @tab @code{break}
14259
14260 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
14261 @tab @code{Z1}
14262 @tab @code{hbreak}
14263
14264 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
14265 @tab @code{Z2}
14266 @tab @code{watch}
14267
14268 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
14269 @tab @code{Z3}
14270 @tab @code{rwatch}
14271
14272 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
14273 @tab @code{Z4}
14274 @tab @code{awatch}
14275
14276 @item @code{target-features}
14277 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
14278 @tab @code{set architecture}
14279
14280 @item @code{library-info}
14281 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
14282 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
14283
14284 @item @code{memory-map}
14285 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
14286 @tab @code{info mem}
14287
14288 @item @code{read-spu-object}
14289 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
14290 @tab @code{info spu}
14291
14292 @item @code{write-spu-object}
14293 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
14294 @tab @code{info spu}
14295
14296 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
14297 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
14298 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
14299
14300 @item @code{search-memory}
14301 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
14302 @tab @code{find}
14303
14304 @item @code{supported-packets}
14305 @tab @code{qSupported}
14306 @tab Remote communications parameters
14307
14308 @item @code{pass-signals}
14309 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
14310 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
14311
14312 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
14313 @tab @code{vFile:close}
14314 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14315
14316 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
14317 @tab @code{vFile:open}
14318 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14319
14320 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
14321 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
14322 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14323
14324 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
14325 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
14326 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14327
14328 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
14329 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
14330 @tab @code{remote delete}
14331
14332 @item @code{noack-packet}
14333 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
14334 @tab Packet acknowledgment
14335
14336 @item @code{osdata}
14337 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
14338 @tab @code{info os}
14339 @end multitable
14340
14341 @node Remote Stub
14342 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
14343
14344 @cindex debugging stub, example
14345 @cindex remote stub, example
14346 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
14347 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
14348 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
14349 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
14350 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
14351 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
14352 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
14353 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
14354
14355 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
14356 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
14357 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
14358 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
14359 program, you need:
14360
14361 @enumerate
14362 @item
14363 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
14364 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
14365 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
14366
14367 @item
14368 A C subroutine library to support your program's
14369 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
14370
14371 @item
14372 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
14373 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
14374 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
14375 documentation.
14376 @end enumerate
14377
14378 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
14379 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
14380 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
14381
14382 @table @emph
14383 @item On the host,
14384 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
14385 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
14386 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
14387
14388 @item On the target,
14389 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
14390 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
14391 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
14392
14393 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
14394 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
14395 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
14396 @end table
14397
14398 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
14399 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
14400 @sc{sparc} boards.
14401
14402 @cindex remote serial stub list
14403 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
14404
14405 @table @code
14406
14407 @item i386-stub.c
14408 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
14409 @cindex Intel
14410 @cindex i386
14411 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
14412
14413 @item m68k-stub.c
14414 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
14415 @cindex Motorola 680x0
14416 @cindex m680x0
14417 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
14418
14419 @item sh-stub.c
14420 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
14421 @cindex Renesas
14422 @cindex SH
14423 For Renesas SH architectures.
14424
14425 @item sparc-stub.c
14426 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
14427 @cindex Sparc
14428 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
14429
14430 @item sparcl-stub.c
14431 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
14432 @cindex Fujitsu
14433 @cindex SparcLite
14434 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
14435
14436 @end table
14437
14438 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
14439 recently added stubs.
14440
14441 @menu
14442 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
14443 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
14444 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
14445 @end menu
14446
14447 @node Stub Contents
14448 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
14449
14450 @cindex remote serial stub
14451 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
14452 subroutines:
14453
14454 @table @code
14455 @item set_debug_traps
14456 @findex set_debug_traps
14457 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
14458 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
14459 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
14460 beginning of your program.
14461
14462 @item handle_exception
14463 @findex handle_exception
14464 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
14465 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
14466 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
14467 run when a trap is triggered.
14468
14469 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
14470 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
14471 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
14472 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
14473 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
14474 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
14475 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
14476 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
14477 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
14478 machine.
14479
14480 @item breakpoint
14481 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
14482 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
14483 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
14484 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
14485 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
14486 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
14487 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
14488 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
14489 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
14490 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
14491 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
14492
14493 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
14494 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
14495 start of your debugging session.
14496 @end table
14497
14498 @node Bootstrapping
14499 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
14500
14501 @cindex remote stub, support routines
14502 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
14503 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
14504 debugging target machine.
14505
14506 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
14507 serial port.
14508
14509 @table @code
14510 @item int getDebugChar()
14511 @findex getDebugChar
14512 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
14513 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
14514 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14515
14516 @item void putDebugChar(int)
14517 @findex putDebugChar
14518 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
14519 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
14520 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14521 @end table
14522
14523 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
14524 @cindex interrupting remote targets
14525 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
14526 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
14527 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
14528 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
14529 remote system to stop.
14530
14531 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
14532 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
14533 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
14534 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
14535
14536 Other routines you need to supply are:
14537
14538 @table @code
14539 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
14540 @findex exceptionHandler
14541 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
14542 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
14543 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
14544 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
14545 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
14546 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
14547 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
14548 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
14549 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
14550 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
14551 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
14552 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
14553 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
14554
14555 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
14556 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
14557 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
14558 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
14559 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
14560
14561 @item void flush_i_cache()
14562 @findex flush_i_cache
14563 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
14564 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
14565 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
14566
14567 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
14568 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
14569 @end table
14570
14571 @noindent
14572 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
14573
14574 @table @code
14575 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
14576 @findex memset
14577 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
14578 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
14579 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
14580 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
14581 @end table
14582
14583 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
14584 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
14585 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
14586 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
14587
14588
14589 @node Debug Session
14590 @subsection Putting it All Together
14591
14592 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
14593 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
14594 steps.
14595
14596 @enumerate
14597 @item
14598 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
14599 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
14600 @display
14601 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
14602 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
14603 @end display
14604
14605 @item
14606 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
14607
14608 @smallexample
14609 set_debug_traps();
14610 breakpoint();
14611 @end smallexample
14612
14613 @item
14614 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
14615 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
14616
14617 @smallexample
14618 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
14619 @end smallexample
14620
14621 @noindent
14622 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
14623 function in your program, that function is called when
14624 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
14625 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
14626 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
14627
14628 @item
14629 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
14630 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
14631
14632 @item
14633 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
14634 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
14635
14636 @item
14637 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
14638 @c document that. FIXME.
14639 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
14640 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
14641
14642 @item
14643 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
14644 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14645
14646 @end enumerate
14647
14648 @node Configurations
14649 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
14650
14651 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
14652 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
14653 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
14654
14655 There are three major categories of configurations: native
14656 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
14657 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
14658 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
14659 are quite different from each other.
14660
14661 @menu
14662 * Native::
14663 * Embedded OS::
14664 * Embedded Processors::
14665 * Architectures::
14666 @end menu
14667
14668 @node Native
14669 @section Native
14670
14671 This section describes details specific to particular native
14672 configurations.
14673
14674 @menu
14675 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
14676 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
14677 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
14678 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
14679 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
14680 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
14681 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
14682 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
14683 @end menu
14684
14685 @node HP-UX
14686 @subsection HP-UX
14687
14688 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
14689 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
14690 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
14691
14692
14693 @node BSD libkvm Interface
14694 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
14695
14696 @cindex libkvm
14697 @cindex kernel memory image
14698 @cindex kernel crash dump
14699
14700 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
14701 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
14702 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
14703 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
14704 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
14705 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
14706 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
14707 @code{kvm} target:
14708
14709 @smallexample
14710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
14711 @end smallexample
14712
14713 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
14714 argument:
14715
14716 @smallexample
14717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
14718 @end smallexample
14719
14720 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
14721 available:
14722
14723 @table @code
14724 @kindex kvm
14725 @item kvm pcb
14726 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
14727
14728 @item kvm proc
14729 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
14730 modern FreeBSD systems.
14731 @end table
14732
14733 @node SVR4 Process Information
14734 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
14735 @cindex /proc
14736 @cindex examine process image
14737 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
14738
14739 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
14740 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
14741 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
14742 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
14743 proc} is available to report information about the process running
14744 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
14745 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
14746 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
14747 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
14748
14749 @table @code
14750 @kindex info proc
14751 @cindex process ID
14752 @item info proc
14753 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
14754 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
14755 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
14756 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
14757 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
14758 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
14759 executable file's absolute file name.
14760
14761 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
14762 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
14763 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
14764 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
14765 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
14766 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
14767
14768 @item info proc mappings
14769 @cindex memory address space mappings
14770 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
14771 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
14772 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
14773 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
14774 memory access rights to that range.
14775
14776 @item info proc stat
14777 @itemx info proc status
14778 @cindex process detailed status information
14779 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
14780 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
14781 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
14782 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
14783 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
14784 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
14785 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
14786
14787 @item info proc all
14788 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
14789 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
14790
14791 @ignore
14792 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
14793 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
14794 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
14795 @kindex info proc times
14796 @item info proc times
14797 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
14798 its children.
14799
14800 @kindex info proc id
14801 @item info proc id
14802 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
14803 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
14804 @end ignore
14805
14806 @item set procfs-trace
14807 @kindex set procfs-trace
14808 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
14809 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
14810
14811 @item show procfs-trace
14812 @kindex show procfs-trace
14813 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
14814
14815 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
14816 @kindex set procfs-file
14817 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
14818 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
14819 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
14820 standard output.
14821
14822 @item show procfs-file
14823 @kindex show procfs-file
14824 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
14825
14826 @item proc-trace-entry
14827 @itemx proc-trace-exit
14828 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
14829 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
14830 @kindex proc-trace-entry
14831 @kindex proc-trace-exit
14832 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
14833 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
14834 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
14835 from the @code{syscall} interface.
14836
14837 @item info pidlist
14838 @kindex info pidlist
14839 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
14840 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
14841 processes and all the threads within each process.
14842
14843 @item info meminfo
14844 @kindex info meminfo
14845 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
14846 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
14847 @end table
14848
14849 @node DJGPP Native
14850 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
14851 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
14852 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
14853 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
14854
14855 @cindex DPMI
14856 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
14857 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
14858 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
14859 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
14860
14861 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
14862 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
14863 subsection describes those commands.
14864
14865 @table @code
14866 @kindex info dos
14867 @item info dos
14868 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
14869 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14870
14871 @kindex sysinfo
14872 @cindex MS-DOS system info
14873 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
14874 @item info dos sysinfo
14875 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
14876 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
14877 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
14878
14879 @cindex GDT
14880 @cindex LDT
14881 @cindex IDT
14882 @cindex segment descriptor tables
14883 @cindex descriptor tables display
14884 @item info dos gdt
14885 @itemx info dos ldt
14886 @itemx info dos idt
14887 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
14888 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
14889 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
14890 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
14891 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
14892 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
14893 rights.
14894
14895 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
14896 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
14897 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
14898 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
14899 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
14900
14901 @cindex garbled pointers
14902 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
14903 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
14904 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
14905 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
14906 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
14907 debugged program's data segment:
14908
14909 @smallexample
14910 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
14911 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
14912 @end smallexample
14913
14914 @noindent
14915 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14916 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14917
14918 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14919 @item info dos pde
14920 @itemx info dos pte
14921 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14922 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14923 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14924 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14925 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14926 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14927 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14928 that is currently in use.
14929
14930 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14931 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14932 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14933 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14934 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14935 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14936 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14937
14938 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14939 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14940 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14941 controller.
14942
14943 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14944
14945 @cindex physical address from linear address
14946 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14947 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14948 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14949 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14950 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14951 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14952 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14953
14954 @smallexample
14955 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14956 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14957 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14958 @end smallexample
14959
14960 @noindent
14961 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14962 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14963 attributes of that page.
14964
14965 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14966 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14967 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14968 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14969 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14970 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14971
14972 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14973 transfer buffer:
14974
14975 @smallexample
14976 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14977 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14978 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14979 @end smallexample
14980
14981 @noindent
14982 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
14983 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14984 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14985 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14986 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14987
14988 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14989 @end table
14990
14991 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14992 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14993 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14994 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14995
14996 @table @code
14997 @kindex set com1base
14998 @kindex set com1irq
14999 @kindex set com2base
15000 @kindex set com2irq
15001 @kindex set com3base
15002 @kindex set com3irq
15003 @kindex set com4base
15004 @kindex set com4irq
15005 @item set com1base @var{addr}
15006 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
15007 port.
15008
15009 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
15010 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
15011 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
15012
15013 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
15014 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
15015 other 3 COM ports.
15016
15017 @kindex show com1base
15018 @kindex show com1irq
15019 @kindex show com2base
15020 @kindex show com2irq
15021 @kindex show com3base
15022 @kindex show com3irq
15023 @kindex show com4base
15024 @kindex show com4irq
15025 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
15026 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
15027 lines used by the COM ports.
15028
15029 @item info serial
15030 @kindex info serial
15031 @cindex DOS serial port status
15032 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
15033 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
15034 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
15035 counts of various errors encountered so far.
15036 @end table
15037
15038
15039 @node Cygwin Native
15040 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
15041 @cindex MS Windows debugging
15042 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
15043 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
15044
15045 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
15046 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
15047 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
15048 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
15049 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
15050
15051 @table @code
15052 @kindex info w32
15053 @item info w32
15054 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
15055 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15056
15057 @item info w32 selector
15058 This command displays information returned by
15059 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
15060 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
15061 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
15062 Without argument, this command displays information
15063 about the six segment registers.
15064
15065 @kindex info dll
15066 @item info dll
15067 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
15068
15069 @kindex dll-symbols
15070 @item dll-symbols
15071 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
15072 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
15073
15074 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
15075 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
15076 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
15077 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
15078 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
15079 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
15080 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
15081 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
15082 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
15083 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
15084 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
15085
15086 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
15087 @item show cygwin-exceptions
15088 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
15089 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
15090
15091 @kindex set new-console
15092 @item set new-console @var{mode}
15093 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
15094 be started in a new console on next start.
15095 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
15096 be started in the same console as the debugger.
15097
15098 @kindex show new-console
15099 @item show new-console
15100 Displays whether a new console is used
15101 when the debuggee is started.
15102
15103 @kindex set new-group
15104 @item set new-group @var{mode}
15105 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
15106 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
15107 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
15108 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
15109
15110 @kindex show new-group
15111 @item show new-group
15112 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
15113
15114 @kindex set debugevents
15115 @item set debugevents
15116 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
15117 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
15118 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
15119 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
15120 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
15121
15122 @kindex set debugexec
15123 @item set debugexec
15124 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
15125 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
15126
15127 @kindex set debugexceptions
15128 @item set debugexceptions
15129 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
15130 debuggee seen by the debugger.
15131
15132 @kindex set debugmemory
15133 @item set debugmemory
15134 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
15135 and writes by the debugger.
15136
15137 @kindex set shell
15138 @item set shell
15139 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
15140 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
15141
15142 @kindex show shell
15143 @item show shell
15144 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
15145
15146 @end table
15147
15148 @menu
15149 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
15150 @end menu
15151
15152 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
15153 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
15154 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
15155 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
15156
15157 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
15158 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
15159 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
15160 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
15161 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
15162 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
15163 ``minimal symbols''.
15164
15165 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
15166 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
15167 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
15168 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
15169 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
15170 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
15171 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
15172 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
15173 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
15174 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
15175
15176 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
15177
15178 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
15179 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
15180 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
15181 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
15182 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
15183 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
15184 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
15185 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
15186 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
15187
15188 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
15189 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
15190 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
15191 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
15192 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
15193 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
15194
15195 @smallexample
15196 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
15197 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
15198
15199 Non-debugging symbols:
15200 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
15201 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
15202 @end smallexample
15203
15204 @smallexample
15205 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
15206 All functions matching regular expression "!":
15207
15208 Non-debugging symbols:
15209 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
15210 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
15211 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
15212 [etc...]
15213 @end smallexample
15214
15215 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
15216
15217 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
15218 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
15219 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
15220 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
15221 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
15222 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
15223 a function within a DLL without a running program.
15224
15225 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
15226 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
15227 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
15228 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
15229 problem:
15230
15231 @smallexample
15232 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
15233 $1 = 268572168
15234 @end smallexample
15235
15236 @smallexample
15237 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
15238 0x10021610: "\230y\""
15239 @end smallexample
15240
15241 And two possible solutions:
15242
15243 @smallexample
15244 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
15245 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15246 @end smallexample
15247
15248 @smallexample
15249 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
15250 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
15251 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
15252 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
15253 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
15254 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15255 @end smallexample
15256
15257 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
15258 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
15259 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
15260 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
15261 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
15262
15263 @smallexample
15264 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
15265 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
15266 @end smallexample
15267
15268 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
15269 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
15270 safe.
15271
15272 @node Hurd Native
15273 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
15274 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
15275
15276 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
15277 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
15278
15279 @table @code
15280 @item set signals
15281 @itemx set sigs
15282 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
15283 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15284 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
15285 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
15286 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
15287 @code{signals}.
15288
15289 @item show signals
15290 @itemx show sigs
15291 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
15292 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15293 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
15294
15295 @item set signal-thread
15296 @itemx set sigthread
15297 @kindex set signal-thread
15298 @kindex set sigthread
15299 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
15300 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
15301 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
15302 signal-thread}.
15303
15304 @item show signal-thread
15305 @itemx show sigthread
15306 @kindex show signal-thread
15307 @kindex show sigthread
15308 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
15309 delivered a signal.
15310
15311 @item set stopped
15312 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15313 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
15314 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
15315 continued by delivering a signal to it.
15316
15317 @item show stopped
15318 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15319 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
15320 stopped.
15321
15322 @item set exceptions
15323 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15324 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
15325 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
15326 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
15327 trapping on.
15328
15329 @item show exceptions
15330 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15331 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
15332
15333 @item set task pause
15334 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
15335 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15336 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15337 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
15338 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
15339 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
15340 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
15341 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
15342 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
15343
15344 @item show task pause
15345 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
15346 Show the current state of task suspension.
15347
15348 @item set task detach-suspend-count
15349 @cindex task suspend count
15350 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15351 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
15352 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
15353
15354 @item show task detach-suspend-count
15355 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
15356
15357 @item set task exception-port
15358 @itemx set task excp
15359 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15360 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
15361 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
15362 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
15363
15364 @item set noninvasive
15365 @cindex noninvasive task options
15366 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
15367 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
15368 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
15369 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
15370
15371 @item info send-rights
15372 @itemx info receive-rights
15373 @itemx info port-rights
15374 @itemx info port-sets
15375 @itemx info dead-names
15376 @itemx info ports
15377 @itemx info psets
15378 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15379 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15380 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15381 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15382 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15383 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
15384 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
15385 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
15386 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
15387
15388 @item set thread pause
15389 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
15390 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15391 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15392 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
15393 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
15394 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
15395 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
15396 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
15397 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
15398 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
15399 only the current thread.
15400
15401 @item show thread pause
15402 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
15403 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
15404
15405 @item set thread run
15406 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15407
15408 @item show thread run
15409 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15410
15411 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
15412 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15413 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15414 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
15415 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
15416 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
15417 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
15418
15419 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
15420 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
15421 detaching.
15422
15423 @item set thread exception-port
15424 @itemx set thread excp
15425 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
15426 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
15427 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
15428
15429 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
15430 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
15431 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
15432 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
15433
15434 @item set thread default
15435 @itemx show thread default
15436 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15437 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
15438 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
15439 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
15440 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
15441 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
15442 the non-default commands.
15443 @end table
15444
15445
15446 @node Neutrino
15447 @subsection QNX Neutrino
15448 @cindex QNX Neutrino
15449
15450 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
15451 Neutrino target:
15452
15453 @table @code
15454 @item set debug nto-debug
15455 @kindex set debug nto-debug
15456 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
15457 Neutrino support.
15458
15459 @item show debug nto-debug
15460 @kindex show debug nto-debug
15461 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
15462 @end table
15463
15464 @node Darwin
15465 @subsection Darwin
15466 @cindex Darwin
15467
15468 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
15469
15470 @table @code
15471 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
15472 @kindex set debug darwin
15473 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
15474 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
15475
15476 @item show debug darwin
15477 @kindex show debug darwin
15478 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
15479
15480 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
15481 @kindex set debug mach-o
15482 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
15483 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
15484 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
15485 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
15486 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
15487 usage.
15488
15489 @item show debug mach-o
15490 @kindex show debug mach-o
15491 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
15492
15493 @item set mach-exceptions on
15494 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
15495 @kindex set mach-exceptions
15496 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
15497 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
15498 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
15499 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
15500
15501 @item show mach-exceptions
15502 @kindex show mach-exceptions
15503 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
15504 @end table
15505
15506
15507 @node Embedded OS
15508 @section Embedded Operating Systems
15509
15510 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
15511 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
15512 architectures.
15513
15514 @menu
15515 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15516 @end menu
15517
15518 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
15519 various real-time operating systems.
15520
15521 @node VxWorks
15522 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15523
15524 @cindex VxWorks
15525
15526 @table @code
15527
15528 @kindex target vxworks
15529 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
15530 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
15531 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
15532
15533 @end table
15534
15535 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
15536 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
15537
15538 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
15539 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
15540 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15541 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
15542 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
15543 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
15544 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
15545
15546 @table @code
15547 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
15548 @kindex vxworks-timeout
15549 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
15550 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15551 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
15552 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
15553 of a thin network line.
15554 @end table
15555
15556 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
15557 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
15558 procedures.
15559
15560 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
15561 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
15562 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
15563 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
15564 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
15565 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
15566 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
15567 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
15568 manual.
15569 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
15570
15571 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
15572 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15573 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
15574 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
15575
15576 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15577
15578 @smallexample
15579 (vxgdb)
15580 @end smallexample
15581
15582 @menu
15583 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
15584 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
15585 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
15586 @end menu
15587
15588 @node VxWorks Connection
15589 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
15590
15591 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
15592 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
15593
15594 @smallexample
15595 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
15596 @end smallexample
15597
15598 @need 750
15599 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15600
15601 @smallexample
15602 Attaching remote machine across net...
15603 Connected to tt.
15604 @end smallexample
15605
15606 @need 1000
15607 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
15608 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
15609 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
15610 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
15611 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
15612
15613 @smallexample
15614 prog.o: No such file or directory.
15615 @end smallexample
15616
15617 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
15618 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
15619 command again.
15620
15621 @node VxWorks Download
15622 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
15623
15624 @cindex download to VxWorks
15625 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
15626 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
15627 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
15628 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
15629 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
15630 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
15631 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
15632 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
15633 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
15634 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
15635 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
15636 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
15637 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
15638 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
15639 program, type this on VxWorks:
15640
15641 @smallexample
15642 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
15643 @end smallexample
15644
15645 @noindent
15646 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15647
15648 @smallexample
15649 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
15650 (vxgdb) load prog.o
15651 @end smallexample
15652
15653 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
15654
15655 @smallexample
15656 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
15657 @end smallexample
15658
15659 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
15660 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
15661 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
15662 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
15663 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
15664 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
15665 table.)
15666
15667 @node VxWorks Attach
15668 @subsubsection Running Tasks
15669
15670 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
15671 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
15672 follows:
15673
15674 @smallexample
15675 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
15676 @end smallexample
15677
15678 @noindent
15679 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
15680 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
15681 the time of attachment.
15682
15683 @node Embedded Processors
15684 @section Embedded Processors
15685
15686 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
15687 configurations.
15688
15689 @cindex send command to simulator
15690 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
15691 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
15692
15693 @table @code
15694 @item sim @var{command}
15695 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
15696 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
15697 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
15698 acceptable commands.
15699 @end table
15700
15701
15702 @menu
15703 * ARM:: ARM RDI
15704 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
15705 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
15706 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
15707 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
15708 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
15709 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
15710 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
15711 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
15712 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
15713 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
15714 * CRIS:: CRIS
15715 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
15716 @end menu
15717
15718 @node ARM
15719 @subsection ARM
15720 @cindex ARM RDI
15721
15722 @table @code
15723 @kindex target rdi
15724 @item target rdi @var{dev}
15725 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
15726 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
15727 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
15728
15729 @kindex target rdp
15730 @item target rdp @var{dev}
15731 ARM Demon monitor.
15732
15733 @end table
15734
15735 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
15736
15737 @table @code
15738 @item set arm disassembler
15739 @kindex set arm
15740 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
15741 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
15742
15743 @item show arm disassembler
15744 @kindex show arm
15745 Show the current disassembly style.
15746
15747 @item set arm apcs32
15748 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
15749 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
15750
15751 @item show arm apcs32
15752 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
15753
15754 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
15755 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
15756 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
15757
15758 @table @code
15759 @item auto
15760 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
15761 @item softfpa
15762 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
15763 processors.
15764 @item fpa
15765 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
15766 @item softvfp
15767 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
15768 @item vfp
15769 VFP co-processor.
15770 @end table
15771
15772 @item show arm fpu
15773 Show the current type of the FPU.
15774
15775 @item set arm abi
15776 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
15777
15778 @item show arm abi
15779 Show the currently used ABI.
15780
15781 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15782 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
15783 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
15784 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
15785 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
15786 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
15787 register).
15788
15789 @item show arm fallback-mode
15790 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
15791
15792 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15793 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
15794 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
15795 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
15796 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
15797
15798 @item show arm force-mode
15799 Show the current forced instruction mode.
15800
15801 @item set debug arm
15802 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
15803 target support subsystem.
15804
15805 @item show debug arm
15806 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
15807 @end table
15808
15809 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
15810 using the RDI interface:
15811
15812 @table @code
15813 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15814 @kindex rdilogfile
15815 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
15816 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
15817 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
15818 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
15819 @file{rdi.log}.
15820
15821 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
15822 @kindex rdilogenable
15823 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
15824 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
15825 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
15826 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
15827 are logged to a file.
15828
15829 @item set rdiromatzero
15830 @kindex set rdiromatzero
15831 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
15832 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
15833 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
15834 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
15835 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
15836
15837 @item show rdiromatzero
15838 @kindex show rdiromatzero
15839 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
15840
15841 @item set rdiheartbeat
15842 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
15843 @cindex RDI heartbeat
15844 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
15845 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
15846 well as the Angel monitor.
15847
15848 @item show rdiheartbeat
15849 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
15850 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
15851 @end table
15852
15853
15854 @node M32R/D
15855 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
15856
15857 @table @code
15858 @kindex target m32r
15859 @item target m32r @var{dev}
15860 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
15861
15862 @kindex target m32rsdi
15863 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
15864 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
15865 @end table
15866
15867 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
15868
15869 @table @code
15870 @item set download-path @var{path}
15871 @kindex set download-path
15872 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
15873 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15874
15875 @item show download-path
15876 @kindex show download-path
15877 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15878
15879 @item set board-address @var{addr}
15880 @kindex set board-address
15881 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
15882 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
15883
15884 @item show board-address
15885 @kindex show board-address
15886 Show the current IP address of the target board.
15887
15888 @item set server-address @var{addr}
15889 @kindex set server-address
15890 @cindex download server address (M32R)
15891 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
15892 host machine.
15893
15894 @item show server-address
15895 @kindex show server-address
15896 Display the IP address of the download server.
15897
15898 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15899 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
15900 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
15901 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
15902 executable file is uploaded.
15903
15904 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15905 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
15906 Test the @code{upload} command.
15907 @end table
15908
15909 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
15910
15911 @table @code
15912 @item sdireset
15913 @kindex sdireset
15914 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
15915 This command resets the SDI connection.
15916
15917 @item sdistatus
15918 @kindex sdistatus
15919 This command shows the SDI connection status.
15920
15921 @item debug_chaos
15922 @kindex debug_chaos
15923 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
15924 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
15925
15926 @item use_debug_dma
15927 @kindex use_debug_dma
15928 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
15929
15930 @item use_mon_code
15931 @kindex use_mon_code
15932 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
15933
15934 @item use_ib_break
15935 @kindex use_ib_break
15936 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
15937
15938 @item use_dbt_break
15939 @kindex use_dbt_break
15940 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
15941 @end table
15942
15943 @node M68K
15944 @subsection M68k
15945
15946 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
15947 target command for the following ROM monitor.
15948
15949 @table @code
15950
15951 @kindex target dbug
15952 @item target dbug @var{dev}
15953 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
15954
15955 @end table
15956
15957 @node MIPS Embedded
15958 @subsection MIPS Embedded
15959
15960 @cindex MIPS boards
15961 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
15962 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
15963 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
15964
15965 @need 1000
15966 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
15967
15968 @table @code
15969 @item target mips @var{port}
15970 @kindex target mips @var{port}
15971 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
15972 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
15973 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
15974 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
15975 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15976 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15977
15978 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15979 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15980 debugger:
15981
15982 @smallexample
15983 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15984 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15985 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
15986 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
15987 (@value{GDBP}) run
15988 @end smallexample
15989
15990 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
15991 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
15992 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
15993 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
15994 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15995
15996 @item target pmon @var{port}
15997 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
15998 PMON ROM monitor.
15999
16000 @item target ddb @var{port}
16001 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
16002 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
16003
16004 @item target lsi @var{port}
16005 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
16006 LSI variant of PMON.
16007
16008 @kindex target r3900
16009 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
16010 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
16011
16012 @kindex target array
16013 @item target array @var{dev}
16014 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
16015
16016 @end table
16017
16018
16019 @noindent
16020 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
16021
16022 @table @code
16023 @item set mipsfpu double
16024 @itemx set mipsfpu single
16025 @itemx set mipsfpu none
16026 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
16027 @itemx show mipsfpu
16028 @kindex set mipsfpu
16029 @kindex show mipsfpu
16030 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
16031 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
16032 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
16033 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
16034 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
16035 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
16036 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
16037 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
16038 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
16039 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
16040 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
16041 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
16042 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
16043
16044 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
16045 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
16046 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
16047
16048 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
16049 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
16050
16051 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
16052 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
16053 @itemx show timeout
16054 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
16055 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
16056 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
16057 @kindex set timeout
16058 @kindex show timeout
16059 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
16060 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
16061 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
16062 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
16063 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
16064 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
16065 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
16066 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
16067 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
16068 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
16069
16070 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
16071 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
16072 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
16073 to run before stopping.
16074
16075 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
16076 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16077 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
16078 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
16079 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
16080 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
16081
16082 @item show syn-garbage-limit
16083 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16084 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
16085 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
16086
16087 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
16088 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16089 @cindex remote monitor prompt
16090 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
16091 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
16092 @table @asis
16093 @item pmon target
16094 @samp{PMON}
16095 @item ddb target
16096 @samp{NEC010}
16097 @item lsi target
16098 @samp{PMON>}
16099 @end table
16100
16101 @item show monitor-prompt
16102 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16103 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
16104 remote monitor.
16105
16106 @item set monitor-warnings
16107 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16108 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
16109 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
16110 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
16111 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
16112
16113 @item show monitor-warnings
16114 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16115 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
16116
16117 @item pmon @var{command}
16118 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
16119 @cindex send PMON command
16120 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
16121 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
16122 @end table
16123
16124 @node OpenRISC 1000
16125 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
16126 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
16127
16128 @cindex or1k boards
16129 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
16130 about platform and commands.
16131
16132 @table @code
16133
16134 @kindex target jtag
16135 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
16136
16137 Connects to remote JTAG server.
16138 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
16139 connected via parallel port to the board.
16140
16141 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
16142
16143 @kindex or1ksim
16144 @item or1ksim @var{command}
16145 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
16146 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
16147
16148 @kindex info or1k spr
16149 @item info or1k spr
16150 Displays spr groups.
16151
16152 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
16153 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
16154 Displays register names in selected group.
16155
16156 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
16157 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
16158 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
16159 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
16160 Shows information about specified spr register.
16161
16162 @kindex spr
16163 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
16164 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
16165 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
16166 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
16167 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
16168 @end table
16169
16170 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
16171 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
16172 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
16173 triggers can be set using:
16174 @table @code
16175 @item $LEA/$LDATA
16176 Load effective address/data
16177 @item $SEA/$SDATA
16178 Store effective address/data
16179 @item $AEA/$ADATA
16180 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
16181 @item $FETCH
16182 Fetch data
16183 @end table
16184
16185 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
16186 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
16187
16188 @code{htrace} commands:
16189 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
16190 @table @code
16191 @kindex hwatch
16192 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
16193 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
16194 or Data. For example:
16195
16196 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16197
16198 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16199
16200 @kindex htrace
16201 @item htrace info
16202 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
16203
16204 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
16205 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
16206
16207 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
16208 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
16209
16210 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
16211 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
16212
16213 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
16214 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
16215 triggered.
16216
16217 @item htrace enable
16218 @itemx htrace disable
16219 Enables/disables the HW trace.
16220
16221 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
16222 Clears currently recorded trace data.
16223
16224 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
16225 will be written there.
16226
16227 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
16228 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
16229
16230 @item htrace mode continuous
16231 Set continuous trace mode.
16232
16233 @item htrace mode suspend
16234 Set suspend trace mode.
16235
16236 @end table
16237
16238 @node PowerPC Embedded
16239 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
16240
16241 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
16242
16243 @table @code
16244 @kindex set powerpc
16245 @item set powerpc soft-float
16246 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
16247 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
16248 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
16249 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16250
16251 @item set powerpc vector-abi
16252 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
16253 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
16254 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
16255 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
16256 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
16257 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
16258 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16259
16260 @kindex target dink32
16261 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
16262 DINK32 ROM monitor.
16263
16264 @kindex target ppcbug
16265 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
16266 @kindex target ppcbug1
16267 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
16268 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
16269
16270 @kindex target sds
16271 @item target sds @var{dev}
16272 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
16273 @end table
16274
16275 @cindex SDS protocol
16276 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
16277 by @value{GDBN}:
16278
16279 @table @code
16280 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
16281 @kindex set sdstimeout
16282 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
16283 default is 2 seconds.
16284
16285 @item show sdstimeout
16286 @kindex show sdstimeout
16287 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
16288
16289 @item sds @var{command}
16290 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
16291 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
16292 @end table
16293
16294
16295 @node PA
16296 @subsection HP PA Embedded
16297
16298 @table @code
16299
16300 @kindex target op50n
16301 @item target op50n @var{dev}
16302 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
16303
16304 @kindex target w89k
16305 @item target w89k @var{dev}
16306 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
16307
16308 @end table
16309
16310 @node Sparclet
16311 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
16312
16313 @cindex Sparclet
16314
16315 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
16316 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
16317 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
16318 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
16319 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
16320
16321 @table @code
16322 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
16323 @kindex remotetimeout
16324 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
16325 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
16326 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
16327 @end table
16328
16329 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
16330 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
16331 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
16332 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
16333 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
16334
16335 @smallexample
16336 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
16337 @end smallexample
16338
16339 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
16340
16341 @smallexample
16342 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
16343 @end smallexample
16344
16345 @cindex running, on Sparclet
16346 Once you have set
16347 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
16348 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
16349 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
16350
16351 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16352
16353 @smallexample
16354 (gdbslet)
16355 @end smallexample
16356
16357 @menu
16358 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
16359 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
16360 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
16361 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
16362 @end menu
16363
16364 @node Sparclet File
16365 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
16366
16367 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
16368
16369 @smallexample
16370 (gdbslet) file prog
16371 @end smallexample
16372
16373 @need 1000
16374 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
16375 @value{GDBN} locates
16376 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
16377 path.
16378 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
16379 files will be searched as well.
16380 @value{GDBN} locates
16381 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
16382 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
16383 If it fails
16384 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
16385
16386 @smallexample
16387 prog: No such file or directory.
16388 @end smallexample
16389
16390 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
16391 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
16392 @code{target} command again.
16393
16394 @node Sparclet Connection
16395 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
16396
16397 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
16398 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
16399
16400 @smallexample
16401 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
16402 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
16403 main () at ../prog.c:3
16404 @end smallexample
16405
16406 @need 750
16407 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16408
16409 @smallexample
16410 Connected to ttya.
16411 @end smallexample
16412
16413 @node Sparclet Download
16414 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
16415
16416 @cindex download to Sparclet
16417 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
16418 you can use the @value{GDBN}
16419 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
16420 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
16421 command.
16422 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
16423 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
16424 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
16425 of each of the file's sections.
16426 For instance, if the program
16427 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
16428 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16429
16430 @smallexample
16431 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
16432 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
16433 @end smallexample
16434
16435 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
16436 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
16437 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
16438
16439 @node Sparclet Execution
16440 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
16441
16442 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
16443 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
16444 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
16445 manual for the list of commands.
16446
16447 @smallexample
16448 (gdbslet) b main
16449 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
16450 (gdbslet) run
16451 Starting program: prog
16452 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
16453 3 char *symarg = 0;
16454 (gdbslet) step
16455 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
16456 (gdbslet)
16457 @end smallexample
16458
16459 @node Sparclite
16460 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
16461
16462 @table @code
16463
16464 @kindex target sparclite
16465 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
16466 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
16467 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
16468 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
16469 remote protocol.
16470
16471 @end table
16472
16473 @node Z8000
16474 @subsection Zilog Z8000
16475
16476 @cindex Z8000
16477 @cindex simulator, Z8000
16478 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
16479
16480 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
16481 a Z8000 simulator.
16482
16483 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
16484 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
16485 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
16486 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
16487
16488 @table @code
16489 @item target sim @var{args}
16490 @kindex sim
16491 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
16492 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
16493 options, specify them via @var{args}.
16494 @end table
16495
16496 @noindent
16497 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
16498 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
16499 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
16500 to run your program, and so on.
16501
16502 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
16503 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
16504 additional items of information as specially named registers:
16505
16506 @table @code
16507
16508 @item cycles
16509 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
16510
16511 @item insts
16512 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
16513
16514 @item time
16515 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
16516
16517 @end table
16518
16519 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
16520 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
16521 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
16522 simulated clock ticks.
16523
16524 @node AVR
16525 @subsection Atmel AVR
16526 @cindex AVR
16527
16528 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
16529 following AVR-specific commands:
16530
16531 @table @code
16532 @item info io_registers
16533 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
16534 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
16535 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
16536 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
16537 @end table
16538
16539 @node CRIS
16540 @subsection CRIS
16541 @cindex CRIS
16542
16543 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
16544 following CRIS-specific commands:
16545
16546 @table @code
16547 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
16548 @cindex CRIS version
16549 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
16550 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
16551 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
16552
16553 @item show cris-version
16554 Show the current CRIS version.
16555
16556 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
16557 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
16558 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
16559 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
16560 @code{R59}.
16561
16562 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
16563 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
16564
16565 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
16566 @cindex CRIS mode
16567 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
16568 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
16569 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
16570
16571 @item show cris-mode
16572 Show the current CRIS mode.
16573 @end table
16574
16575 @node Super-H
16576 @subsection Renesas Super-H
16577 @cindex Super-H
16578
16579 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
16580 commands:
16581
16582 @table @code
16583 @item regs
16584 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
16585 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
16586
16587 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
16588 @kindex set sh calling-convention
16589 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
16590 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
16591 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
16592 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
16593 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
16594 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
16595 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
16596 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
16597 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
16598 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
16599
16600 @item show sh calling-convention
16601 @kindex show sh calling-convention
16602 Show the current calling convention setting.
16603
16604 @end table
16605
16606
16607 @node Architectures
16608 @section Architectures
16609
16610 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
16611 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
16612
16613 @menu
16614 * i386::
16615 * A29K::
16616 * Alpha::
16617 * MIPS::
16618 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
16619 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16620 * PowerPC::
16621 @end menu
16622
16623 @node i386
16624 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
16625
16626 @table @code
16627 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
16628 @kindex set struct-convention
16629 @cindex struct return convention
16630 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
16631 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
16632 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
16633 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
16634 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
16635 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
16636 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
16637 be returned in a register.
16638
16639 @item show struct-convention
16640 @kindex show struct-convention
16641 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
16642 from functions.
16643 @end table
16644
16645 @node A29K
16646 @subsection A29K
16647
16648 @table @code
16649
16650 @kindex set rstack_high_address
16651 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
16652 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
16653 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
16654 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
16655 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
16656 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
16657 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
16658 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
16659 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
16660 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
16661 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
16662 hexadecimal.
16663
16664 @kindex show rstack_high_address
16665 @item show rstack_high_address
16666 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
16667 processors.
16668
16669 @end table
16670
16671 @node Alpha
16672 @subsection Alpha
16673
16674 See the following section.
16675
16676 @node MIPS
16677 @subsection MIPS
16678
16679 @cindex stack on Alpha
16680 @cindex stack on MIPS
16681 @cindex Alpha stack
16682 @cindex MIPS stack
16683 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
16684 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
16685 find the beginning of a function.
16686
16687 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
16688 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
16689 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
16690 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
16691 commands:
16692
16693 @table @code
16694 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
16695 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
16696 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
16697 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
16698 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
16699 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
16700 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
16701 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
16702
16703 @item show heuristic-fence-post
16704 Display the current limit.
16705 @end table
16706
16707 @noindent
16708 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
16709 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
16710
16711 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
16712 programs:
16713
16714 @table @code
16715 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
16716 @kindex set mips abi
16717 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
16718 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
16719 values of @var{arg} are:
16720
16721 @table @samp
16722 @item auto
16723 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
16724 default).
16725 @item o32
16726 @item o64
16727 @item n32
16728 @item n64
16729 @item eabi32
16730 @item eabi64
16731 @item auto
16732 @end table
16733
16734 @item show mips abi
16735 @kindex show mips abi
16736 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
16737
16738 @item set mipsfpu
16739 @itemx show mipsfpu
16740 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
16741
16742 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
16743 @kindex set mips mask-address
16744 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
16745 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
16746 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
16747 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
16748 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
16749
16750 @item show mips mask-address
16751 @kindex show mips mask-address
16752 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
16753 not.
16754
16755 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16756 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16757 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
16758 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
16759 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
16760 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
16761
16762 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16763 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16764 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
16765
16766 @item set debug mips
16767 @kindex set debug mips
16768 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
16769 target code in @value{GDBN}.
16770
16771 @item show debug mips
16772 @kindex show debug mips
16773 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
16774 @end table
16775
16776
16777 @node HPPA
16778 @subsection HPPA
16779 @cindex HPPA support
16780
16781 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
16782 following special commands:
16783
16784 @table @code
16785 @item set debug hppa
16786 @kindex set debug hppa
16787 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
16788 messages are to be displayed.
16789
16790 @item show debug hppa
16791 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
16792
16793 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
16794 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
16795 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
16796 given @var{address}.
16797
16798 @end table
16799
16800
16801 @node SPU
16802 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16803 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
16804 @cindex SPU
16805
16806 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
16807 it provides the following special commands:
16808
16809 @table @code
16810 @item info spu event
16811 @kindex info spu
16812 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
16813 and pending event status.
16814
16815 @item info spu signal
16816 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
16817 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
16818 notification channels.
16819
16820 @item info spu mailbox
16821 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
16822 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
16823 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
16824
16825 @item info spu dma
16826 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16827 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16828 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16829
16830 @item info spu proxydma
16831 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16832 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16833 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16834
16835 @end table
16836
16837 @node PowerPC
16838 @subsection PowerPC
16839 @cindex PowerPC architecture
16840
16841 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
16842 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
16843 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
16844 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
16845 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
16846
16847 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
16848 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
16849 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
16850
16851 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
16852 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
16853
16854
16855 @node Controlling GDB
16856 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
16857
16858 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
16859 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
16860 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
16861 described here.
16862
16863 @menu
16864 * Prompt:: Prompt
16865 * Editing:: Command editing
16866 * Command History:: Command history
16867 * Screen Size:: Screen size
16868 * Numbers:: Numbers
16869 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
16870 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
16871 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
16872 @end menu
16873
16874 @node Prompt
16875 @section Prompt
16876
16877 @cindex prompt
16878
16879 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
16880 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
16881 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
16882 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
16883 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
16884 which one you are talking to.
16885
16886 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
16887 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
16888 or a prompt that does not.
16889
16890 @table @code
16891 @kindex set prompt
16892 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
16893 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
16894
16895 @kindex show prompt
16896 @item show prompt
16897 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
16898 @end table
16899
16900 @node Editing
16901 @section Command Editing
16902 @cindex readline
16903 @cindex command line editing
16904
16905 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
16906 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
16907 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
16908 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
16909 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
16910 debugging sessions.
16911
16912 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
16913 command @code{set}.
16914
16915 @table @code
16916 @kindex set editing
16917 @cindex editing
16918 @item set editing
16919 @itemx set editing on
16920 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
16921
16922 @item set editing off
16923 Disable command line editing.
16924
16925 @kindex show editing
16926 @item show editing
16927 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
16928 @end table
16929
16930 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
16931 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
16932 encouraged to read that chapter.
16933
16934 @node Command History
16935 @section Command History
16936 @cindex command history
16937
16938 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
16939 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
16940 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
16941 history facility.
16942
16943 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
16944 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
16945 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
16946
16947 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
16948 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
16949 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
16950 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
16951 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
16952 pressed on a line by itself.
16953
16954 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
16955 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
16956 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
16957 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
16958
16959 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
16960 history.
16961
16962 @table @code
16963 @cindex history substitution
16964 @cindex history file
16965 @kindex set history filename
16966 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
16967 @item set history filename @var{fname}
16968 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
16969 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
16970 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
16971 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
16972 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
16973 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
16974 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
16975 is not set.
16976
16977 @cindex save command history
16978 @kindex set history save
16979 @item set history save
16980 @itemx set history save on
16981 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
16982 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
16983
16984 @item set history save off
16985 Stop recording command history in a file.
16986
16987 @cindex history size
16988 @kindex set history size
16989 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
16990 @item set history size @var{size}
16991 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
16992 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
16993 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
16994 @end table
16995
16996 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
16997 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
16998
16999 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
17000 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
17001 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
17002 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
17003 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
17004 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
17005 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
17006 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
17007
17008 The commands to control history expansion are:
17009
17010 @table @code
17011 @item set history expansion on
17012 @itemx set history expansion
17013 @kindex set history expansion
17014 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
17015
17016 @item set history expansion off
17017 Disable history expansion.
17018
17019 @c @group
17020 @kindex show history
17021 @item show history
17022 @itemx show history filename
17023 @itemx show history save
17024 @itemx show history size
17025 @itemx show history expansion
17026 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
17027 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
17028 @c @end group
17029 @end table
17030
17031 @table @code
17032 @kindex show commands
17033 @cindex show last commands
17034 @cindex display command history
17035 @item show commands
17036 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
17037
17038 @item show commands @var{n}
17039 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
17040
17041 @item show commands +
17042 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
17043 @end table
17044
17045 @node Screen Size
17046 @section Screen Size
17047 @cindex size of screen
17048 @cindex pauses in output
17049
17050 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
17051 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
17052 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
17053 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
17054 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
17055 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
17056 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
17057 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
17058
17059 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
17060 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
17061 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
17062 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
17063 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
17064 width} commands:
17065
17066 @table @code
17067 @kindex set height
17068 @kindex set width
17069 @kindex show width
17070 @kindex show height
17071 @item set height @var{lpp}
17072 @itemx show height
17073 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
17074 @itemx show width
17075 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
17076 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
17077 commands display the current settings.
17078
17079 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
17080 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
17081 file or to an editor buffer.
17082
17083 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
17084 from wrapping its output.
17085
17086 @item set pagination on
17087 @itemx set pagination off
17088 @kindex set pagination
17089 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
17090 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
17091
17092 @item show pagination
17093 @kindex show pagination
17094 Show the current pagination mode.
17095 @end table
17096
17097 @node Numbers
17098 @section Numbers
17099 @cindex number representation
17100 @cindex entering numbers
17101
17102 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
17103 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
17104 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
17105 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
17106 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
17107 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
17108 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
17109 both input and output with the commands described below.
17110
17111 @table @code
17112 @kindex set input-radix
17113 @item set input-radix @var{base}
17114 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
17115 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17116 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
17117 example, any of
17118
17119 @smallexample
17120 set input-radix 012
17121 set input-radix 10.
17122 set input-radix 0xa
17123 @end smallexample
17124
17125 @noindent
17126 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
17127 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
17128 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
17129 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
17130 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
17131 change the radix.
17132
17133 @kindex set output-radix
17134 @item set output-radix @var{base}
17135 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
17136 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17137 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
17138
17139 @kindex show input-radix
17140 @item show input-radix
17141 Display the current default base for numeric input.
17142
17143 @kindex show output-radix
17144 @item show output-radix
17145 Display the current default base for numeric display.
17146
17147 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
17148 @itemx show radix
17149 @kindex set radix
17150 @kindex show radix
17151 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
17152 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
17153 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
17154 default value of 10.
17155
17156 @end table
17157
17158 @node ABI
17159 @section Configuring the Current ABI
17160
17161 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
17162 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
17163 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
17164 current ABI.
17165
17166 @cindex OS ABI
17167 @kindex set osabi
17168 @kindex show osabi
17169
17170 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
17171 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
17172 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
17173 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
17174 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
17175 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
17176 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
17177 platform provides.
17178
17179 @table @code
17180 @item show osabi
17181 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
17182
17183 @item set osabi
17184 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
17185
17186 @item set osabi @var{abi}
17187 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
17188 @end table
17189
17190 @cindex float promotion
17191
17192 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
17193 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
17194 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
17195 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
17196 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
17197 @code{double} and then passed.
17198
17199 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
17200 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
17201 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
17202
17203 @table @code
17204 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
17205 @item set coerce-float-to-double
17206 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
17207 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
17208 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
17209
17210 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
17211 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
17212 functions.
17213
17214 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
17215 @item show coerce-float-to-double
17216 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
17217 @end table
17218
17219 @kindex set cp-abi
17220 @kindex show cp-abi
17221 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
17222 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
17223 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
17224 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
17225 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
17226 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
17227 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
17228 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
17229 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
17230 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
17231 ``auto''.
17232
17233 @table @code
17234 @item show cp-abi
17235 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
17236
17237 @item set cp-abi
17238 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
17239
17240 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
17241 @itemx set cp-abi auto
17242 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
17243 @end table
17244
17245 @node Messages/Warnings
17246 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
17247
17248 @cindex verbose operation
17249 @cindex optional warnings
17250 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
17251 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
17252 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
17253 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
17254
17255 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
17256 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
17257 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17258
17259 @table @code
17260 @kindex set verbose
17261 @item set verbose on
17262 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17263
17264 @item set verbose off
17265 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17266
17267 @kindex show verbose
17268 @item show verbose
17269 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
17270 @end table
17271
17272 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
17273 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
17274 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
17275 Symbol Files}).
17276
17277 @table @code
17278
17279 @kindex set complaints
17280 @item set complaints @var{limit}
17281 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
17282 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
17283 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
17284 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
17285
17286 @kindex show complaints
17287 @item show complaints
17288 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
17289
17290 @end table
17291
17292 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
17293 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
17294 you try to run a program which is already running:
17295
17296 @smallexample
17297 (@value{GDBP}) run
17298 The program being debugged has been started already.
17299 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
17300 @end smallexample
17301
17302 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
17303 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
17304
17305 @table @code
17306
17307 @kindex set confirm
17308 @cindex flinching
17309 @cindex confirmation
17310 @cindex stupid questions
17311 @item set confirm off
17312 Disables confirmation requests.
17313
17314 @item set confirm on
17315 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
17316
17317 @kindex show confirm
17318 @item show confirm
17319 Displays state of confirmation requests.
17320
17321 @end table
17322
17323 @cindex command tracing
17324 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
17325 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
17326 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
17327 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
17328
17329 @table @code
17330 @kindex set trace-commands
17331 @cindex command scripts, debugging
17332 @item set trace-commands on
17333 Enable command tracing.
17334 @item set trace-commands off
17335 Disable command tracing.
17336 @item show trace-commands
17337 Display the current state of command tracing.
17338 @end table
17339
17340 @node Debugging Output
17341 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
17342 @cindex optional debugging messages
17343
17344 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
17345 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
17346 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
17347 section documents those commands.
17348
17349 @table @code
17350 @kindex set exec-done-display
17351 @item set exec-done-display
17352 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
17353 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
17354 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
17355 @kindex show exec-done-display
17356 @item show exec-done-display
17357 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
17358 notification.
17359 @kindex set debug
17360 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
17361 @cindex architecture debugging info
17362 @item set debug arch
17363 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
17364 @kindex show debug
17365 @item show debug arch
17366 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
17367 @item set debug aix-thread
17368 @cindex AIX threads
17369 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
17370 module.
17371 @item show debug aix-thread
17372 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
17373 @item set debug dwarf2-die
17374 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
17375 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
17376 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
17377 A value of zero turns off the display.
17378 @item show debug dwarf2-die
17379 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
17380 @item set debug displaced
17381 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
17382 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
17383 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
17384 @item show debug displaced
17385 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
17386 related to displaced stepping.
17387 @item set debug event
17388 @cindex event debugging info
17389 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
17390 default is off.
17391 @item show debug event
17392 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
17393 info.
17394 @item set debug expression
17395 @cindex expression debugging info
17396 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
17397 expression parsing. The default is off.
17398 @item show debug expression
17399 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
17400 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
17401 @item set debug frame
17402 @cindex frame debugging info
17403 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
17404 default is off.
17405 @item show debug frame
17406 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
17407 info.
17408 @item set debug infrun
17409 @cindex inferior debugging info
17410 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
17411 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
17412 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
17413 @item show debug infrun
17414 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
17415 @item set debug lin-lwp
17416 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
17417 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17418 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
17419 @item show debug lin-lwp
17420 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
17421 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
17422 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
17423 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17424 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
17425 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
17426 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
17427 @item set debug observer
17428 @cindex observer debugging info
17429 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
17430 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
17431 @item show debug observer
17432 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
17433 @item set debug overload
17434 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
17435 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
17436 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
17437 is off.
17438 @item show debug overload
17439 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
17440 debugging info.
17441 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
17442 @cindex serial connections, debugging
17443 @cindex debug remote protocol
17444 @cindex remote protocol debugging
17445 @cindex display remote packets
17446 @item set debug remote
17447 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
17448 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
17449 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
17450 @item show debug remote
17451 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
17452 @item set debug serial
17453 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
17454 default is off.
17455 @item show debug serial
17456 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
17457 info.
17458 @item set debug solib-frv
17459 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
17460 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
17461 @item show debug solib-frv
17462 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
17463 messages.
17464 @item set debug target
17465 @cindex target debugging info
17466 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
17467 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
17468 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
17469 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
17470 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
17471 @item show debug target
17472 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
17473 info.
17474 @item set debug timestamp
17475 @cindex timestampping debugging info
17476 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
17477 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
17478 message.
17479 @item show debug timestamp
17480 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
17481 debugging info.
17482 @item set debugvarobj
17483 @cindex variable object debugging info
17484 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
17485 info. The default is off.
17486 @item show debugvarobj
17487 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
17488 debugging info.
17489 @item set debug xml
17490 @cindex XML parser debugging
17491 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
17492 @item show debug xml
17493 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
17494 @end table
17495
17496 @node Extending GDB
17497 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
17498 @cindex extending GDB
17499
17500 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
17501 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
17502 Python scripting language.
17503
17504 @menu
17505 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
17506 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17507 @end menu
17508
17509 @node Sequences
17510 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
17511
17512 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
17513 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
17514 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
17515 files.
17516
17517 @menu
17518 * Define:: How to define your own commands
17519 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
17520 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
17521 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
17522 @end menu
17523
17524 @node Define
17525 @subsection User-defined Commands
17526
17527 @cindex user-defined command
17528 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
17529 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
17530 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
17531 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
17532 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
17533 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
17534
17535 @smallexample
17536 define adder
17537 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17538 end
17539 @end smallexample
17540
17541 @noindent
17542 To execute the command use:
17543
17544 @smallexample
17545 adder 1 2 3
17546 @end smallexample
17547
17548 @noindent
17549 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
17550 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
17551 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
17552 functions calls.
17553
17554 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
17555 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
17556 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
17557 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
17558
17559 @smallexample
17560 define adder
17561 if $argc == 2
17562 print $arg0 + $arg1
17563 end
17564 if $argc == 3
17565 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17566 end
17567 end
17568 @end smallexample
17569
17570 @table @code
17571
17572 @kindex define
17573 @item define @var{commandname}
17574 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
17575 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
17576 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
17577 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
17578 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
17579 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
17580
17581 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
17582 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
17583 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17584
17585 @kindex document
17586 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
17587 @item document @var{commandname}
17588 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
17589 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
17590 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
17591 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
17592 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
17593 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
17594
17595 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
17596 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
17597 does not change the documentation.
17598
17599 @kindex dont-repeat
17600 @cindex don't repeat command
17601 @item dont-repeat
17602 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
17603 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
17604 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
17605
17606 @kindex help user-defined
17607 @item help user-defined
17608 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
17609 (if any) for each.
17610
17611 @kindex show user
17612 @item show user
17613 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
17614 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
17615 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
17616 definitions for all user-defined commands.
17617
17618 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
17619 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
17620 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
17621 @item show max-user-call-depth
17622 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
17623 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
17624 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
17625 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
17626 @end table
17627
17628 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
17629 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
17630
17631 When user-defined commands are executed, the
17632 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
17633 stops execution of the user-defined command.
17634
17635 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
17636 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
17637 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
17638 messages when used in a user-defined command.
17639
17640 @node Hooks
17641 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
17642 @cindex command hooks
17643 @cindex hooks, for commands
17644 @cindex hooks, pre-command
17645
17646 @kindex hook
17647 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
17648 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
17649 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
17650 before that command.
17651
17652 @cindex hooks, post-command
17653 @kindex hookpost
17654 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
17655 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
17656 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
17657 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
17658 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
17659
17660 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
17661 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
17662
17663 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
17664 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
17665
17666 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
17667 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
17668 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
17669 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
17670 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
17671
17672 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
17673 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
17674 you could define:
17675
17676 @smallexample
17677 define hook-stop
17678 handle SIGALRM nopass
17679 end
17680
17681 define hook-run
17682 handle SIGALRM pass
17683 end
17684
17685 define hook-continue
17686 handle SIGALRM pass
17687 end
17688 @end smallexample
17689
17690 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
17691 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
17692 you could define:
17693
17694 @smallexample
17695 define hook-echo
17696 echo <<<---
17697 end
17698
17699 define hookpost-echo
17700 echo --->>>\n
17701 end
17702
17703 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
17704 <<<---Hello World--->>>
17705 (@value{GDBP})
17706
17707 @end smallexample
17708
17709 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
17710 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
17711 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
17712 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
17713 @c or not?
17714 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
17715 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
17716 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
17717
17718 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
17719 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
17720 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
17721
17722 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
17723 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
17724
17725 @node Command Files
17726 @subsection Command Files
17727
17728 @cindex command files
17729 @cindex scripting commands
17730 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
17731 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
17732 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
17733 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
17734 terminal.
17735
17736 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
17737 command:
17738
17739 @table @code
17740 @kindex source
17741 @cindex execute commands from a file
17742 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
17743 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
17744 @end table
17745
17746 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
17747 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
17748 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
17749 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
17750 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
17751
17752 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
17753 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
17754
17755 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
17756 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
17757 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
17758
17759 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
17760 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
17761 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
17762 when called from command files.
17763
17764 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
17765 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
17766 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
17767 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
17768 the next command.
17769
17770 @smallexample
17771 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
17772 @end smallexample
17773
17774 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
17775 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
17776 would be directed to @file{log}.
17777
17778 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
17779 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
17780 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
17781 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
17782 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
17783 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
17784 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
17785 conditionally, etc.
17786
17787 @table @code
17788 @kindex if
17789 @kindex else
17790 @item if
17791 @itemx else
17792 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
17793 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
17794 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
17795 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
17796 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
17797 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
17798 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17799
17800 @kindex while
17801 @item while
17802 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
17803 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
17804 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
17805 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
17806 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
17807 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
17808
17809 @kindex loop_break
17810 @item loop_break
17811 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
17812 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
17813 line.
17814
17815 @kindex loop_continue
17816 @item loop_continue
17817 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
17818 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
17819 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
17820 the controlling expression.
17821
17822 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
17823 @item end
17824 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
17825 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
17826 @end table
17827
17828
17829 @node Output
17830 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
17831
17832 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
17833 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
17834 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
17835 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
17836 want.
17837
17838 @table @code
17839 @kindex echo
17840 @item echo @var{text}
17841 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
17842 @c because it is not in ANSI.
17843 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
17844 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
17845 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
17846 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
17847 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
17848 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
17849 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
17850 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
17851 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
17852
17853 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
17854 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
17855
17856 @smallexample
17857 echo This is some text\n\
17858 which is continued\n\
17859 onto several lines.\n
17860 @end smallexample
17861
17862 produces the same output as
17863
17864 @smallexample
17865 echo This is some text\n
17866 echo which is continued\n
17867 echo onto several lines.\n
17868 @end smallexample
17869
17870 @kindex output
17871 @item output @var{expression}
17872 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
17873 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
17874 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
17875 on expressions.
17876
17877 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
17878 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
17879 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
17880 Formats}, for more information.
17881
17882 @kindex printf
17883 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
17884 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
17885 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
17886 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
17887 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
17888 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
17889 executing the code below:
17890
17891 @smallexample
17892 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
17893 @end smallexample
17894
17895 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
17896 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
17897 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
17898 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
17899 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
17900 printed.
17901
17902 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
17903
17904 @smallexample
17905 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
17906 @end smallexample
17907
17908 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
17909 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
17910 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
17911
17912 @itemize @bullet
17913 @item
17914 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
17915
17916 @item
17917 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
17918 width.
17919
17920 @item
17921 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
17922 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
17923
17924 @item
17925 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
17926 supported.
17927
17928 @item
17929 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
17930
17931 @item
17932 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
17933 @end itemize
17934
17935 @noindent
17936 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
17937 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
17938 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
17939 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
17940
17941 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
17942 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
17943 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
17944 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
17945 supported.
17946
17947 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
17948 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
17949 together with a floating point specifier.
17950 letters:
17951
17952 @itemize @bullet
17953 @item
17954 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
17955
17956 @item
17957 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
17958
17959 @item
17960 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
17961 @end itemize
17962
17963 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
17964 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
17965 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
17966
17967 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
17968 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
17969
17970 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
17971 @smallexample
17972 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
17973 @end smallexample
17974
17975 @end table
17976
17977 @node Python
17978 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17979 @cindex python scripting
17980 @cindex scripting with python
17981
17982 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
17983 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
17984 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
17985
17986 @menu
17987 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
17988 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
17989 @end menu
17990
17991 @node Python Commands
17992 @subsection Python Commands
17993 @cindex python commands
17994 @cindex commands to access python
17995
17996 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
17997 and one related setting:
17998
17999 @table @code
18000 @kindex python
18001 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
18002 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
18003
18004 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
18005 argument as a Python command. For example:
18006
18007 @smallexample
18008 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
18009 23
18010 @end smallexample
18011
18012 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
18013 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
18014 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
18015 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
18016 containing @code{end}. For example:
18017
18018 @smallexample
18019 (@value{GDBP}) python
18020 Type python script
18021 End with a line saying just "end".
18022 >print 23
18023 >end
18024 23
18025 @end smallexample
18026
18027 @kindex maint set python print-stack
18028 @item maint set python print-stack
18029 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
18030 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
18031 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
18032 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
18033 disabled.
18034 @end table
18035
18036 @node Python API
18037 @subsection Python API
18038 @cindex python api
18039 @cindex programming in python
18040
18041 @cindex python stdout
18042 @cindex python pagination
18043 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
18044 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
18045 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
18046 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
18047 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
18048
18049 @menu
18050 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
18051 * Exception Handling::
18052 * Values From Inferior::
18053 @end menu
18054
18055 @node Basic Python
18056 @subsubsection Basic Python
18057
18058 @cindex python functions
18059 @cindex python module
18060 @cindex gdb module
18061 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
18062 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
18063 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
18064 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
18065
18066 @findex gdb.execute
18067 @defun execute command
18068 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18069 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
18070 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
18071 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
18072 @end defun
18073
18074 @findex gdb.get_parameter
18075 @defun get_parameter parameter
18076 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
18077 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
18078 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
18079 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
18080
18081 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
18082 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
18083 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
18084 @end defun
18085
18086 @findex gdb.write
18087 @defun write string
18088 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
18089 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
18090 call this function.
18091 @end defun
18092
18093 @findex gdb.flush
18094 @defun flush
18095 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
18096 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
18097 function.
18098 @end defun
18099
18100 @node Exception Handling
18101 @subsubsection Exception Handling
18102 @cindex python exceptions
18103 @cindex exceptions, python
18104
18105 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
18106 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
18107 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
18108 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
18109 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
18110 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
18111 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
18112
18113 @smallexample
18114 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
18115 Traceback (most recent call last):
18116 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
18117 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
18118 @end smallexample
18119
18120 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
18121 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
18122 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
18123 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
18124 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
18125 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
18126 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
18127 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
18128 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
18129 traceback.
18130
18131 @node Values From Inferior
18132 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
18133 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
18134 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
18135
18136 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
18137 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
18138 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
18139 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
18140 fetching values when necessary.
18141
18142 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
18143 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
18144 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
18145
18146 @smallexample
18147 bar = some_val + 2
18148 @end smallexample
18149
18150 @noindent
18151 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
18152 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
18153
18154 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
18155 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
18156 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
18157 can access its @code{foo} element with:
18158
18159 @smallexample
18160 bar = some_val['foo']
18161 @end smallexample
18162
18163 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
18164
18165 For pointer data types, @code{gdb.Value} provides a method for
18166 dereferencing the pointer to obtain the object it points to.
18167
18168 @defmethod Value dereference
18169 This method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object whose contents is
18170 the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if @code{foo} is
18171 a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
18172
18173 @smallexample
18174 int *foo;
18175 @end smallexample
18176
18177 @noindent
18178 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
18179 @code{foo} points to like this:
18180
18181 @smallexample
18182 bar = foo.dereference ()
18183 @end smallexample
18184
18185 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
18186 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
18187 @end defmethod
18188
18189 @node Interpreters
18190 @chapter Command Interpreters
18191 @cindex command interpreters
18192
18193 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
18194 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
18195 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
18196
18197 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
18198 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
18199 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
18200 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
18201
18202 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
18203 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
18204 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
18205 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
18206
18207 @table @code
18208 @item console
18209 @cindex console interpreter
18210 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
18211 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
18212 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
18213
18214 @item mi
18215 @cindex mi interpreter
18216 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
18217 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
18218 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
18219 Interface}.
18220
18221 @item mi2
18222 @cindex mi2 interpreter
18223 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
18224
18225 @item mi1
18226 @cindex mi1 interpreter
18227 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
18228
18229 @end table
18230
18231 @cindex invoke another interpreter
18232 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
18233 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
18234 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
18235 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
18236 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
18237 the IDE inoperable!
18238
18239 @kindex interpreter-exec
18240 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
18241 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
18242 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
18243 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
18244
18245 @smallexample
18246 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
18247 @end smallexample
18248
18249 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
18250 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
18251
18252 @node TUI
18253 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
18254 @cindex TUI
18255 @cindex Text User Interface
18256
18257 @menu
18258 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
18259 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
18260 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
18261 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
18262 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
18263 @end menu
18264
18265 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
18266 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
18267 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
18268 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
18269 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
18270 is available.
18271
18272 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
18273 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
18274 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
18275 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
18276 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
18277 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
18278
18279 @node TUI Overview
18280 @section TUI Overview
18281
18282 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
18283
18284 @table @emph
18285 @item command
18286 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
18287 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
18288 managed using readline.
18289
18290 @item source
18291 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
18292 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
18293
18294 @item assembly
18295 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
18296
18297 @item register
18298 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
18299 when their values change.
18300 @end table
18301
18302 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
18303 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
18304 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
18305 indicates the breakpoint type:
18306
18307 @table @code
18308 @item B
18309 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
18310
18311 @item b
18312 Breakpoint which was never hit.
18313
18314 @item H
18315 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
18316
18317 @item h
18318 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
18319 @end table
18320
18321 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
18322
18323 @table @code
18324 @item +
18325 Breakpoint is enabled.
18326
18327 @item -
18328 Breakpoint is disabled.
18329 @end table
18330
18331 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
18332 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
18333 changes.
18334
18335 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
18336 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
18337 layouts:
18338
18339 @itemize @bullet
18340 @item
18341 source only,
18342
18343 @item
18344 assembly only,
18345
18346 @item
18347 source and assembly,
18348
18349 @item
18350 source and registers, or
18351
18352 @item
18353 assembly and registers.
18354 @end itemize
18355
18356 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
18357
18358 @table @emph
18359 @item target
18360 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
18361 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
18362
18363 @item process
18364 Gives the current process or thread number.
18365 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
18366
18367 @item function
18368 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
18369 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
18370 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
18371 the string @code{??} is displayed.
18372
18373 @item line
18374 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
18375 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
18376
18377 @item pc
18378 Indicates the current program counter address.
18379 @end table
18380
18381 @node TUI Keys
18382 @section TUI Key Bindings
18383 @cindex TUI key bindings
18384
18385 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
18386 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
18387 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
18388
18389 @table @kbd
18390 @kindex C-x C-a
18391 @item C-x C-a
18392 @kindex C-x a
18393 @itemx C-x a
18394 @kindex C-x A
18395 @itemx C-x A
18396 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
18397 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
18398 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
18399 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
18400 The screen is then refreshed.
18401
18402 @kindex C-x 1
18403 @item C-x 1
18404 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
18405 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
18406 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
18407
18408 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
18409
18410 @kindex C-x 2
18411 @item C-x 2
18412 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
18413 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
18414 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
18415 previous layout and the new one.
18416
18417 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
18418
18419 @kindex C-x o
18420 @item C-x o
18421 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
18422 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
18423 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
18424
18425 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
18426
18427 @kindex C-x s
18428 @item C-x s
18429 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
18430 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
18431 @end table
18432
18433 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
18434
18435 @table @asis
18436 @kindex PgUp
18437 @item @key{PgUp}
18438 Scroll the active window one page up.
18439
18440 @kindex PgDn
18441 @item @key{PgDn}
18442 Scroll the active window one page down.
18443
18444 @kindex Up
18445 @item @key{Up}
18446 Scroll the active window one line up.
18447
18448 @kindex Down
18449 @item @key{Down}
18450 Scroll the active window one line down.
18451
18452 @kindex Left
18453 @item @key{Left}
18454 Scroll the active window one column left.
18455
18456 @kindex Right
18457 @item @key{Right}
18458 Scroll the active window one column right.
18459
18460 @kindex C-L
18461 @item @kbd{C-L}
18462 Refresh the screen.
18463 @end table
18464
18465 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
18466 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
18467 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
18468 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
18469 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
18470
18471 @node TUI Single Key Mode
18472 @section TUI Single Key Mode
18473 @cindex TUI single key mode
18474
18475 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
18476 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
18477 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
18478
18479 @table @kbd
18480 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18481 @item c
18482 continue
18483
18484 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18485 @item d
18486 down
18487
18488 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18489 @item f
18490 finish
18491
18492 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18493 @item n
18494 next
18495
18496 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18497 @item q
18498 exit the SingleKey mode.
18499
18500 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18501 @item r
18502 run
18503
18504 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18505 @item s
18506 step
18507
18508 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18509 @item u
18510 up
18511
18512 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18513 @item v
18514 info locals
18515
18516 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18517 @item w
18518 where
18519 @end table
18520
18521 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
18522 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
18523 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
18524 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
18525 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
18526 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
18527
18528
18529 @node TUI Commands
18530 @section TUI-specific Commands
18531 @cindex TUI commands
18532
18533 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
18534 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
18535 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
18536 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
18537
18538 @table @code
18539 @item info win
18540 @kindex info win
18541 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
18542
18543 @item layout next
18544 @kindex layout
18545 Display the next layout.
18546
18547 @item layout prev
18548 Display the previous layout.
18549
18550 @item layout src
18551 Display the source window only.
18552
18553 @item layout asm
18554 Display the assembly window only.
18555
18556 @item layout split
18557 Display the source and assembly window.
18558
18559 @item layout regs
18560 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
18561
18562 @item focus next
18563 @kindex focus
18564 Make the next window active for scrolling.
18565
18566 @item focus prev
18567 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
18568
18569 @item focus src
18570 Make the source window active for scrolling.
18571
18572 @item focus asm
18573 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
18574
18575 @item focus regs
18576 Make the register window active for scrolling.
18577
18578 @item focus cmd
18579 Make the command window active for scrolling.
18580
18581 @item refresh
18582 @kindex refresh
18583 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
18584
18585 @item tui reg float
18586 @kindex tui reg
18587 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
18588
18589 @item tui reg general
18590 Show the general registers in the register window.
18591
18592 @item tui reg next
18593 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
18594 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
18595 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
18596 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
18597
18598 @item tui reg system
18599 Show the system registers in the register window.
18600
18601 @item update
18602 @kindex update
18603 Update the source window and the current execution point.
18604
18605 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
18606 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
18607 @kindex winheight
18608 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
18609 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
18610 decrease it.
18611
18612 @item tabset @var{nchars}
18613 @kindex tabset
18614 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
18615 @end table
18616
18617 @node TUI Configuration
18618 @section TUI Configuration Variables
18619 @cindex TUI configuration variables
18620
18621 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
18622
18623 @table @code
18624 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
18625 @kindex set tui border-kind
18626 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
18627 The possible values are the following:
18628 @table @code
18629 @item space
18630 Use a space character to draw the border.
18631
18632 @item ascii
18633 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
18634
18635 @item acs
18636 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
18637 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
18638 @end table
18639
18640 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
18641 @kindex set tui border-mode
18642 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
18643 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
18644 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
18645 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
18646 @table @code
18647 @item normal
18648 Use normal attributes to display the border.
18649
18650 @item standout
18651 Use standout mode.
18652
18653 @item reverse
18654 Use reverse video mode.
18655
18656 @item half
18657 Use half bright mode.
18658
18659 @item half-standout
18660 Use half bright and standout mode.
18661
18662 @item bold
18663 Use extra bright or bold mode.
18664
18665 @item bold-standout
18666 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
18667 @end table
18668 @end table
18669
18670 @node Emacs
18671 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
18672
18673 @cindex Emacs
18674 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
18675 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
18676 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
18677 @value{GDBN}.
18678
18679 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
18680 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
18681 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
18682 created Emacs buffer.
18683 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
18684
18685 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
18686 things:
18687
18688 @itemize @bullet
18689 @item
18690 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
18691 the GUD buffer.
18692
18693 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
18694 and output done by the program you are debugging.
18695
18696 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
18697 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
18698 in this way.
18699
18700 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
18701 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
18702 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
18703 stop.
18704
18705 @item
18706 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
18707
18708 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
18709 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
18710 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
18711 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
18712 and the source.
18713
18714 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
18715 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
18716 @end itemize
18717
18718 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
18719 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
18720 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
18721 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
18722
18723 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
18724 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
18725 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
18726 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
18727 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
18728 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
18729 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
18730 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
18731 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
18732
18733 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
18734 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
18735 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
18736 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
18737
18738 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
18739 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
18740 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
18741 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
18742 one you want.
18743
18744 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
18745 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
18746
18747 @table @kbd
18748 @item C-h m
18749 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
18750
18751 @item C-c C-s
18752 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
18753 update the display window to show the current file and location.
18754
18755 @item C-c C-n
18756 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
18757 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
18758 to show the current file and location.
18759
18760 @item C-c C-i
18761 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
18762 display window accordingly.
18763
18764 @item C-c C-f
18765 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
18766 @code{finish} command.
18767
18768 @item C-c C-r
18769 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
18770 command.
18771
18772 @item C-c <
18773 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
18774 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
18775 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
18776
18777 @item C-c >
18778 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
18779 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
18780 @end table
18781
18782 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
18783 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
18784
18785 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
18786 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
18787 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
18788 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
18789 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
18790 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
18791 speedbar displays watch expressions.
18792
18793 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
18794 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
18795 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
18796 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
18797 frame.
18798
18799 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
18800 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
18801 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
18802 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
18803 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
18804 to correspond properly with the code.
18805
18806 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
18807 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
18808 Emacs Manual}).
18809
18810 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
18811 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
18812 @ignore
18813 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
18814 @kindex Epoch
18815 @kindex inspect
18816
18817 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
18818 called the @code{epoch}
18819 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
18820 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
18821 each value is printed in its own window.
18822 @end ignore
18823
18824
18825 @node GDB/MI
18826 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
18827
18828 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
18829
18830 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
18831 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
18832 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
18833 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
18834 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
18835 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
18836
18837 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
18838 in the form of a reference manual.
18839
18840 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
18841 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
18842 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
18843
18844 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
18845
18846 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
18847 This chapter uses the following notation:
18848
18849 @itemize @bullet
18850 @item
18851 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
18852
18853 @item
18854 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
18855 it may or may not be given.
18856
18857 @item
18858 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
18859 may repeat zero or more times.
18860
18861 @item
18862 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
18863 may repeat one or more times.
18864
18865 @item
18866 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
18867 @end itemize
18868
18869 @ignore
18870 @heading Dependencies
18871 @end ignore
18872
18873 @menu
18874 * GDB/MI General Design::
18875 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
18876 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
18877 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
18878 * GDB/MI Output Records::
18879 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
18880 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
18881 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
18882 * GDB/MI Program Context::
18883 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
18884 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
18885 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
18886 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
18887 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
18888 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
18889 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
18890 * GDB/MI File Commands::
18891 @ignore
18892 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
18893 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
18894 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
18895 @end ignore
18896 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
18897 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
18898 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
18899 @end menu
18900
18901 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18902 @node GDB/MI General Design
18903 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
18904 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
18905
18906 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
18907 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
18908 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
18909 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
18910 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
18911 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
18912 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
18913 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
18914 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
18915 a command and reported as part of that command response.
18916
18917 The important examples of notifications are:
18918 @itemize @bullet
18919
18920 @item
18921 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
18922 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
18923 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
18924 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
18925 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
18926 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
18927 command itself was successfully executed.
18928
18929 @item
18930 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
18931 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
18932 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
18933 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
18934 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
18935 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
18936
18937 @item
18938 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
18939 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
18940 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
18941 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
18942 orthogonal frontend design.
18943
18944 @end itemize
18945
18946 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
18947 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
18948 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
18949 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
18950 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
18951 the user interface.
18952
18953 @subsection Context management
18954
18955 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
18956 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
18957 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
18958 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
18959 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
18960 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
18961 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
18962 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
18963 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
18964
18965 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
18966 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
18967 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
18968 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
18969 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
18970 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
18971 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
18972 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
18973 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
18974 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
18975 for thread and frame to operate on.
18976
18977 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
18978 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
18979 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
18980 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
18981 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
18982 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
18983 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
18984 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
18985 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
18986 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
18987
18988 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
18989 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
18990 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
18991 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
18992 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
18993 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
18994 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
18995 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
18996 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
18997 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
18998 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
18999 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
19000 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
19001 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
19002 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
19003 @samp{--frame} options.
19004
19005 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
19006
19007 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
19008 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
19009 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
19010 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
19011 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
19012 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
19013 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
19014 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
19015 @code{-list-target-features} command.
19016
19017 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
19018 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
19019 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
19020 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
19021 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
19022 are running.
19023
19024 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
19025 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
19026 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
19027 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
19028 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
19029 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
19030 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
19031 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
19032 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
19033 @samp{--thread} option).
19034
19035 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
19036 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
19037 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
19038 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
19039
19040 @subsection Thread groups
19041 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
19042 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
19043 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
19044 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
19045 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
19046
19047 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
19048 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
19049 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
19050 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
19051 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
19052 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
19053 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
19054 into processes.
19055
19056 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
19057 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
19058 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
19059 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
19060 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
19061 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
19062 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
19063 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
19064 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
19065 the members of specific thread group.
19066
19067 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
19068 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
19069 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
19070 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
19071 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
19072 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
19073 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
19074 after attaching to that thread group.
19075
19076 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19077 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
19078 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
19079
19080 @menu
19081 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
19082 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
19083 @end menu
19084
19085 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
19086 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
19087
19088 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
19089 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
19090 @table @code
19091 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
19092 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
19093
19094 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
19095 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
19096 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
19097
19098 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
19099 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
19100 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
19101
19102 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
19103 "any sequence of digits"
19104
19105 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
19106 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
19107
19108 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
19109 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
19110
19111 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
19112 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
19113
19114 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
19115 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
19116 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
19117
19118 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
19119 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
19120
19121 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
19122 @code{CR | CR-LF}
19123 @end table
19124
19125 @noindent
19126 Notes:
19127
19128 @itemize @bullet
19129 @item
19130 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
19131 output is described below.
19132
19133 @item
19134 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
19135 finishes.
19136
19137 @item
19138 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
19139 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
19140 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
19141 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
19142 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
19143 @end itemize
19144
19145 Pragmatics:
19146
19147 @itemize @bullet
19148 @item
19149 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
19150
19151 @item
19152 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
19153 @end itemize
19154
19155 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
19156 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
19157
19158 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
19159 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
19160 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
19161 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
19162 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
19163 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
19164
19165 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
19166 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
19167 @var{token}.
19168
19169 @table @code
19170 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
19171 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
19172
19173 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
19174 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
19175
19176 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
19177 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
19178
19179 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
19180 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
19181
19182 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
19183 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
19184
19185 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
19186 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
19187
19188 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
19189 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
19190
19191 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
19192 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
19193
19194 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
19195 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
19196
19197 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
19198 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
19199 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
19200
19201 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
19202 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
19203
19204 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
19205 @code{ @var{string} }
19206
19207 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
19208 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
19209
19210 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
19211 @code{@var{c-string}}
19212
19213 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
19214 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
19215
19216 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
19217 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
19218 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
19219
19220 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
19221 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
19222
19223 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
19224 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
19225
19226 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
19227 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
19228
19229 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
19230 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
19231
19232 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
19233 @code{CR | CR-LF}
19234
19235 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
19236 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
19237 @end table
19238
19239 @noindent
19240 Notes:
19241
19242 @itemize @bullet
19243 @item
19244 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
19245
19246 @item
19247 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
19248 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
19249 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
19250 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
19251 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
19252 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
19253 prior command.
19254
19255 @item
19256 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19257 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
19258 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
19259 prefixed by @samp{+}.
19260
19261 @item
19262 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19263 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
19264 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
19265 @samp{*}.
19266
19267 @item
19268 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19269 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
19270 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
19271 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
19272
19273 @item
19274 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19275 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
19276 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
19277 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
19278
19279 @item
19280 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19281 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
19282 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
19283
19284 @item
19285 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19286 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
19287 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
19288 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
19289
19290 @item
19291 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19292 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
19293 @var{values}.
19294
19295
19296 @end itemize
19297
19298 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
19299 details about the various output records.
19300
19301 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19302 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
19303 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
19304
19305 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
19306 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
19307
19308 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
19309 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
19310 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
19311 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
19312 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
19313 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
19314
19315 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
19316 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
19317 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
19318
19319 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19320 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
19321 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
19322 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
19323
19324 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
19325 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
19326
19327 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
19328 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
19329 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
19330 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
19331 might change.
19332
19333 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
19334 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
19335 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
19336 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
19337
19338 @itemize @bullet
19339 @item
19340 New MI commands may be added.
19341
19342 @item
19343 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
19344
19345 @item
19346 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
19347 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
19348
19349 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
19350 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
19351
19352 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
19353 @c resolve inconsistencies.
19354 @end itemize
19355
19356 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
19357 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
19358 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
19359 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
19360 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
19361
19362 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
19363 @c version?
19364
19365 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
19366 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
19367 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
19368 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
19369 @cindex mailing lists
19370
19371 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19372 @node GDB/MI Output Records
19373 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
19374
19375 @menu
19376 * GDB/MI Result Records::
19377 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
19378 * GDB/MI Async Records::
19379 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
19380 @end menu
19381
19382 @node GDB/MI Result Records
19383 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
19384
19385 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
19386 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
19387 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
19388 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
19389
19390 @table @code
19391 @findex ^done
19392 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
19393 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
19394 values.
19395
19396 @item "^running"
19397 @findex ^running
19398 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
19399 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
19400 running.
19401
19402 @item "^connected"
19403 @findex ^connected
19404 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
19405
19406 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
19407 @findex ^error
19408 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
19409 error message.
19410
19411 @item "^exit"
19412 @findex ^exit
19413 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
19414
19415 @end table
19416
19417 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
19418 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
19419
19420 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
19421 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
19422 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
19423 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
19424 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
19425
19426 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
19427 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
19428 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
19429 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
19430 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
19431
19432 @table @code
19433 @item "~" @var{string-output}
19434 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
19435 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
19436
19437 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
19438 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
19439 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
19440 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
19441
19442 @item "&" @var{string-output}
19443 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
19444 internals.
19445 @end table
19446
19447 @node GDB/MI Async Records
19448 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
19449
19450 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
19451 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
19452 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
19453 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
19454 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
19455 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
19456
19457 The following is the list of possible async records:
19458
19459 @table @code
19460
19461 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
19462 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
19463 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
19464 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
19465 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
19466 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
19467 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
19468 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
19469 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
19470 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
19471
19472 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}"
19473 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
19474 following values:
19475
19476 @table @code
19477 @item breakpoint-hit
19478 A breakpoint was reached.
19479 @item watchpoint-trigger
19480 A watchpoint was triggered.
19481 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
19482 A read watchpoint was triggered.
19483 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
19484 An access watchpoint was triggered.
19485 @item function-finished
19486 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
19487 @item location-reached
19488 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
19489 @item watchpoint-scope
19490 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
19491 @item end-stepping-range
19492 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
19493 similar CLI command was accomplished.
19494 @item exited-signalled
19495 The inferior exited because of a signal.
19496 @item exited
19497 The inferior exited.
19498 @item exited-normally
19499 The inferior exited normally.
19500 @item signal-received
19501 A signal was received by the inferior.
19502 @end table
19503
19504 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
19505 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
19506 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
19507 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
19508 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
19509 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
19510 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
19511 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
19512 several threads in the list.
19513
19514 @item =thread-group-created,id="@var{id}"
19515 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
19516 A thread thread group either was attached to, or has exited/detached
19517 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
19518 thread group.
19519
19520 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
19521 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
19522 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
19523 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
19524 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
19525
19526 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
19527 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
19528 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
19529 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
19530 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
19531 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
19532 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
19533
19534 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
19535 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
19536 that thread.
19537
19538 @end table
19539
19540 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
19541 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
19542
19543 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
19544 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
19545 fields:
19546
19547 @table @code
19548 @item level
19549 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
19550 zero. This field is always present.
19551
19552 @item func
19553 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
19554 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
19555
19556 @item addr
19557 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
19558
19559 @item file
19560 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
19561 address. This field may be absent.
19562
19563 @item line
19564 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
19565 may be absent.
19566
19567 @item from
19568 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
19569 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
19570
19571 @end table
19572
19573
19574 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19575 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
19576 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
19577 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
19578
19579 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
19580 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
19581 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
19582 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
19583
19584 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
19585 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
19586
19587 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
19588
19589 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
19590 information of the breakpoint.
19591
19592 @smallexample
19593 -> -break-insert main
19594 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
19595 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
19596 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
19597 <- (gdb)
19598 @end smallexample
19599
19600 @subheading Program Execution
19601
19602 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
19603 reason that execution stopped.
19604
19605 @smallexample
19606 -> -exec-run
19607 <- ^running
19608 <- (gdb)
19609 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
19610 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
19611 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
19612 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
19613 <- (gdb)
19614 -> -exec-continue
19615 <- ^running
19616 <- (gdb)
19617 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19618 <- (gdb)
19619 @end smallexample
19620
19621 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
19622
19623 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
19624
19625 @smallexample
19626 -> (gdb)
19627 <- -gdb-exit
19628 <- ^exit
19629 @end smallexample
19630
19631 @subheading A Bad Command
19632
19633 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
19634
19635 @smallexample
19636 -> -rubbish
19637 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
19638 <- (gdb)
19639 @end smallexample
19640
19641
19642 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19643 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
19644 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
19645
19646 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
19647 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
19648
19649 @subheading Motivation
19650
19651 The motivation for this collection of commands.
19652
19653 @subheading Introduction
19654
19655 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
19656
19657 @subheading Commands
19658
19659 For each command in the block, the following is described:
19660
19661 @subsubheading Synopsis
19662
19663 @smallexample
19664 -command @var{args}@dots{}
19665 @end smallexample
19666
19667 @subsubheading Result
19668
19669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19670
19671 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
19672
19673 @subsubheading Example
19674
19675 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
19676 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
19677
19678
19679 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19680 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
19681 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
19682
19683 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
19684 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
19685 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
19686 breakpoints.
19687
19688 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
19689 @findex -break-after
19690
19691 @subsubheading Synopsis
19692
19693 @smallexample
19694 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
19695 @end smallexample
19696
19697 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
19698 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
19699 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
19700 @samp{-break-list} command below.
19701
19702 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19703
19704 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
19705
19706 @subsubheading Example
19707
19708 @smallexample
19709 (gdb)
19710 -break-insert main
19711 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
19712 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
19713 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
19714 (gdb)
19715 -break-after 1 3
19716 ~
19717 ^done
19718 (gdb)
19719 -break-list
19720 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19721 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19722 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19723 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19724 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19725 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19726 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19727 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19728 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19729 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
19730 (gdb)
19731 @end smallexample
19732
19733 @ignore
19734 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
19735 @findex -break-catch
19736
19737 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
19738 @findex -break-commands
19739 @end ignore
19740
19741
19742 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
19743 @findex -break-condition
19744
19745 @subsubheading Synopsis
19746
19747 @smallexample
19748 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
19749 @end smallexample
19750
19751 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
19752 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
19753 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
19754 command below).
19755
19756 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19757
19758 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
19759
19760 @subsubheading Example
19761
19762 @smallexample
19763 (gdb)
19764 -break-condition 1 1
19765 ^done
19766 (gdb)
19767 -break-list
19768 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19769 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19770 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19771 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19772 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19773 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19774 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19775 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19776 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19777 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
19778 (gdb)
19779 @end smallexample
19780
19781 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
19782 @findex -break-delete
19783
19784 @subsubheading Synopsis
19785
19786 @smallexample
19787 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19788 @end smallexample
19789
19790 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
19791 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
19792
19793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19794
19795 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
19796
19797 @subsubheading Example
19798
19799 @smallexample
19800 (gdb)
19801 -break-delete 1
19802 ^done
19803 (gdb)
19804 -break-list
19805 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
19806 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19807 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19808 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19809 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19810 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19811 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19812 body=[]@}
19813 (gdb)
19814 @end smallexample
19815
19816 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
19817 @findex -break-disable
19818
19819 @subsubheading Synopsis
19820
19821 @smallexample
19822 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19823 @end smallexample
19824
19825 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
19826 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
19827
19828 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19829
19830 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
19831
19832 @subsubheading Example
19833
19834 @smallexample
19835 (gdb)
19836 -break-disable 2
19837 ^done
19838 (gdb)
19839 -break-list
19840 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19841 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19842 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19843 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19844 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19845 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19846 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19847 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
19848 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19849 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
19850 (gdb)
19851 @end smallexample
19852
19853 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
19854 @findex -break-enable
19855
19856 @subsubheading Synopsis
19857
19858 @smallexample
19859 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19860 @end smallexample
19861
19862 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
19863
19864 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19865
19866 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
19867
19868 @subsubheading Example
19869
19870 @smallexample
19871 (gdb)
19872 -break-enable 2
19873 ^done
19874 (gdb)
19875 -break-list
19876 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19877 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19878 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19879 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19880 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19881 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19882 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19883 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19884 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19885 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
19886 (gdb)
19887 @end smallexample
19888
19889 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
19890 @findex -break-info
19891
19892 @subsubheading Synopsis
19893
19894 @smallexample
19895 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
19896 @end smallexample
19897
19898 @c REDUNDANT???
19899 Get information about a single breakpoint.
19900
19901 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19902
19903 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
19904
19905 @subsubheading Example
19906 N.A.
19907
19908 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
19909 @findex -break-insert
19910
19911 @subsubheading Synopsis
19912
19913 @smallexample
19914 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
19915 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
19916 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
19917 @end smallexample
19918
19919 @noindent
19920 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
19921
19922 @itemize @bullet
19923 @item function
19924 @c @item +offset
19925 @c @item -offset
19926 @c @item linenum
19927 @item filename:linenum
19928 @item filename:function
19929 @item *address
19930 @end itemize
19931
19932 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
19933
19934 @table @samp
19935 @item -t
19936 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
19937 @item -h
19938 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
19939 @item -c @var{condition}
19940 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
19941 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
19942 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
19943 @item -f
19944 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
19945 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
19946 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
19947 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
19948 cannot be parsed.
19949 @end table
19950
19951 @subsubheading Result
19952
19953 The result is in the form:
19954
19955 @smallexample
19956 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
19957 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
19958 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
19959 times="@var{times}"@}
19960 @end smallexample
19961
19962 @noindent
19963 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
19964 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
19965 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
19966 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
19967 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
19968 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
19969 which use the same output).
19970
19971 Note: this format is open to change.
19972 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
19973
19974 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19975
19976 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
19977 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
19978
19979 @subsubheading Example
19980
19981 @smallexample
19982 (gdb)
19983 -break-insert main
19984 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
19985 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
19986 (gdb)
19987 -break-insert -t foo
19988 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
19989 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
19990 (gdb)
19991 -break-list
19992 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19993 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19994 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19995 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19996 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19997 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19998 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19999 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20000 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
20001 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
20002 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
20003 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
20004 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
20005 (gdb)
20006 -break-insert -r foo.*
20007 ~int foo(int, int);
20008 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
20009 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
20010 (gdb)
20011 @end smallexample
20012
20013 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
20014 @findex -break-list
20015
20016 @subsubheading Synopsis
20017
20018 @smallexample
20019 -break-list
20020 @end smallexample
20021
20022 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
20023
20024 @table @samp
20025 @item Number
20026 number of the breakpoint
20027 @item Type
20028 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
20029 @item Disposition
20030 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
20031 or @samp{nokeep}
20032 @item Enabled
20033 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
20034 @item Address
20035 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
20036 @item What
20037 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
20038 name, line number
20039 @item Times
20040 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
20041 @end table
20042
20043 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
20044 @code{body} field is an empty list.
20045
20046 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20047
20048 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
20049
20050 @subsubheading Example
20051
20052 @smallexample
20053 (gdb)
20054 -break-list
20055 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20056 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20057 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20058 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20059 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20060 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20061 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20062 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20063 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
20064 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20065 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20066 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
20067 (gdb)
20068 @end smallexample
20069
20070 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
20071
20072 @smallexample
20073 (gdb)
20074 -break-list
20075 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
20076 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20077 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20078 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20079 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20080 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20081 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20082 body=[]@}
20083 (gdb)
20084 @end smallexample
20085
20086 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
20087 @findex -break-watch
20088
20089 @subsubheading Synopsis
20090
20091 @smallexample
20092 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
20093 @end smallexample
20094
20095 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
20096 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
20097 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
20098 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
20099 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
20100 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
20101 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
20102 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
20103
20104 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
20105 breakpoints inserted.
20106
20107 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20108
20109 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
20110 @samp{rwatch}.
20111
20112 @subsubheading Example
20113
20114 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
20115
20116 @smallexample
20117 (gdb)
20118 -break-watch x
20119 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
20120 (gdb)
20121 -exec-continue
20122 ^running
20123 (gdb)
20124 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
20125 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
20126 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
20127 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
20128 (gdb)
20129 @end smallexample
20130
20131 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
20132 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
20133 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
20134
20135 @smallexample
20136 (gdb)
20137 -break-watch C
20138 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
20139 (gdb)
20140 -exec-continue
20141 ^running
20142 (gdb)
20143 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
20144 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
20145 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20146 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20147 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
20148 (gdb)
20149 -exec-continue
20150 ^running
20151 (gdb)
20152 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
20153 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
20154 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20155 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20156 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20157 (gdb)
20158 @end smallexample
20159
20160 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
20161 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
20162 deleted.
20163
20164 @smallexample
20165 (gdb)
20166 -break-watch C
20167 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
20168 (gdb)
20169 -break-list
20170 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20171 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20172 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20173 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20174 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20175 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20176 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20177 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20178 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20179 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20180 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
20181 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
20182 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
20183 (gdb)
20184 -exec-continue
20185 ^running
20186 (gdb)
20187 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
20188 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
20189 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20190 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20191 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
20192 (gdb)
20193 -break-list
20194 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20195 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20196 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20197 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20198 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20199 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20200 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20201 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20202 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20203 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20204 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
20205 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
20206 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
20207 (gdb)
20208 -exec-continue
20209 ^running
20210 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
20211 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
20212 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20213 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20214 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20215 (gdb)
20216 -break-list
20217 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20218 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20219 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20220 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20221 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20222 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20223 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20224 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20225 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20226 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20227 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
20228 times="1"@}]@}
20229 (gdb)
20230 @end smallexample
20231
20232 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20233 @node GDB/MI Program Context
20234 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
20235
20236 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
20237 @findex -exec-arguments
20238
20239
20240 @subsubheading Synopsis
20241
20242 @smallexample
20243 -exec-arguments @var{args}
20244 @end smallexample
20245
20246 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
20247 @samp{-exec-run}.
20248
20249 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20250
20251 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
20252
20253 @subsubheading Example
20254
20255 @smallexample
20256 (gdb)
20257 -exec-arguments -v word
20258 ^done
20259 (gdb)
20260 @end smallexample
20261
20262
20263 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
20264 @findex -exec-show-arguments
20265
20266 @subsubheading Synopsis
20267
20268 @smallexample
20269 -exec-show-arguments
20270 @end smallexample
20271
20272 Print the arguments of the program.
20273
20274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20275
20276 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
20277
20278 @subsubheading Example
20279 N.A.
20280
20281
20282 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
20283 @findex -environment-cd
20284
20285 @subsubheading Synopsis
20286
20287 @smallexample
20288 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
20289 @end smallexample
20290
20291 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
20292
20293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20294
20295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
20296
20297 @subsubheading Example
20298
20299 @smallexample
20300 (gdb)
20301 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
20302 ^done
20303 (gdb)
20304 @end smallexample
20305
20306
20307 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
20308 @findex -environment-directory
20309
20310 @subsubheading Synopsis
20311
20312 @smallexample
20313 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
20314 @end smallexample
20315
20316 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
20317 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
20318 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
20319 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
20320 occurs as normal.
20321 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
20322 multiple directories in a single command
20323 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
20324 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
20325 If blanks are needed as
20326 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
20327 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
20328 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
20329 character must not be used
20330 in any directory name.
20331 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
20332
20333 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20334
20335 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
20336
20337 @subsubheading Example
20338
20339 @smallexample
20340 (gdb)
20341 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
20342 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
20343 (gdb)
20344 -environment-directory ""
20345 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
20346 (gdb)
20347 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
20348 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
20349 (gdb)
20350 -environment-directory -r
20351 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
20352 (gdb)
20353 @end smallexample
20354
20355
20356 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
20357 @findex -environment-path
20358
20359 @subsubheading Synopsis
20360
20361 @smallexample
20362 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
20363 @end smallexample
20364
20365 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
20366 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
20367 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
20368 supplied in addition to the
20369 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
20370 occurs as normal.
20371 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
20372 multiple directories in a single command
20373 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
20374 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
20375 If blanks are needed as
20376 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
20377 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
20378 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
20379 character must not be used
20380 in any directory name.
20381 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
20382
20383
20384 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20385
20386 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
20387
20388 @subsubheading Example
20389
20390 @smallexample
20391 (gdb)
20392 -environment-path
20393 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
20394 (gdb)
20395 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
20396 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
20397 (gdb)
20398 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
20399 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
20400 (gdb)
20401 @end smallexample
20402
20403
20404 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
20405 @findex -environment-pwd
20406
20407 @subsubheading Synopsis
20408
20409 @smallexample
20410 -environment-pwd
20411 @end smallexample
20412
20413 Show the current working directory.
20414
20415 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20416
20417 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
20418
20419 @subsubheading Example
20420
20421 @smallexample
20422 (gdb)
20423 -environment-pwd
20424 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
20425 (gdb)
20426 @end smallexample
20427
20428 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20429 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
20430 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
20431
20432
20433 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
20434 @findex -thread-info
20435
20436 @subsubheading Synopsis
20437
20438 @smallexample
20439 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
20440 @end smallexample
20441
20442 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
20443 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
20444 threads. When printing information about all threads,
20445 also reports the current thread.
20446
20447 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20448
20449 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
20450 about all threads.
20451
20452 @subsubheading Example
20453
20454 @smallexample
20455 -thread-info
20456 ^done,threads=[
20457 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
20458 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
20459 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
20460 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
20461 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
20462 current-thread-id="1"
20463 (gdb)
20464 @end smallexample
20465
20466 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
20467
20468 @table @code
20469 @item stopped
20470 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
20471 threads.
20472
20473 @item running
20474 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
20475 threads.
20476
20477 @end table
20478
20479 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
20480 @findex -thread-list-ids
20481
20482 @subsubheading Synopsis
20483
20484 @smallexample
20485 -thread-list-ids
20486 @end smallexample
20487
20488 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
20489 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
20490
20491 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
20492 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
20493
20494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20495
20496 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
20497
20498 @subsubheading Example
20499
20500 No threads present, besides the main process:
20501
20502 @smallexample
20503 (gdb)
20504 -thread-list-ids
20505 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
20506 (gdb)
20507 @end smallexample
20508
20509
20510 Several threads:
20511
20512 @smallexample
20513 (gdb)
20514 -thread-list-ids
20515 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20516 number-of-threads="3"
20517 (gdb)
20518 @end smallexample
20519
20520
20521 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
20522 @findex -thread-select
20523
20524 @subsubheading Synopsis
20525
20526 @smallexample
20527 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
20528 @end smallexample
20529
20530 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
20531 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
20532
20533 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
20534 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
20535
20536 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20537
20538 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
20539
20540 @subsubheading Example
20541
20542 @smallexample
20543 (gdb)
20544 -exec-next
20545 ^running
20546 (gdb)
20547 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
20548 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
20549 (gdb)
20550 -thread-list-ids
20551 ^done,
20552 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20553 number-of-threads="3"
20554 (gdb)
20555 -thread-select 3
20556 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
20557 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
20558 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
20559 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
20560 (gdb)
20561 @end smallexample
20562
20563 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20564 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
20565 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
20566
20567 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
20568 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
20569 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
20570 other cases.
20571
20572 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
20573 @findex -exec-continue
20574
20575 @subsubheading Synopsis
20576
20577 @smallexample
20578 -exec-continue [--all|--thread-group N]
20579 @end smallexample
20580
20581 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
20582 encountered, or until the inferior exits. In all-stop mode
20583 (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads,
20584 depending on the value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. In
20585 non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), if the @samp{--all} is not
20586 specified, only the thread specified with the @samp{--thread} option
20587 (or current thread, if no @samp{--thread} is provided) is resumed. If
20588 @samp{--all} is specified, all threads will be resumed. The
20589 @samp{--all} option is ignored in all-stop mode. If the
20590 @samp{--thread-group} options is specified, then all threads in that
20591 thread group are resumed.
20592
20593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20594
20595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
20596
20597 @subsubheading Example
20598
20599 @smallexample
20600 -exec-continue
20601 ^running
20602 (gdb)
20603 @@Hello world
20604 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
20605 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
20606 line="13"@}
20607 (gdb)
20608 @end smallexample
20609
20610
20611 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
20612 @findex -exec-finish
20613
20614 @subsubheading Synopsis
20615
20616 @smallexample
20617 -exec-finish
20618 @end smallexample
20619
20620 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
20621 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
20622
20623 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20624
20625 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
20626
20627 @subsubheading Example
20628
20629 Function returning @code{void}.
20630
20631 @smallexample
20632 -exec-finish
20633 ^running
20634 (gdb)
20635 @@hello from foo
20636 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
20637 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
20638 (gdb)
20639 @end smallexample
20640
20641 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
20642 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
20643 value itself.
20644
20645 @smallexample
20646 -exec-finish
20647 ^running
20648 (gdb)
20649 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
20650 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
20651 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20652 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
20653 (gdb)
20654 @end smallexample
20655
20656
20657 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
20658 @findex -exec-interrupt
20659
20660 @subsubheading Synopsis
20661
20662 @smallexample
20663 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
20664 @end smallexample
20665
20666 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
20667 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
20668 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
20669 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
20670 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
20671
20672 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
20673 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
20674 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
20675 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
20676
20677 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
20678 All threads will be interrupted if the @samp{--all} option is
20679 specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, all
20680 threads in that group will be interrupted.
20681
20682 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20683
20684 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
20685
20686 @subsubheading Example
20687
20688 @smallexample
20689 (gdb)
20690 111-exec-continue
20691 111^running
20692
20693 (gdb)
20694 222-exec-interrupt
20695 222^done
20696 (gdb)
20697 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
20698 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20699 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
20700 (gdb)
20701
20702 (gdb)
20703 -exec-interrupt
20704 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
20705 (gdb)
20706 @end smallexample
20707
20708
20709 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
20710 @findex -exec-next
20711
20712 @subsubheading Synopsis
20713
20714 @smallexample
20715 -exec-next
20716 @end smallexample
20717
20718 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
20719 of the next source line is reached.
20720
20721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20722
20723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
20724
20725 @subsubheading Example
20726
20727 @smallexample
20728 -exec-next
20729 ^running
20730 (gdb)
20731 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
20732 (gdb)
20733 @end smallexample
20734
20735
20736 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
20737 @findex -exec-next-instruction
20738
20739 @subsubheading Synopsis
20740
20741 @smallexample
20742 -exec-next-instruction
20743 @end smallexample
20744
20745 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
20746 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
20747 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
20748 printed as well.
20749
20750 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20751
20752 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
20753
20754 @subsubheading Example
20755
20756 @smallexample
20757 (gdb)
20758 -exec-next-instruction
20759 ^running
20760
20761 (gdb)
20762 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20763 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
20764 (gdb)
20765 @end smallexample
20766
20767
20768 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
20769 @findex -exec-return
20770
20771 @subsubheading Synopsis
20772
20773 @smallexample
20774 -exec-return
20775 @end smallexample
20776
20777 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
20778 Displays the new current frame.
20779
20780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20781
20782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
20783
20784 @subsubheading Example
20785
20786 @smallexample
20787 (gdb)
20788 200-break-insert callee4
20789 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
20790 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
20791 (gdb)
20792 000-exec-run
20793 000^running
20794 (gdb)
20795 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
20796 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20797 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20798 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
20799 (gdb)
20800 205-break-delete
20801 205^done
20802 (gdb)
20803 111-exec-return
20804 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
20805 args=[@{name="strarg",
20806 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20807 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20808 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20809 (gdb)
20810 @end smallexample
20811
20812
20813 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
20814 @findex -exec-run
20815
20816 @subsubheading Synopsis
20817
20818 @smallexample
20819 -exec-run
20820 @end smallexample
20821
20822 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
20823 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
20824 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
20825 the program has exited exceptionally.
20826
20827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20828
20829 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
20830
20831 @subsubheading Examples
20832
20833 @smallexample
20834 (gdb)
20835 -break-insert main
20836 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
20837 (gdb)
20838 -exec-run
20839 ^running
20840 (gdb)
20841 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
20842 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
20843 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
20844 (gdb)
20845 @end smallexample
20846
20847 @noindent
20848 Program exited normally:
20849
20850 @smallexample
20851 (gdb)
20852 -exec-run
20853 ^running
20854 (gdb)
20855 x = 55
20856 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
20857 (gdb)
20858 @end smallexample
20859
20860 @noindent
20861 Program exited exceptionally:
20862
20863 @smallexample
20864 (gdb)
20865 -exec-run
20866 ^running
20867 (gdb)
20868 x = 55
20869 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
20870 (gdb)
20871 @end smallexample
20872
20873 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
20874 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
20875
20876 @smallexample
20877 (gdb)
20878 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
20879 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
20880 @end smallexample
20881
20882
20883 @c @subheading -exec-signal
20884
20885
20886 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
20887 @findex -exec-step
20888
20889 @subsubheading Synopsis
20890
20891 @smallexample
20892 -exec-step
20893 @end smallexample
20894
20895 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
20896 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
20897 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
20898 function.
20899
20900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20901
20902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
20903
20904 @subsubheading Example
20905
20906 Stepping into a function:
20907
20908 @smallexample
20909 -exec-step
20910 ^running
20911 (gdb)
20912 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20913 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
20914 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
20915 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
20916 (gdb)
20917 @end smallexample
20918
20919 Regular stepping:
20920
20921 @smallexample
20922 -exec-step
20923 ^running
20924 (gdb)
20925 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
20926 (gdb)
20927 @end smallexample
20928
20929
20930 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
20931 @findex -exec-step-instruction
20932
20933 @subsubheading Synopsis
20934
20935 @smallexample
20936 -exec-step-instruction
20937 @end smallexample
20938
20939 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
20940 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
20941 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
20942 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
20943 well.
20944
20945 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20946
20947 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
20948
20949 @subsubheading Example
20950
20951 @smallexample
20952 (gdb)
20953 -exec-step-instruction
20954 ^running
20955
20956 (gdb)
20957 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20958 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20959 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
20960 (gdb)
20961 -exec-step-instruction
20962 ^running
20963
20964 (gdb)
20965 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20966 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20967 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
20968 (gdb)
20969 @end smallexample
20970
20971
20972 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
20973 @findex -exec-until
20974
20975 @subsubheading Synopsis
20976
20977 @smallexample
20978 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
20979 @end smallexample
20980
20981 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
20982 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
20983 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
20984 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
20985
20986 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20987
20988 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
20989
20990 @subsubheading Example
20991
20992 @smallexample
20993 (gdb)
20994 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
20995 ^running
20996 (gdb)
20997 x = 55
20998 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
20999 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
21000 (gdb)
21001 @end smallexample
21002
21003 @ignore
21004 @subheading -file-clear
21005 Is this going away????
21006 @end ignore
21007
21008 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21009 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
21010 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
21011
21012
21013 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
21014 @findex -stack-info-frame
21015
21016 @subsubheading Synopsis
21017
21018 @smallexample
21019 -stack-info-frame
21020 @end smallexample
21021
21022 Get info on the selected frame.
21023
21024 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21025
21026 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
21027 (without arguments).
21028
21029 @subsubheading Example
21030
21031 @smallexample
21032 (gdb)
21033 -stack-info-frame
21034 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
21035 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21036 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
21037 (gdb)
21038 @end smallexample
21039
21040 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
21041 @findex -stack-info-depth
21042
21043 @subsubheading Synopsis
21044
21045 @smallexample
21046 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
21047 @end smallexample
21048
21049 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
21050 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
21051
21052 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21053
21054 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21055
21056 @subsubheading Example
21057
21058 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
21059
21060 @smallexample
21061 (gdb)
21062 -stack-info-depth
21063 ^done,depth="12"
21064 (gdb)
21065 -stack-info-depth 4
21066 ^done,depth="4"
21067 (gdb)
21068 -stack-info-depth 12
21069 ^done,depth="12"
21070 (gdb)
21071 -stack-info-depth 11
21072 ^done,depth="11"
21073 (gdb)
21074 -stack-info-depth 13
21075 ^done,depth="12"
21076 (gdb)
21077 @end smallexample
21078
21079 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
21080 @findex -stack-list-arguments
21081
21082 @subsubheading Synopsis
21083
21084 @smallexample
21085 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
21086 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
21087 @end smallexample
21088
21089 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
21090 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
21091 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
21092 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
21093 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
21094 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
21095 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
21096 which case only existing frames will be returned.
21097
21098 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
21099 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
21100 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
21101
21102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21103
21104 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
21105 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
21106 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
21107
21108 @subsubheading Example
21109
21110 @smallexample
21111 (gdb)
21112 -stack-list-frames
21113 ^done,
21114 stack=[
21115 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21116 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21117 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
21118 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
21119 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21120 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
21121 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
21122 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21123 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
21124 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
21125 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21126 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
21127 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
21128 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21129 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
21130 (gdb)
21131 -stack-list-arguments 0
21132 ^done,
21133 stack-args=[
21134 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
21135 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
21136 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
21137 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
21138 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
21139 (gdb)
21140 -stack-list-arguments 1
21141 ^done,
21142 stack-args=[
21143 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
21144 frame=@{level="1",
21145 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
21146 frame=@{level="2",args=[
21147 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21148 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
21149 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
21150 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21151 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
21152 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
21153 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
21154 (gdb)
21155 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
21156 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
21157 (gdb)
21158 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
21159 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
21160 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21161 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
21162 (gdb)
21163 @end smallexample
21164
21165 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
21166
21167
21168 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
21169 @findex -stack-list-frames
21170
21171 @subsubheading Synopsis
21172
21173 @smallexample
21174 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
21175 @end smallexample
21176
21177 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
21178 following info:
21179
21180 @table @samp
21181 @item @var{level}
21182 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
21183 @item @var{addr}
21184 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
21185 @item @var{func}
21186 Function name.
21187 @item @var{file}
21188 File name of the source file where the function lives.
21189 @item @var{line}
21190 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
21191 @end table
21192
21193 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
21194 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
21195 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
21196 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
21197 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
21198 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
21199 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
21200
21201 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21202
21203 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
21204
21205 @subsubheading Example
21206
21207 Full stack backtrace:
21208
21209 @smallexample
21210 (gdb)
21211 -stack-list-frames
21212 ^done,stack=
21213 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
21214 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
21215 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21216 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21217 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21218 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21219 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21220 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21221 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21222 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21223 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21224 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21225 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21226 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21227 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21228 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21229 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21230 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21231 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21232 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21233 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21234 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21235 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
21236 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
21237 (gdb)
21238 @end smallexample
21239
21240 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
21241
21242 @smallexample
21243 (gdb)
21244 -stack-list-frames 3 5
21245 ^done,stack=
21246 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21247 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21248 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21249 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21250 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21251 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
21252 (gdb)
21253 @end smallexample
21254
21255 Show a single frame:
21256
21257 @smallexample
21258 (gdb)
21259 -stack-list-frames 3 3
21260 ^done,stack=
21261 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21262 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
21263 (gdb)
21264 @end smallexample
21265
21266
21267 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
21268 @findex -stack-list-locals
21269
21270 @subsubheading Synopsis
21271
21272 @smallexample
21273 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
21274 @end smallexample
21275
21276 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
21277 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
21278 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
21279 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
21280 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
21281 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
21282 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
21283 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
21284 more detail.
21285
21286 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21287
21288 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
21289
21290 @subsubheading Example
21291
21292 @smallexample
21293 (gdb)
21294 -stack-list-locals 0
21295 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
21296 (gdb)
21297 -stack-list-locals --all-values
21298 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
21299 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
21300 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
21301 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
21302 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
21303 (gdb)
21304 @end smallexample
21305
21306
21307 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
21308 @findex -stack-select-frame
21309
21310 @subsubheading Synopsis
21311
21312 @smallexample
21313 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
21314 @end smallexample
21315
21316 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
21317 the stack.
21318
21319 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
21320 option to every command.
21321
21322 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21323
21324 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
21325 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
21326
21327 @subsubheading Example
21328
21329 @smallexample
21330 (gdb)
21331 -stack-select-frame 2
21332 ^done
21333 (gdb)
21334 @end smallexample
21335
21336 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21337 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
21338 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
21339
21340 @ignore
21341
21342 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
21343
21344 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
21345 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
21346 used by @code{Insight}.
21347
21348 The two main reasons for that are:
21349
21350 @enumerate 1
21351 @item
21352 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
21353
21354 @item
21355 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
21356 now).
21357 @end enumerate
21358
21359 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
21360 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
21361 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
21362 hints about their use.
21363
21364 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
21365 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
21366 least, the following operations:
21367
21368 @itemize @bullet
21369 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
21370 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
21371 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
21372 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
21373 @end itemize
21374
21375 @end ignore
21376
21377 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
21378
21379 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
21380
21381 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
21382 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
21383 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
21384 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
21385 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
21386 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
21387 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
21388 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
21389 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
21390 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
21391 object, or to change display format.
21392
21393 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
21394 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
21395 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
21396 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
21397 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
21398 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
21399 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
21400 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
21401 child will be created.
21402
21403 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
21404 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
21405 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
21406 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
21407 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
21408
21409 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
21410 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
21411 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
21412 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
21413 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
21414 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
21415 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
21416 variables that frontend has created.
21417
21418 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
21419 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
21420 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
21421 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
21422 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
21423 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
21424 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
21425 implicitly updated.
21426
21427 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
21428 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
21429 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
21430 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
21431 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
21432 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
21433 frame. Consider this example:
21434
21435 @smallexample
21436 void do_work(...)
21437 @{
21438 struct work_state state;
21439
21440 if (...)
21441 do_work(...);
21442 @}
21443 @end smallexample
21444
21445 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
21446 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
21447 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
21448 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
21449 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
21450
21451 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
21452 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
21453 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
21454 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
21455 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
21456 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
21457
21458 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
21459 access this functionality:
21460
21461 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
21462 @item @strong{Operation}
21463 @tab @strong{Description}
21464
21465 @item @code{-var-create}
21466 @tab create a variable object
21467 @item @code{-var-delete}
21468 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
21469 @item @code{-var-set-format}
21470 @tab set the display format of this variable
21471 @item @code{-var-show-format}
21472 @tab show the display format of this variable
21473 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
21474 @tab tells how many children this object has
21475 @item @code{-var-list-children}
21476 @tab return a list of the object's children
21477 @item @code{-var-info-type}
21478 @tab show the type of this variable object
21479 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
21480 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
21481 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
21482 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
21483 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
21484 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
21485 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
21486 @tab get the value of this variable
21487 @item @code{-var-assign}
21488 @tab set the value of this variable
21489 @item @code{-var-update}
21490 @tab update the variable and its children
21491 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
21492 @tab set frozeness attribute
21493 @end multitable
21494
21495 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
21496 how it can be used.
21497
21498 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
21499
21500 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
21501 @findex -var-create
21502
21503 @subsubheading Synopsis
21504
21505 @smallexample
21506 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
21507 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
21508 @end smallexample
21509
21510 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
21511 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
21512 register.
21513
21514 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
21515 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
21516 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
21517 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
21518 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
21519
21520 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
21521 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
21522 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
21523 object must be created.
21524
21525 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
21526 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
21527
21528 @itemize @bullet
21529 @item
21530 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
21531
21532 @item
21533 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
21534
21535 @item
21536 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
21537 @end itemize
21538
21539 @subsubheading Result
21540
21541 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
21542 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
21543 the @value{GDBN} CLI. If a fixed variable object is bound to a
21544 specific thread, the thread is is also printed:
21545
21546 @smallexample
21547 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}"
21548 @end smallexample
21549
21550
21551 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
21552 @findex -var-delete
21553
21554 @subsubheading Synopsis
21555
21556 @smallexample
21557 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
21558 @end smallexample
21559
21560 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
21561 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
21562
21563 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
21564
21565
21566 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
21567 @findex -var-set-format
21568
21569 @subsubheading Synopsis
21570
21571 @smallexample
21572 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
21573 @end smallexample
21574
21575 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
21576 @var{format-spec}.
21577
21578 @anchor{-var-set-format}
21579 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
21580
21581 @smallexample
21582 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
21583 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
21584 @end smallexample
21585
21586 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
21587 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
21588 for pointers, etc.).
21589
21590 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
21591 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
21592
21593 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
21594 @findex -var-show-format
21595
21596 @subsubheading Synopsis
21597
21598 @smallexample
21599 -var-show-format @var{name}
21600 @end smallexample
21601
21602 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
21603
21604 @smallexample
21605 @var{format} @expansion{}
21606 @var{format-spec}
21607 @end smallexample
21608
21609
21610 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
21611 @findex -var-info-num-children
21612
21613 @subsubheading Synopsis
21614
21615 @smallexample
21616 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
21617 @end smallexample
21618
21619 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
21620
21621 @smallexample
21622 numchild=@var{n}
21623 @end smallexample
21624
21625
21626 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
21627 @findex -var-list-children
21628
21629 @subsubheading Synopsis
21630
21631 @smallexample
21632 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
21633 @end smallexample
21634 @anchor{-var-list-children}
21635
21636 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
21637 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
21638 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
21639 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
21640 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
21641 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
21642 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
21643 and unions.
21644
21645 @subsubheading Example
21646
21647 @smallexample
21648 (gdb)
21649 -var-list-children n
21650 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
21651 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
21652 (gdb)
21653 -var-list-children --all-values n
21654 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
21655 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
21656 @end smallexample
21657
21658
21659 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
21660 @findex -var-info-type
21661
21662 @subsubheading Synopsis
21663
21664 @smallexample
21665 -var-info-type @var{name}
21666 @end smallexample
21667
21668 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
21669 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
21670 @value{GDBN} CLI:
21671
21672 @smallexample
21673 type=@var{typename}
21674 @end smallexample
21675
21676
21677 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
21678 @findex -var-info-expression
21679
21680 @subsubheading Synopsis
21681
21682 @smallexample
21683 -var-info-expression @var{name}
21684 @end smallexample
21685
21686 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
21687 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
21688 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
21689
21690 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
21691 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
21692
21693 @smallexample
21694 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
21695 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
21696 @end smallexample
21697
21698 @noindent
21699 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
21700
21701 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
21702 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
21703 is of limited use.
21704
21705 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
21706 @findex -var-info-path-expression
21707
21708 @subsubheading Synopsis
21709
21710 @smallexample
21711 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
21712 @end smallexample
21713
21714 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
21715 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
21716 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
21717 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
21718 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
21719 watchpoint from a variable object.
21720
21721 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
21722 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
21723 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
21724 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
21725 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
21726 @smallexample
21727 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
21728 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
21729 @end smallexample
21730
21731 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
21732 @findex -var-show-attributes
21733
21734 @subsubheading Synopsis
21735
21736 @smallexample
21737 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
21738 @end smallexample
21739
21740 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
21741
21742 @smallexample
21743 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
21744 @end smallexample
21745
21746 @noindent
21747 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
21748
21749 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
21750 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
21751
21752 @subsubheading Synopsis
21753
21754 @smallexample
21755 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
21756 @end smallexample
21757
21758 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
21759 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
21760 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
21761 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
21762 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
21763 the current display format will be used. The current display format
21764 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
21765
21766 @smallexample
21767 value=@var{value}
21768 @end smallexample
21769
21770 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
21771 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
21772
21773 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
21774 @findex -var-assign
21775
21776 @subsubheading Synopsis
21777
21778 @smallexample
21779 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
21780 @end smallexample
21781
21782 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
21783 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
21784 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
21785 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
21786
21787 @subsubheading Example
21788
21789 @smallexample
21790 (gdb)
21791 -var-assign var1 3
21792 ^done,value="3"
21793 (gdb)
21794 -var-update *
21795 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
21796 (gdb)
21797 @end smallexample
21798
21799 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
21800 @findex -var-update
21801
21802 @subsubheading Synopsis
21803
21804 @smallexample
21805 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
21806 @end smallexample
21807
21808 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
21809 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
21810 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
21811 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
21812 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
21813 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
21814 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
21815 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
21816 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
21817 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
21818 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
21819 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
21820 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
21821
21822 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
21823 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
21824 diagnostic.
21825
21826 @subsubheading Example
21827
21828 @smallexample
21829 (gdb)
21830 -var-assign var1 3
21831 ^done,value="3"
21832 (gdb)
21833 -var-update --all-values var1
21834 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
21835 type_changed="false"@}]
21836 (gdb)
21837 @end smallexample
21838
21839 @anchor{-var-update}
21840 The field in_scope may take three values:
21841
21842 @table @code
21843 @item "true"
21844 The variable object's current value is valid.
21845
21846 @item "false"
21847 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
21848 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
21849 scope.
21850
21851 @item "invalid"
21852 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
21853 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
21854 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
21855 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
21856 objects.
21857 @end table
21858
21859 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
21860 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
21861
21862 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
21863 @findex -var-set-frozen
21864 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
21865
21866 @subsubheading Synopsis
21867
21868 @smallexample
21869 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
21870 @end smallexample
21871
21872 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
21873 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
21874 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
21875 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
21876 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
21877 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
21878 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
21879 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
21880 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
21881 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
21882 @code{-var-update} does.
21883
21884 @subsubheading Example
21885
21886 @smallexample
21887 (gdb)
21888 -var-set-frozen V 1
21889 ^done
21890 (gdb)
21891 @end smallexample
21892
21893
21894 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21895 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
21896 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
21897
21898 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
21899 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
21900 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
21901 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
21902
21903 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
21904 @c @subheading -data-assign
21905 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
21906 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
21907 @c set variable
21908 @c @subsubheading Example
21909 @c N.A.
21910
21911 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
21912 @findex -data-disassemble
21913
21914 @subsubheading Synopsis
21915
21916 @smallexample
21917 -data-disassemble
21918 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
21919 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
21920 -- @var{mode}
21921 @end smallexample
21922
21923 @noindent
21924 Where:
21925
21926 @table @samp
21927 @item @var{start-addr}
21928 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
21929 @item @var{end-addr}
21930 is the end address
21931 @item @var{filename}
21932 is the name of the file to disassemble
21933 @item @var{linenum}
21934 is the line number to disassemble around
21935 @item @var{lines}
21936 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
21937 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
21938 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
21939 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
21940 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
21941 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
21942 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
21943 are displayed.
21944 @item @var{mode}
21945 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
21946 disassembly).
21947 @end table
21948
21949 @subsubheading Result
21950
21951 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
21952
21953 @itemize @bullet
21954 @item Address
21955 @item Func-name
21956 @item Offset
21957 @item Instruction
21958 @end itemize
21959
21960 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
21961 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
21962
21963 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21964
21965 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
21966
21967 @subsubheading Example
21968
21969 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
21970
21971 @smallexample
21972 (gdb)
21973 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
21974 ^done,
21975 asm_insns=[
21976 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21977 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21978 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21979 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21980 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
21981 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
21982 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
21983 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21984 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
21985 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
21986 (gdb)
21987 @end smallexample
21988
21989 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
21990 @code{main}.
21991
21992 @smallexample
21993 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
21994 ^done,asm_insns=[
21995 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
21996 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
21997 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21998 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21999 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22000 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22001 [@dots{}]
22002 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
22003 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
22004 (gdb)
22005 @end smallexample
22006
22007 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
22008
22009 @smallexample
22010 (gdb)
22011 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
22012 ^done,asm_insns=[
22013 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22014 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
22015 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22016 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22017 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22018 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
22019 (gdb)
22020 @end smallexample
22021
22022 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
22023
22024 @smallexample
22025 (gdb)
22026 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
22027 ^done,asm_insns=[
22028 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
22029 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
22030 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
22031 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22032 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
22033 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
22034 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
22035 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
22036 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22037 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22038 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22039 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
22040 (gdb)
22041 @end smallexample
22042
22043
22044 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
22045 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
22046
22047 @subsubheading Synopsis
22048
22049 @smallexample
22050 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
22051 @end smallexample
22052
22053 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
22054 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
22055 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
22056
22057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22058
22059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
22060 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
22061 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
22062
22063 @subsubheading Example
22064
22065 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
22066 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
22067 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
22068 output.
22069
22070 @smallexample
22071 211-data-evaluate-expression A
22072 211^done,value="1"
22073 (gdb)
22074 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
22075 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
22076 (gdb)
22077 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
22078 411^done,value="4"
22079 (gdb)
22080 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
22081 511^done,value="4"
22082 (gdb)
22083 @end smallexample
22084
22085
22086 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
22087 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
22088
22089 @subsubheading Synopsis
22090
22091 @smallexample
22092 -data-list-changed-registers
22093 @end smallexample
22094
22095 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
22096
22097 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22098
22099 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
22100 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
22101
22102 @subsubheading Example
22103
22104 On a PPC MBX board:
22105
22106 @smallexample
22107 (gdb)
22108 -exec-continue
22109 ^running
22110
22111 (gdb)
22112 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
22113 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
22114 line="5"@}
22115 (gdb)
22116 -data-list-changed-registers
22117 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
22118 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
22119 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
22120 (gdb)
22121 @end smallexample
22122
22123
22124 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
22125 @findex -data-list-register-names
22126
22127 @subsubheading Synopsis
22128
22129 @smallexample
22130 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
22131 @end smallexample
22132
22133 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
22134 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
22135 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
22136 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
22137 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
22138 include empty register names.
22139
22140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22141
22142 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
22143 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
22144 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
22145
22146 @subsubheading Example
22147
22148 For the PPC MBX board:
22149 @smallexample
22150 (gdb)
22151 -data-list-register-names
22152 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
22153 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
22154 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
22155 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
22156 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
22157 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
22158 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
22159 (gdb)
22160 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
22161 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
22162 (gdb)
22163 @end smallexample
22164
22165 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
22166 @findex -data-list-register-values
22167
22168 @subsubheading Synopsis
22169
22170 @smallexample
22171 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
22172 @end smallexample
22173
22174 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
22175 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
22176 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
22177 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
22178
22179 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
22180
22181 @table @code
22182 @item x
22183 Hexadecimal
22184 @item o
22185 Octal
22186 @item t
22187 Binary
22188 @item d
22189 Decimal
22190 @item r
22191 Raw
22192 @item N
22193 Natural
22194 @end table
22195
22196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22197
22198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
22199 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
22200
22201 @subsubheading Example
22202
22203 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
22204 don't appear in the actual output):
22205
22206 @smallexample
22207 (gdb)
22208 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
22209 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
22210 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
22211 (gdb)
22212 -data-list-register-values x
22213 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
22214 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
22215 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
22216 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
22217 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
22218 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
22219 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
22220 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
22221 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
22222 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
22223 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
22224 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
22225 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
22226 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
22227 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
22228 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
22229 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
22230 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
22231 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
22232 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
22233 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
22234 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
22235 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
22236 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
22237 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
22238 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
22239 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
22240 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
22241 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
22242 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
22243 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
22244 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
22245 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
22246 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
22247 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
22248 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
22249 (gdb)
22250 @end smallexample
22251
22252
22253 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
22254 @findex -data-read-memory
22255
22256 @subsubheading Synopsis
22257
22258 @smallexample
22259 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
22260 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
22261 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
22262 @end smallexample
22263
22264 @noindent
22265 where:
22266
22267 @table @samp
22268 @item @var{address}
22269 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
22270 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
22271 quoted using the C convention.
22272
22273 @item @var{word-format}
22274 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
22275 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
22276 ,Output Formats}).
22277
22278 @item @var{word-size}
22279 The size of each memory word in bytes.
22280
22281 @item @var{nr-rows}
22282 The number of rows in the output table.
22283
22284 @item @var{nr-cols}
22285 The number of columns in the output table.
22286
22287 @item @var{aschar}
22288 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
22289 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
22290 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
22291 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
22292
22293 @item @var{byte-offset}
22294 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
22295 @end table
22296
22297 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
22298 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
22299 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
22300 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
22301 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
22302 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
22303 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
22304 @samp{addr}.
22305
22306 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
22307 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
22308 @samp{prev-page}.
22309
22310 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22311
22312 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
22313 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
22314
22315 @subsubheading Example
22316
22317 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
22318 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
22319 word. Display each word in hex.
22320
22321 @smallexample
22322 (gdb)
22323 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
22324 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
22325 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
22326 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
22327 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
22328 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
22329 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
22330 (gdb)
22331 @end smallexample
22332
22333 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
22334 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
22335
22336 @smallexample
22337 (gdb)
22338 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
22339 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
22340 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
22341 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
22342 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
22343 (gdb)
22344 @end smallexample
22345
22346 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
22347 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
22348 used as the non-printable character.
22349
22350 @smallexample
22351 (gdb)
22352 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
22353 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
22354 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
22355 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
22356 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22357 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22358 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22359 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22360 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
22361 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
22362 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
22363 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
22364 (gdb)
22365 @end smallexample
22366
22367 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22368 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
22369 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
22370
22371 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
22372
22373 @c @subheading -trace-actions
22374
22375 @c @subheading -trace-delete
22376
22377 @c @subheading -trace-disable
22378
22379 @c @subheading -trace-dump
22380
22381 @c @subheading -trace-enable
22382
22383 @c @subheading -trace-exists
22384
22385 @c @subheading -trace-find
22386
22387 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
22388
22389 @c @subheading -trace-info
22390
22391 @c @subheading -trace-insert
22392
22393 @c @subheading -trace-list
22394
22395 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
22396
22397 @c @subheading -trace-save
22398
22399 @c @subheading -trace-start
22400
22401 @c @subheading -trace-stop
22402
22403
22404 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22405 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
22406 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
22407
22408
22409 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
22410 @findex -symbol-info-address
22411
22412 @subsubheading Synopsis
22413
22414 @smallexample
22415 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
22416 @end smallexample
22417
22418 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
22419
22420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22421
22422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
22423
22424 @subsubheading Example
22425 N.A.
22426
22427
22428 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
22429 @findex -symbol-info-file
22430
22431 @subsubheading Synopsis
22432
22433 @smallexample
22434 -symbol-info-file
22435 @end smallexample
22436
22437 Show the file for the symbol.
22438
22439 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22440
22441 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
22442 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
22443
22444 @subsubheading Example
22445 N.A.
22446
22447
22448 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
22449 @findex -symbol-info-function
22450
22451 @subsubheading Synopsis
22452
22453 @smallexample
22454 -symbol-info-function
22455 @end smallexample
22456
22457 Show which function the symbol lives in.
22458
22459 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22460
22461 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
22462
22463 @subsubheading Example
22464 N.A.
22465
22466
22467 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
22468 @findex -symbol-info-line
22469
22470 @subsubheading Synopsis
22471
22472 @smallexample
22473 -symbol-info-line
22474 @end smallexample
22475
22476 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
22477
22478 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22479
22480 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
22481 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
22482
22483 @subsubheading Example
22484 N.A.
22485
22486
22487 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
22488 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
22489
22490 @subsubheading Synopsis
22491
22492 @smallexample
22493 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
22494 @end smallexample
22495
22496 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
22497
22498 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22499
22500 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
22501
22502 @subsubheading Example
22503 N.A.
22504
22505
22506 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
22507 @findex -symbol-list-functions
22508
22509 @subsubheading Synopsis
22510
22511 @smallexample
22512 -symbol-list-functions
22513 @end smallexample
22514
22515 List the functions in the executable.
22516
22517 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22518
22519 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
22520 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
22521
22522 @subsubheading Example
22523 N.A.
22524
22525
22526 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
22527 @findex -symbol-list-lines
22528
22529 @subsubheading Synopsis
22530
22531 @smallexample
22532 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
22533 @end smallexample
22534
22535 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
22536 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
22537 ascending PC order.
22538
22539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22540
22541 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
22542
22543 @subsubheading Example
22544 @smallexample
22545 (gdb)
22546 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
22547 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
22548 (gdb)
22549 @end smallexample
22550
22551
22552 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
22553 @findex -symbol-list-types
22554
22555 @subsubheading Synopsis
22556
22557 @smallexample
22558 -symbol-list-types
22559 @end smallexample
22560
22561 List all the type names.
22562
22563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22564
22565 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
22566 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
22567
22568 @subsubheading Example
22569 N.A.
22570
22571
22572 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
22573 @findex -symbol-list-variables
22574
22575 @subsubheading Synopsis
22576
22577 @smallexample
22578 -symbol-list-variables
22579 @end smallexample
22580
22581 List all the global and static variable names.
22582
22583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22584
22585 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
22586
22587 @subsubheading Example
22588 N.A.
22589
22590
22591 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
22592 @findex -symbol-locate
22593
22594 @subsubheading Synopsis
22595
22596 @smallexample
22597 -symbol-locate
22598 @end smallexample
22599
22600 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22601
22602 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
22603
22604 @subsubheading Example
22605 N.A.
22606
22607
22608 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
22609 @findex -symbol-type
22610
22611 @subsubheading Synopsis
22612
22613 @smallexample
22614 -symbol-type @var{variable}
22615 @end smallexample
22616
22617 Show type of @var{variable}.
22618
22619 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22620
22621 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
22622 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
22623
22624 @subsubheading Example
22625 N.A.
22626
22627
22628 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22629 @node GDB/MI File Commands
22630 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
22631
22632 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
22633 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
22634
22635 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
22636 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
22637
22638 @subsubheading Synopsis
22639
22640 @smallexample
22641 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
22642 @end smallexample
22643
22644 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
22645 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
22646 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
22647 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
22648 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
22649 notification.
22650
22651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22652
22653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
22654
22655 @subsubheading Example
22656
22657 @smallexample
22658 (gdb)
22659 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
22660 ^done
22661 (gdb)
22662 @end smallexample
22663
22664
22665 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
22666 @findex -file-exec-file
22667
22668 @subsubheading Synopsis
22669
22670 @smallexample
22671 -file-exec-file @var{file}
22672 @end smallexample
22673
22674 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
22675 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
22676 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
22677 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
22678 notification.
22679
22680 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22681
22682 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
22683
22684 @subsubheading Example
22685
22686 @smallexample
22687 (gdb)
22688 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
22689 ^done
22690 (gdb)
22691 @end smallexample
22692
22693
22694 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
22695 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
22696
22697 @subsubheading Synopsis
22698
22699 @smallexample
22700 -file-list-exec-sections
22701 @end smallexample
22702
22703 List the sections of the current executable file.
22704
22705 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22706
22707 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
22708 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
22709 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
22710
22711 @subsubheading Example
22712 N.A.
22713
22714
22715 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
22716 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
22717
22718 @subsubheading Synopsis
22719
22720 @smallexample
22721 -file-list-exec-source-file
22722 @end smallexample
22723
22724 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
22725 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
22726 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
22727 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
22728
22729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22730
22731 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
22732
22733 @subsubheading Example
22734
22735 @smallexample
22736 (gdb)
22737 123-file-list-exec-source-file
22738 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
22739 (gdb)
22740 @end smallexample
22741
22742
22743 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
22744 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
22745
22746 @subsubheading Synopsis
22747
22748 @smallexample
22749 -file-list-exec-source-files
22750 @end smallexample
22751
22752 List the source files for the current executable.
22753
22754 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
22755 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
22756
22757 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22758
22759 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
22760 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
22761
22762 @subsubheading Example
22763 @smallexample
22764 (gdb)
22765 -file-list-exec-source-files
22766 ^done,files=[
22767 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
22768 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
22769 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
22770 (gdb)
22771 @end smallexample
22772
22773 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
22774 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
22775
22776 @subsubheading Synopsis
22777
22778 @smallexample
22779 -file-list-shared-libraries
22780 @end smallexample
22781
22782 List the shared libraries in the program.
22783
22784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22785
22786 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
22787
22788 @subsubheading Example
22789 N.A.
22790
22791
22792 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
22793 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
22794
22795 @subsubheading Synopsis
22796
22797 @smallexample
22798 -file-list-symbol-files
22799 @end smallexample
22800
22801 List symbol files.
22802
22803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22804
22805 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
22806
22807 @subsubheading Example
22808 N.A.
22809
22810
22811 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
22812 @findex -file-symbol-file
22813
22814 @subsubheading Synopsis
22815
22816 @smallexample
22817 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
22818 @end smallexample
22819
22820 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
22821 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
22822 produced, except for a completion notification.
22823
22824 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22825
22826 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
22827
22828 @subsubheading Example
22829
22830 @smallexample
22831 (gdb)
22832 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
22833 ^done
22834 (gdb)
22835 @end smallexample
22836
22837 @ignore
22838 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22839 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
22840 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
22841
22842 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
22843
22844 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
22845
22846 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
22847
22848 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
22849
22850 @c @subheading -overlay-map
22851
22852 @c @subheading -overlay-off
22853
22854 @c @subheading -overlay-on
22855
22856 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
22857
22858 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22859 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
22860 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
22861
22862 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
22863
22864 @c @subheading -signal-handle
22865
22866 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
22867
22868 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
22869 @end ignore
22870
22871
22872 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22873 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
22874 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
22875
22876
22877 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
22878 @findex -target-attach
22879
22880 @subsubheading Synopsis
22881
22882 @smallexample
22883 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
22884 @end smallexample
22885
22886 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
22887 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
22888 group, the id previously returned by
22889 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
22890
22891 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22892
22893 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
22894
22895 @subsubheading Example
22896 @smallexample
22897 (gdb)
22898 -target-attach 34
22899 =thread-created,id="1"
22900 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
22901 ^done
22902 (gdb)
22903 @end smallexample
22904
22905 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
22906 @findex -target-compare-sections
22907
22908 @subsubheading Synopsis
22909
22910 @smallexample
22911 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
22912 @end smallexample
22913
22914 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
22915 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
22916
22917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22918
22919 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
22920
22921 @subsubheading Example
22922 N.A.
22923
22924
22925 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
22926 @findex -target-detach
22927
22928 @subsubheading Synopsis
22929
22930 @smallexample
22931 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
22932 @end smallexample
22933
22934 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
22935 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
22936 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
22937
22938 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22939
22940 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
22941
22942 @subsubheading Example
22943
22944 @smallexample
22945 (gdb)
22946 -target-detach
22947 ^done
22948 (gdb)
22949 @end smallexample
22950
22951
22952 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
22953 @findex -target-disconnect
22954
22955 @subsubheading Synopsis
22956
22957 @smallexample
22958 -target-disconnect
22959 @end smallexample
22960
22961 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
22962 generally not resumed.
22963
22964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22965
22966 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
22967
22968 @subsubheading Example
22969
22970 @smallexample
22971 (gdb)
22972 -target-disconnect
22973 ^done
22974 (gdb)
22975 @end smallexample
22976
22977
22978 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
22979 @findex -target-download
22980
22981 @subsubheading Synopsis
22982
22983 @smallexample
22984 -target-download
22985 @end smallexample
22986
22987 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
22988 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
22989
22990 @table @samp
22991 @item section
22992 The name of the section.
22993 @item section-sent
22994 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
22995 @item section-size
22996 The size of the section.
22997 @item total-sent
22998 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
22999 @item total-size
23000 The size of the overall executable to download.
23001 @end table
23002
23003 @noindent
23004 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
23005 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
23006
23007 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
23008 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
23009
23010 @table @samp
23011 @item section
23012 The name of the section.
23013 @item section-size
23014 The size of the section.
23015 @item total-size
23016 The size of the overall executable to download.
23017 @end table
23018
23019 @noindent
23020 At the end, a summary is printed.
23021
23022 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23023
23024 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
23025
23026 @subsubheading Example
23027
23028 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
23029 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
23030
23031 @smallexample
23032 (gdb)
23033 -target-download
23034 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
23035 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
23036 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
23037 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
23038 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
23039 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
23040 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
23041 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
23042 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
23043 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
23044 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
23045 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
23046 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
23047 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
23048 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
23049 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
23050 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
23051 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
23052 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
23053 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
23054 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
23055 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
23056 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
23057 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
23058 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
23059 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
23060 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
23061 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
23062 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
23063 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
23064 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
23065 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
23066 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
23067 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
23068 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
23069 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
23070 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
23071 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
23072 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
23073 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
23074 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
23075 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
23076 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
23077 write-rate="429"
23078 (gdb)
23079 @end smallexample
23080
23081
23082 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
23083 @findex -target-exec-status
23084
23085 @subsubheading Synopsis
23086
23087 @smallexample
23088 -target-exec-status
23089 @end smallexample
23090
23091 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
23092 not, for instance).
23093
23094 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23095
23096 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
23097
23098 @subsubheading Example
23099 N.A.
23100
23101
23102 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
23103 @findex -target-list-available-targets
23104
23105 @subsubheading Synopsis
23106
23107 @smallexample
23108 -target-list-available-targets
23109 @end smallexample
23110
23111 List the possible targets to connect to.
23112
23113 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23114
23115 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
23116
23117 @subsubheading Example
23118 N.A.
23119
23120
23121 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
23122 @findex -target-list-current-targets
23123
23124 @subsubheading Synopsis
23125
23126 @smallexample
23127 -target-list-current-targets
23128 @end smallexample
23129
23130 Describe the current target.
23131
23132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23133
23134 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
23135 other things).
23136
23137 @subsubheading Example
23138 N.A.
23139
23140
23141 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
23142 @findex -target-list-parameters
23143
23144 @subsubheading Synopsis
23145
23146 @smallexample
23147 -target-list-parameters
23148 @end smallexample
23149
23150 @c ????
23151
23152 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23153
23154 No equivalent.
23155
23156 @subsubheading Example
23157 N.A.
23158
23159
23160 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
23161 @findex -target-select
23162
23163 @subsubheading Synopsis
23164
23165 @smallexample
23166 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
23167 @end smallexample
23168
23169 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
23170
23171 @table @samp
23172 @item @var{type}
23173 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
23174 @item @var{parameters}
23175 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
23176 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
23177 @end table
23178
23179 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
23180 which the target program is, in the following form:
23181
23182 @smallexample
23183 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
23184 args=[@var{arg list}]
23185 @end smallexample
23186
23187 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23188
23189 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
23190
23191 @subsubheading Example
23192
23193 @smallexample
23194 (gdb)
23195 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
23196 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
23197 (gdb)
23198 @end smallexample
23199
23200 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23201 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
23202 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
23203
23204
23205 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
23206 @findex -target-file-put
23207
23208 @subsubheading Synopsis
23209
23210 @smallexample
23211 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
23212 @end smallexample
23213
23214 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
23215 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
23216
23217 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23218
23219 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
23220
23221 @subsubheading Example
23222
23223 @smallexample
23224 (gdb)
23225 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
23226 ^done
23227 (gdb)
23228 @end smallexample
23229
23230
23231 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
23232 @findex -target-file-get
23233
23234 @subsubheading Synopsis
23235
23236 @smallexample
23237 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
23238 @end smallexample
23239
23240 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
23241 on the host system.
23242
23243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23244
23245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
23246
23247 @subsubheading Example
23248
23249 @smallexample
23250 (gdb)
23251 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
23252 ^done
23253 (gdb)
23254 @end smallexample
23255
23256
23257 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
23258 @findex -target-file-delete
23259
23260 @subsubheading Synopsis
23261
23262 @smallexample
23263 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
23264 @end smallexample
23265
23266 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
23267
23268 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23269
23270 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
23271
23272 @subsubheading Example
23273
23274 @smallexample
23275 (gdb)
23276 -target-file-delete remotefile
23277 ^done
23278 (gdb)
23279 @end smallexample
23280
23281
23282 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23283 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
23284 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
23285
23286 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
23287
23288 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
23289 @findex -gdb-exit
23290
23291 @subsubheading Synopsis
23292
23293 @smallexample
23294 -gdb-exit
23295 @end smallexample
23296
23297 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
23298
23299 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23300
23301 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
23302
23303 @subsubheading Example
23304
23305 @smallexample
23306 (gdb)
23307 -gdb-exit
23308 ^exit
23309 @end smallexample
23310
23311
23312 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
23313 @findex -exec-abort
23314
23315 @subsubheading Synopsis
23316
23317 @smallexample
23318 -exec-abort
23319 @end smallexample
23320
23321 Kill the inferior running program.
23322
23323 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23324
23325 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
23326
23327 @subsubheading Example
23328 N.A.
23329
23330
23331 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
23332 @findex -gdb-set
23333
23334 @subsubheading Synopsis
23335
23336 @smallexample
23337 -gdb-set
23338 @end smallexample
23339
23340 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
23341 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
23342
23343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23344
23345 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
23346
23347 @subsubheading Example
23348
23349 @smallexample
23350 (gdb)
23351 -gdb-set $foo=3
23352 ^done
23353 (gdb)
23354 @end smallexample
23355
23356
23357 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
23358 @findex -gdb-show
23359
23360 @subsubheading Synopsis
23361
23362 @smallexample
23363 -gdb-show
23364 @end smallexample
23365
23366 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
23367
23368 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23369
23370 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
23371
23372 @subsubheading Example
23373
23374 @smallexample
23375 (gdb)
23376 -gdb-show annotate
23377 ^done,value="0"
23378 (gdb)
23379 @end smallexample
23380
23381 @c @subheading -gdb-source
23382
23383
23384 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
23385 @findex -gdb-version
23386
23387 @subsubheading Synopsis
23388
23389 @smallexample
23390 -gdb-version
23391 @end smallexample
23392
23393 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
23394
23395 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23396
23397 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
23398 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
23399
23400 @subsubheading Example
23401
23402 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
23403 @c box in TeX.
23404 @smallexample
23405 (gdb)
23406 -gdb-version
23407 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
23408 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
23409 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
23410 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
23411 ~ certain conditions.
23412 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
23413 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
23414 ~ details.
23415 ~This GDB was configured as
23416 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
23417 ^done
23418 (gdb)
23419 @end smallexample
23420
23421 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
23422 @findex -list-features
23423
23424 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
23425 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
23426 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
23427 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
23428 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
23429 startup.
23430
23431 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
23432 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
23433 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
23434 is given below.
23435
23436 Example output:
23437
23438 @smallexample
23439 (gdb) -list-features
23440 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
23441 @end smallexample
23442
23443 The current list of features is:
23444
23445 @table @samp
23446 @item frozen-varobjs
23447 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
23448 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
23449 of @code{-varobj-create}.
23450 @item pending-breakpoints
23451 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
23452 @item thread-info
23453 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
23454
23455 @end table
23456
23457 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
23458 @findex -list-target-features
23459
23460 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
23461 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
23462 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
23463 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
23464 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
23465 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
23466 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
23467 Example output:
23468
23469 @smallexample
23470 (gdb) -list-features
23471 ^done,result=["async"]
23472 @end smallexample
23473
23474 The current list of features is:
23475
23476 @table @samp
23477 @item async
23478 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
23479 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
23480 while the target is running.
23481
23482 @end table
23483
23484 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
23485 @findex -list-thread-groups
23486
23487 @subheading Synopsis
23488
23489 @smallexample
23490 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ @var{group} ]
23491 @end smallexample
23492
23493 When used without the @var{group} parameter, lists top-level thread
23494 groups that are being debugged. When used with the @var{group}
23495 parameter, the children of the specified group are listed. The
23496 children can be either threads, or other groups. At present,
23497 @value{GDBN} will not report both threads and groups as children at
23498 the same time, but it may change in future.
23499
23500 With the @samp{--available} option, instead of reporting groups that
23501 are been debugged, GDB will report all thread groups available on the
23502 target. Using the @samp{--available} option together with @var{group}
23503 is not allowed.
23504
23505 @subheading Example
23506
23507 @smallexample
23508 @value{GDBP}
23509 -list-thread-groups
23510 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
23511 -list-thread-groups 17
23512 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
23513 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
23514 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
23515 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
23516 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
23517 @end smallexample
23518
23519 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
23520 @findex -interpreter-exec
23521
23522 @subheading Synopsis
23523
23524 @smallexample
23525 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
23526 @end smallexample
23527 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
23528
23529 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
23530
23531 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
23532
23533 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
23534
23535 @subheading Example
23536
23537 @smallexample
23538 (gdb)
23539 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
23540 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
23541 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
23542 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
23543 ^done
23544 (gdb)
23545 @end smallexample
23546
23547 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
23548 @findex -inferior-tty-set
23549
23550 @subheading Synopsis
23551
23552 @smallexample
23553 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
23554 @end smallexample
23555
23556 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
23557
23558 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
23559
23560 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
23561
23562 @subheading Example
23563
23564 @smallexample
23565 (gdb)
23566 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
23567 ^done
23568 (gdb)
23569 @end smallexample
23570
23571 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
23572 @findex -inferior-tty-show
23573
23574 @subheading Synopsis
23575
23576 @smallexample
23577 -inferior-tty-show
23578 @end smallexample
23579
23580 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
23581
23582 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
23583
23584 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
23585
23586 @subheading Example
23587
23588 @smallexample
23589 (gdb)
23590 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
23591 ^done
23592 (gdb)
23593 -inferior-tty-show
23594 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
23595 (gdb)
23596 @end smallexample
23597
23598 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
23599 @findex -enable-timings
23600
23601 @subheading Synopsis
23602
23603 @smallexample
23604 -enable-timings [yes | no]
23605 @end smallexample
23606
23607 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
23608 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
23609 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
23610 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
23611
23612 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
23613
23614 No equivalent.
23615
23616 @subheading Example
23617
23618 @smallexample
23619 (gdb)
23620 -enable-timings
23621 ^done
23622 (gdb)
23623 -break-insert main
23624 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
23625 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
23626 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
23627 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
23628 (gdb)
23629 -enable-timings no
23630 ^done
23631 (gdb)
23632 -exec-run
23633 ^running
23634 (gdb)
23635 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
23636 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
23637 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
23638 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
23639 (gdb)
23640 @end smallexample
23641
23642 @node Annotations
23643 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
23644
23645 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
23646 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
23647 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
23648 relatively high level.
23649
23650 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
23651 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
23652
23653 @ignore
23654 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
23655 @end ignore
23656
23657 @menu
23658 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
23659 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
23660 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
23661 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
23662 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
23663 * Annotations for Running::
23664 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
23665 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
23666 @end menu
23667
23668 @node Annotations Overview
23669 @section What is an Annotation?
23670 @cindex annotations
23671
23672 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
23673 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
23674 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
23675 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
23676 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
23677 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
23678 cannot contain newline characters.
23679
23680 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
23681 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
23682 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
23683 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
23684 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
23685 means those three characters as output.
23686
23687 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
23688 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
23689 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
23690 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
23691 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
23692 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
23693 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
23694 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
23695 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
23696
23697 @table @code
23698 @kindex set annotate
23699 @item set annotate @var{level}
23700 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
23701 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
23702
23703 @item show annotate
23704 @kindex show annotate
23705 Show the current annotation level.
23706 @end table
23707
23708 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
23709
23710 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
23711
23712 @smallexample
23713 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
23714 GNU gdb 6.0
23715 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
23716 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
23717 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
23718 under certain conditions.
23719 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
23720 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
23721 for details.
23722 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
23723
23724 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
23725 (@value{GDBP})
23726 ^Z^Zprompt
23727 @kbd{quit}
23728
23729 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
23730 $
23731 @end smallexample
23732
23733 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
23734 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
23735 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
23736 output from @value{GDBN}.
23737
23738 @node Server Prefix
23739 @section The Server Prefix
23740 @cindex server prefix
23741
23742 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
23743 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
23744 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
23745 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
23746 a transparent manner.
23747
23748 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23749 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23750 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23751
23752 @node Prompting
23753 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
23754
23755 @cindex annotations for prompts
23756 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
23757 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
23758 over, etc.
23759
23760 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
23761 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
23762 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
23763 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
23764 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
23765 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
23766 features the following annotations:
23767
23768 @smallexample
23769 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
23770 ^Z^Zprompt
23771 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
23772 @end smallexample
23773
23774 The input types are
23775
23776 @table @code
23777 @findex pre-prompt annotation
23778 @findex prompt annotation
23779 @findex post-prompt annotation
23780 @item prompt
23781 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
23782
23783 @findex pre-commands annotation
23784 @findex commands annotation
23785 @findex post-commands annotation
23786 @item commands
23787 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
23788 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
23789
23790 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
23791 @findex overload-choice annotation
23792 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
23793 @item overload-choice
23794 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
23795
23796 @findex pre-query annotation
23797 @findex query annotation
23798 @findex post-query annotation
23799 @item query
23800 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
23801
23802 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
23803 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
23804 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
23805 @item prompt-for-continue
23806 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
23807 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
23808 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
23809 presence of annotations.
23810 @end table
23811
23812 @node Errors
23813 @section Errors
23814 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
23815
23816 @findex quit annotation
23817 @smallexample
23818 ^Z^Zquit
23819 @end smallexample
23820
23821 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
23822
23823 @findex error annotation
23824 @smallexample
23825 ^Z^Zerror
23826 @end smallexample
23827
23828 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
23829
23830 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
23831 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
23832 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
23833 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
23834 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
23835 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
23836 to the top level.
23837
23838 @findex error-begin annotation
23839 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
23840
23841 @smallexample
23842 ^Z^Zerror-begin
23843 @end smallexample
23844
23845 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
23846 message.
23847
23848 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
23849 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
23850 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
23851
23852 @node Invalidation
23853 @section Invalidation Notices
23854
23855 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
23856 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
23857 changed.
23858
23859 @table @code
23860 @findex frames-invalid annotation
23861 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
23862
23863 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
23864 have changed.
23865
23866 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
23867 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
23868
23869 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
23870 deleted a breakpoint.
23871 @end table
23872
23873 @node Annotations for Running
23874 @section Running the Program
23875 @cindex annotations for running programs
23876
23877 @findex starting annotation
23878 @findex stopping annotation
23879 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
23880 @code{step} or @code{continue},
23881
23882 @smallexample
23883 ^Z^Zstarting
23884 @end smallexample
23885
23886 is output. When the program stops,
23887
23888 @smallexample
23889 ^Z^Zstopped
23890 @end smallexample
23891
23892 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
23893 annotations describe how the program stopped.
23894
23895 @table @code
23896 @findex exited annotation
23897 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
23898 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
23899 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
23900
23901 @findex signalled annotation
23902 @findex signal-name annotation
23903 @findex signal-name-end annotation
23904 @findex signal-string annotation
23905 @findex signal-string-end annotation
23906 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
23907 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
23908 annotation continues:
23909
23910 @smallexample
23911 @var{intro-text}
23912 ^Z^Zsignal-name
23913 @var{name}
23914 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
23915 @var{middle-text}
23916 ^Z^Zsignal-string
23917 @var{string}
23918 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
23919 @var{end-text}
23920 @end smallexample
23921
23922 @noindent
23923 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
23924 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
23925 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
23926 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
23927 user's benefit and have no particular format.
23928
23929 @findex signal annotation
23930 @item ^Z^Zsignal
23931 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
23932 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
23933 terminated with it.
23934
23935 @findex breakpoint annotation
23936 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
23937 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
23938
23939 @findex watchpoint annotation
23940 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
23941 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
23942 @end table
23943
23944 @node Source Annotations
23945 @section Displaying Source
23946 @cindex annotations for source display
23947
23948 @findex source annotation
23949 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
23950
23951 @smallexample
23952 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
23953 @end smallexample
23954
23955 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
23956 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
23957 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
23958 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
23959 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
23960 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
23961 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
23962 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
23963 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
23964 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
23965 depend on the language).
23966
23967 @node GDB Bugs
23968 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
23969 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
23970 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
23971
23972 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
23973
23974 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
23975 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
23976 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
23977 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
23978
23979 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
23980 information that enables us to fix the bug.
23981
23982 @menu
23983 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
23984 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
23985 @end menu
23986
23987 @node Bug Criteria
23988 @section Have You Found a Bug?
23989 @cindex bug criteria
23990
23991 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
23992
23993 @itemize @bullet
23994 @cindex fatal signal
23995 @cindex debugger crash
23996 @cindex crash of debugger
23997 @item
23998 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
23999 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
24000
24001 @cindex error on valid input
24002 @item
24003 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
24004 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
24005 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
24006
24007 @cindex invalid input
24008 @item
24009 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
24010 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
24011 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
24012 for traditional practice''.
24013
24014 @item
24015 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
24016 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
24017 @end itemize
24018
24019 @node Bug Reporting
24020 @section How to Report Bugs
24021 @cindex bug reports
24022 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
24023
24024 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
24025 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
24026 contact that organization first.
24027
24028 You can find contact information for many support companies and
24029 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
24030 distribution.
24031 @c should add a web page ref...
24032
24033 @ifset BUGURL
24034 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
24035 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
24036 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
24037 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
24038 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
24039 be used.
24040
24041 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
24042 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
24043 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
24044 @samp{bug-gdb}.
24045
24046 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
24047 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
24048 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
24049 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
24050 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
24051 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
24052 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
24053 bug reports to the mailing list.
24054 @end ifset
24055 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
24056 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
24057 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
24058 @end ifclear
24059 @end ifset
24060
24061 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
24062 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
24063 fact or leave it out, state it!
24064
24065 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
24066 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
24067 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
24068 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
24069 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
24070 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
24071 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
24072 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
24073 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
24074
24075 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
24076 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
24077 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
24078 self-contained.
24079
24080 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
24081 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
24082 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
24083 bugs properly.
24084
24085 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
24086
24087 @itemize @bullet
24088 @item
24089 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
24090 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
24091 version}.
24092
24093 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
24094 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
24095
24096 @item
24097 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
24098 version number.
24099
24100 @item
24101 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
24102 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
24103
24104 @item
24105 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
24106 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
24107 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
24108 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
24109 those compilers.
24110
24111 @item
24112 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
24113 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
24114 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
24115 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
24116
24117 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
24118 and then we might not encounter the bug.
24119
24120 @item
24121 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
24122 reproduce the bug.
24123
24124 @item
24125 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
24126 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
24127
24128 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
24129 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
24130 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
24131 a chance to make a mistake.
24132
24133 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
24134 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
24135 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
24136 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
24137 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
24138 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
24139 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
24140 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
24141
24142 @pindex script
24143 @cindex recording a session script
24144 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
24145 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
24146 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
24147 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
24148
24149 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
24150 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
24151
24152 @item
24153 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
24154 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
24155 it by context, not by line number.
24156
24157 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
24158 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
24159
24160 @end itemize
24161
24162 Here are some things that are not necessary:
24163
24164 @itemize @bullet
24165 @item
24166 A description of the envelope of the bug.
24167
24168 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
24169 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
24170 changes will not affect it.
24171
24172 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
24173 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
24174 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
24175 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
24176
24177 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
24178 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
24179 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
24180 less time, and so on.
24181
24182 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
24183 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
24184
24185 @item
24186 A patch for the bug.
24187
24188 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
24189 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
24190 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
24191 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
24192
24193 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
24194 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
24195 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
24196 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
24197
24198 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
24199 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
24200 help us to understand.
24201
24202 @item
24203 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
24204
24205 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
24206 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
24207 @end itemize
24208
24209 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
24210 @c and consists of the two following files:
24211 @c rluser.texinfo
24212 @c inc-hist.texinfo
24213 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
24214 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
24215 @include rluser.texi
24216 @include inc-hist.texinfo
24217
24218
24219 @node Formatting Documentation
24220 @appendix Formatting Documentation
24221
24222 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
24223 @cindex reference card
24224 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
24225 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
24226 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
24227 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
24228 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
24229 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
24230
24231 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
24232 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
24233
24234 @smallexample
24235 make refcard.dvi
24236 @end smallexample
24237
24238 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
24239 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
24240 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
24241 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
24242 your @sc{dvi} output program.
24243
24244 @cindex documentation
24245
24246 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
24247 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
24248 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
24249 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
24250 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
24251 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
24252
24253 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
24254 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
24255 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
24256 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
24257 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
24258 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
24259 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
24260 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
24261
24262 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
24263 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
24264 @code{makeinfo}.
24265
24266 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
24267 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
24268 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
24269
24270 @smallexample
24271 cd gdb
24272 make gdb.info
24273 @end smallexample
24274
24275 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
24276 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
24277 Texinfo definitions file.
24278
24279 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
24280 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
24281 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
24282 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
24283 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
24284 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
24285 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
24286
24287 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
24288 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
24289 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
24290 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
24291 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
24292 directory.
24293
24294 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
24295 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
24296 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
24297 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
24298
24299 @smallexample
24300 make gdb.dvi
24301 @end smallexample
24302
24303 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
24304
24305 @node Installing GDB
24306 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
24307 @cindex installation
24308
24309 @menu
24310 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
24311 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
24312 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
24313 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
24314 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
24315 @end menu
24316
24317 @node Requirements
24318 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
24319 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
24320
24321 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
24322 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
24323
24324 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
24325 @table @asis
24326 @item ISO C90 compiler
24327 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
24328 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
24329
24330 @end table
24331
24332 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
24333 @table @asis
24334 @item Expat
24335 @anchor{Expat}
24336 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
24337 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
24338 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
24339 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
24340 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
24341 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
24342
24343 Expat is used for:
24344
24345 @itemize @bullet
24346 @item
24347 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
24348 @item
24349 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
24350 @item
24351 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
24352 @item
24353 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
24354 @end itemize
24355
24356 @item zlib
24357 @cindex compressed debug sections
24358 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
24359 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
24360 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
24361 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
24362 information in such binaries.
24363
24364 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
24365 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
24366 @url{http://zlib.net}.
24367
24368 @end table
24369
24370 @node Running Configure
24371 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
24372 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
24373 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
24374 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
24375 build the @code{gdb} program.
24376 @iftex
24377 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
24378 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
24379 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
24380 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
24381 @end iftex
24382
24383 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
24384 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
24385 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
24386
24387 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
24388 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
24389
24390 @table @code
24391 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
24392 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
24393
24394 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
24395 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
24396
24397 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
24398 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
24399
24400 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
24401 @sc{gnu} include files
24402
24403 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
24404 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
24405
24406 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
24407 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
24408
24409 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
24410 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
24411
24412 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
24413 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
24414
24415 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
24416 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
24417 @end table
24418
24419 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
24420 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
24421 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
24422
24423 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
24424 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
24425 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
24426 argument.
24427
24428 For example:
24429
24430 @smallexample
24431 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
24432 ./configure @var{host}
24433 make
24434 @end smallexample
24435
24436 @noindent
24437 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
24438 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
24439 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
24440 correct value by examining your system.)
24441
24442 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
24443 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
24444 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
24445 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
24446
24447 @need 750
24448 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
24449 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
24450 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
24451
24452 @smallexample
24453 sh configure @var{host}
24454 @end smallexample
24455
24456 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
24457 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
24458 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
24459 @file{configure}
24460 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
24461 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
24462
24463 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
24464 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
24465 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
24466 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
24467 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
24468 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
24469 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
24470 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
24471 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
24472
24473 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
24474 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
24475 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
24476 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
24477 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
24478
24479 @node Separate Objdir
24480 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
24481
24482 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
24483 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
24484 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
24485 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
24486 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
24487 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
24488 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
24489 program specified there.
24490
24491 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
24492 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
24493 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
24494 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
24495 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
24496 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
24497
24498 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
24499 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
24500
24501 @smallexample
24502 @group
24503 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
24504 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
24505 cd ../gdb-sun4
24506 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
24507 make
24508 @end group
24509 @end smallexample
24510
24511 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
24512 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
24513 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
24514 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
24515 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
24516 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
24517
24518 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
24519 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
24520 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
24521 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
24522 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
24523
24524 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
24525 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
24526 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
24527 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
24528 You specify a cross-debugging target by
24529 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
24530
24531 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
24532 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
24533 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
24534
24535 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
24536 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
24537 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
24538 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
24539 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
24540
24541 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
24542 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
24543 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
24544 with each other.
24545
24546 @node Config Names
24547 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
24548
24549 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
24550 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
24551 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
24552 of information in the following pattern:
24553
24554 @smallexample
24555 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
24556 @end smallexample
24557
24558 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
24559 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
24560 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
24561
24562 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
24563 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
24564 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
24565 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
24566 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
24567 abbreviations---for example:
24568
24569 @smallexample
24570 % sh config.sub i386-linux
24571 i386-pc-linux-gnu
24572 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
24573 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
24574 % sh config.sub hp9k700
24575 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
24576 % sh config.sub sun4
24577 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
24578 % sh config.sub sun3
24579 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
24580 % sh config.sub i986v
24581 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
24582 @end smallexample
24583
24584 @noindent
24585 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
24586 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
24587
24588 @node Configure Options
24589 @section @file{configure} Options
24590
24591 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
24592 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
24593 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
24594 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
24595
24596 @smallexample
24597 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
24598 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
24599 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
24600 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
24601 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
24602 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
24603 @var{host}
24604 @end smallexample
24605
24606 @noindent
24607 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
24608 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
24609 @samp{--}.
24610
24611 @table @code
24612 @item --help
24613 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
24614
24615 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
24616 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
24617 @file{@var{dir}}.
24618
24619 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
24620 Configure the source to install programs under directory
24621 @file{@var{dir}}.
24622
24623 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
24624 @need 2000
24625 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
24626 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
24627 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
24628 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
24629 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
24630 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
24631 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
24632 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
24633 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
24634 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
24635 @var{dirname}.
24636
24637 @item --norecursion
24638 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
24639 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
24640
24641 @item --target=@var{target}
24642 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
24643 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
24644 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
24645
24646 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
24647
24648 @item @var{host} @dots{}
24649 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
24650
24651 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
24652 @end table
24653
24654 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
24655 needed for special purposes only.
24656
24657 @node Maintenance Commands
24658 @appendix Maintenance Commands
24659 @cindex maintenance commands
24660 @cindex internal commands
24661
24662 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
24663 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
24664 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
24665 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
24666 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
24667
24668 @table @code
24669 @kindex maint agent
24670 @item maint agent @var{expression}
24671 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
24672 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
24673 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
24674
24675 @kindex maint info breakpoints
24676 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
24677 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
24678 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
24679 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
24680 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
24681 is shown:
24682
24683 @table @code
24684 @item breakpoint
24685 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
24686
24687 @item watchpoint
24688 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
24689
24690 @item longjmp
24691 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
24692 @code{longjmp} calls.
24693
24694 @item longjmp resume
24695 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
24696
24697 @item until
24698 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
24699
24700 @item finish
24701 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
24702
24703 @item shlib events
24704 Shared library events.
24705
24706 @end table
24707
24708 @kindex set displaced-stepping
24709 @kindex show displaced-stepping
24710 @cindex displaced stepping support
24711 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
24712 @item set displaced-stepping
24713 @itemx show displaced-stepping
24714 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
24715 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
24716 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
24717 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
24718 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
24719
24720 @table @code
24721 @item set displaced-stepping on
24722 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
24723 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
24724
24725 @item set displaced-stepping off
24726 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
24727 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
24728
24729 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
24730 @item set displaced-stepping auto
24731 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
24732 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
24733 architecture supports displaced stepping.
24734 @end table
24735
24736 @kindex maint check-symtabs
24737 @item maint check-symtabs
24738 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
24739
24740 @kindex maint cplus first_component
24741 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
24742 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
24743
24744 @kindex maint cplus namespace
24745 @item maint cplus namespace
24746 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
24747
24748 @kindex maint demangle
24749 @item maint demangle @var{name}
24750 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
24751
24752 @kindex maint deprecate
24753 @kindex maint undeprecate
24754 @cindex deprecated commands
24755 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
24756 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
24757 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
24758 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
24759 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
24760 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
24761 the replacement as part of the warning.
24762
24763 @kindex maint dump-me
24764 @item maint dump-me
24765 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
24766 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
24767 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
24768 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
24769
24770 @kindex maint internal-error
24771 @kindex maint internal-warning
24772 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
24773 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
24774 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
24775 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
24776 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
24777 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
24778 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
24779 @value{GDBN} session.
24780
24781 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
24782 used as the text of the error or warning message.
24783
24784 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
24785
24786 @smallexample
24787 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
24788 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
24789 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
24790 debugging may prove unreliable.
24791 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
24792 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
24793 (@value{GDBP})
24794 @end smallexample
24795
24796 @kindex maint packet
24797 @item maint packet @var{text}
24798 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
24799 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
24800 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
24801 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
24802 checksum.
24803
24804 @kindex maint print architecture
24805 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24806 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
24807 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
24808
24809 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
24810 @item maint print c-tdesc
24811 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
24812 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
24813 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
24814
24815 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
24816 @item maint print dummy-frames
24817 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
24818
24819 @smallexample
24820 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
24821 @dots{}
24822 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
24823 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
24824 58 return (a + b);
24825 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
24826 @dots{}
24827 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
24828 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
24829 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
24830 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
24831 (@value{GDBP})
24832 @end smallexample
24833
24834 Takes an optional file parameter.
24835
24836 @kindex maint print registers
24837 @kindex maint print raw-registers
24838 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
24839 @kindex maint print register-groups
24840 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24841 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24842 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24843 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24844 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
24845
24846 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
24847 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
24848 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
24849 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
24850 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
24851 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
24852
24853 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
24854 write the information.
24855
24856 @kindex maint print reggroups
24857 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24858 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
24859 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
24860 information.
24861
24862 The register groups info looks like this:
24863
24864 @smallexample
24865 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
24866 Group Type
24867 general user
24868 float user
24869 all user
24870 vector user
24871 system user
24872 save internal
24873 restore internal
24874 @end smallexample
24875
24876 @kindex flushregs
24877 @item flushregs
24878 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
24879
24880 @kindex maint print objfiles
24881 @cindex info for known object files
24882 @item maint print objfiles
24883 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
24884 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
24885 and symtabs.
24886
24887 @kindex maint print statistics
24888 @cindex bcache statistics
24889 @item maint print statistics
24890 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
24891 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
24892 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
24893 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
24894 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
24895 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
24896 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
24897 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
24898 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
24899 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
24900 lengths.
24901
24902 @kindex maint print target-stack
24903 @cindex target stack description
24904 @item maint print target-stack
24905 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
24906 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
24907 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
24908 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
24909 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
24910 address.
24911
24912 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
24913 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
24914
24915 @kindex maint print type
24916 @cindex type chain of a data type
24917 @item maint print type @var{expr}
24918 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
24919 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
24920 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
24921 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
24922 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
24923
24924 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
24925 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
24926 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
24927 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
24928 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
24929
24930 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
24931 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
24932 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
24933 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
24934 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
24935 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
24936 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
24937 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
24938 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
24939
24940 @kindex maint set profile
24941 @kindex maint show profile
24942 @cindex profiling GDB
24943 @item maint set profile
24944 @itemx maint show profile
24945 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
24946
24947 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
24948 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
24949 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
24950 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
24951 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
24952 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
24953 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
24954
24955 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
24956 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
24957
24958 @kindex maint set linux-async
24959 @kindex maint show linux-async
24960 @cindex asynchronous support
24961 @item maint set linux-async
24962 @itemx maint show linux-async
24963 Control the GNU/Linux native asynchronous support
24964 (@pxref{Background Execution}) of @value{GDBN}.
24965
24966 GNU/Linux native asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
24967 the @samp{maint set linux-async} command to enable it.
24968
24969 @kindex maint set remote-async
24970 @kindex maint show remote-async
24971 @cindex asynchronous support
24972 @item maint set remote-async
24973 @itemx maint show remote-async
24974 Control the remote asynchronous support
24975 (@pxref{Background Execution}) of @value{GDBN}.
24976
24977 Remote asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
24978 the @samp{maint set remote-async} command to enable it.
24979
24980 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
24981 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
24982 @item maint show-debug-regs
24983 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
24984 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
24985 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
24986 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
24987 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
24988
24989 @kindex maint space
24990 @cindex memory used by commands
24991 @item maint space
24992 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
24993 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
24994 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
24995 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
24996 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
24997
24998 @kindex maint time
24999 @cindex time of command execution
25000 @item maint time
25001 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
25002 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
25003 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
25004 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
25005 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
25006 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
25007 it's not possibly currently
25008 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
25009 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
25010
25011 @kindex maint translate-address
25012 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
25013 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
25014 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
25015 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
25016 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
25017 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
25018 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
25019
25020 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
25021 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
25022 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
25023
25024 @end table
25025
25026 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
25027 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
25028
25029 @table @code
25030 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
25031 @kindex set watchdog
25032 @cindex watchdog timer
25033 @cindex timeout for commands
25034 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
25035 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
25036 reports and error and the command is aborted.
25037
25038 @item show watchdog
25039 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
25040 @end table
25041
25042 @node Remote Protocol
25043 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
25044
25045 @menu
25046 * Overview::
25047 * Packets::
25048 * Stop Reply Packets::
25049 * General Query Packets::
25050 * Register Packet Format::
25051 * Tracepoint Packets::
25052 * Host I/O Packets::
25053 * Interrupts::
25054 * Notification Packets::
25055 * Remote Non-Stop::
25056 * Packet Acknowledgment::
25057 * Examples::
25058 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
25059 * Library List Format::
25060 * Memory Map Format::
25061 @end menu
25062
25063 @node Overview
25064 @section Overview
25065
25066 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
25067 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
25068 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
25069 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
25070
25071 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
25072 transmitted and received data, respectively.
25073
25074 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
25075 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
25076 @cindex remote serial protocol
25077 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
25078 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
25079 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
25080 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
25081 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
25082
25083 @smallexample
25084 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25085 @end smallexample
25086 @noindent
25087
25088 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
25089 @noindent
25090 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
25091 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
25092 eight bit unsigned checksum).
25093
25094 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
25095 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
25096
25097 @smallexample
25098 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25099 @end smallexample
25100
25101 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
25102 @noindent
25103 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
25104 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
25105 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
25106
25107 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
25108 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
25109 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
25110 retransmission):
25111
25112 @smallexample
25113 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25114 <- @code{+}
25115 @end smallexample
25116 @noindent
25117
25118 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
25119 once a connection is established.
25120 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
25121
25122 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
25123 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
25124 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
25125 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
25126 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
25127 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
25128 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
25129
25130 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
25131 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
25132 exceptions).
25133
25134 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
25135 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
25136 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
25137 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
25138
25139 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
25140 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
25141 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
25142
25143 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
25144 @anchor{Binary Data}
25145 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
25146 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
25147 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
25148 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
25149 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
25150 binary data.
25151
25152 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
25153 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
25154 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
25155 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
25156 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
25157 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
25158 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
25159 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
25160 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
25161 (described next).
25162
25163 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
25164 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
25165 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
25166 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
25167 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
25168 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
25169 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
25170 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
25171 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
25172 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
25173 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
25174 3}} more times.
25175
25176 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
25177 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
25178 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
25179 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
25180 @samp{0*"00}.
25181
25182 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
25183 error number. That number is not well defined.
25184
25185 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
25186 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
25187 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
25188 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
25189 on that response.
25190
25191 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
25192 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
25193 optional.
25194
25195 @node Packets
25196 @section Packets
25197
25198 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
25199 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
25200 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
25201 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
25202
25203 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
25204 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
25205 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
25206 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
25207 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
25208 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
25209 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
25210 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
25211 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
25212 @var{baz}.
25213
25214 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
25215 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
25216 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
25217 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
25218 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
25219 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
25220 pick any thread.
25221
25222 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
25223 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
25224 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
25225 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
25226 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
25227 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
25228 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
25229 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
25230 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
25231 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
25232 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
25233 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
25234 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
25235
25236 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
25237 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
25238 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
25239 more information.
25240
25241 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
25242 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
25243
25244 Here are the packet descriptions.
25245
25246 @table @samp
25247
25248 @item !
25249 @cindex @samp{!} packet
25250 @anchor{extended mode}
25251 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
25252 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
25253 debugged.
25254
25255 Reply:
25256 @table @samp
25257 @item OK
25258 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
25259 @end table
25260
25261 @item ?
25262 @cindex @samp{?} packet
25263 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
25264 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
25265 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
25266
25267 Reply:
25268 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25269
25270 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
25271 @cindex @samp{A} packet
25272 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
25273 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
25274 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
25275
25276 Reply:
25277 @table @samp
25278 @item OK
25279 The arguments were set.
25280 @item E @var{NN}
25281 An error occurred.
25282 @end table
25283
25284 @item b @var{baud}
25285 @cindex @samp{b} packet
25286 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
25287 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
25288
25289 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
25290 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
25291 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
25292
25293 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
25294 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
25295 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
25296 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
25297 of view, nothing actually happened.}
25298
25299 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
25300 @cindex @samp{B} packet
25301 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
25302 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
25303
25304 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
25305 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
25306
25307 @item bc
25308 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
25309 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
25310 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
25311
25312 Reply:
25313 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25314
25315 @item bs
25316 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
25317 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
25318 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
25319
25320 Reply:
25321 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25322
25323 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
25324 @cindex @samp{c} packet
25325 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
25326 resume at current address.
25327
25328 Reply:
25329 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25330
25331 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
25332 @cindex @samp{C} packet
25333 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
25334 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
25335
25336 Reply:
25337 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25338
25339 @item d
25340 @cindex @samp{d} packet
25341 Toggle debug flag.
25342
25343 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
25344 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
25345
25346 @item D
25347 @itemx D;@var{pid}
25348 @cindex @samp{D} packet
25349 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
25350 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
25351 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
25352
25353 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
25354 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
25355 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
25356 big-endian hex string.
25357
25358 Reply:
25359 @table @samp
25360 @item OK
25361 for success
25362 @item E @var{NN}
25363 for an error
25364 @end table
25365
25366 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
25367 @cindex @samp{F} packet
25368 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
25369 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
25370 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
25371
25372 @item g
25373 @anchor{read registers packet}
25374 @cindex @samp{g} packet
25375 Read general registers.
25376
25377 Reply:
25378 @table @samp
25379 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
25380 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
25381 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
25382 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
25383 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
25384 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
25385 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
25386 @item E @var{NN}
25387 for an error.
25388 @end table
25389
25390 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
25391 @cindex @samp{G} packet
25392 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
25393 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
25394
25395 Reply:
25396 @table @samp
25397 @item OK
25398 for success
25399 @item E @var{NN}
25400 for an error
25401 @end table
25402
25403 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
25404 @cindex @samp{H} packet
25405 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
25406 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
25407 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
25408 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
25409 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
25410
25411 Reply:
25412 @table @samp
25413 @item OK
25414 for success
25415 @item E @var{NN}
25416 for an error
25417 @end table
25418
25419 @c FIXME: JTC:
25420 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
25421 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
25422 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
25423 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
25424 @c described. For example:
25425 @c
25426 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
25427 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
25428 @c otherwise returns current registers.
25429 @c
25430 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
25431 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
25432 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
25433
25434 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
25435 @anchor{cycle step packet}
25436 @cindex @samp{i} packet
25437 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
25438 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
25439 step starting at that address.
25440
25441 @item I
25442 @cindex @samp{I} packet
25443 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
25444 step packet}.
25445
25446 @item k
25447 @cindex @samp{k} packet
25448 Kill request.
25449
25450 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
25451 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
25452 thread?)}.
25453
25454 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
25455 @cindex @samp{m} packet
25456 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
25457 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
25458
25459 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
25460 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
25461 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
25462 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
25463 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
25464 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
25465 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
25466 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
25467
25468 Reply:
25469 @table @samp
25470 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
25471 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
25472 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
25473 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
25474 @item E @var{NN}
25475 @var{NN} is errno
25476 @end table
25477
25478 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
25479 @cindex @samp{M} packet
25480 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
25481 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
25482 hexadecimal number.
25483
25484 Reply:
25485 @table @samp
25486 @item OK
25487 for success
25488 @item E @var{NN}
25489 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
25490 written).
25491 @end table
25492
25493 @item p @var{n}
25494 @cindex @samp{p} packet
25495 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
25496 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
25497 register value is encoded.
25498
25499 Reply:
25500 @table @samp
25501 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
25502 the register's value
25503 @item E @var{NN}
25504 for an error
25505 @item
25506 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
25507 @end table
25508
25509 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
25510 @anchor{write register packet}
25511 @cindex @samp{P} packet
25512 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
25513 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
25514 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
25515
25516 Reply:
25517 @table @samp
25518 @item OK
25519 for success
25520 @item E @var{NN}
25521 for an error
25522 @end table
25523
25524 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
25525 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
25526 @cindex @samp{q} packet
25527 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
25528 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
25529 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
25530
25531 @item r
25532 @cindex @samp{r} packet
25533 Reset the entire system.
25534
25535 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
25536
25537 @item R @var{XX}
25538 @cindex @samp{R} packet
25539 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
25540 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
25541
25542 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
25543
25544 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
25545 @cindex @samp{s} packet
25546 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
25547 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
25548
25549 Reply:
25550 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25551
25552 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
25553 @anchor{step with signal packet}
25554 @cindex @samp{S} packet
25555 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
25556 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
25557
25558 Reply:
25559 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25560
25561 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
25562 @cindex @samp{t} packet
25563 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
25564 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
25565 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
25566
25567 @item T @var{thread-id}
25568 @cindex @samp{T} packet
25569 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
25570
25571 Reply:
25572 @table @samp
25573 @item OK
25574 thread is still alive
25575 @item E @var{NN}
25576 thread is dead
25577 @end table
25578
25579 @item v
25580 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
25581 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
25582
25583 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
25584 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
25585 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
25586 The process ID is a
25587 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
25588 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
25589 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
25590
25591 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
25592 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
25593 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
25594 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
25595 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
25596 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
25597 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
25598 @c stopping or restarting threads.
25599
25600 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
25601
25602 Reply:
25603 @table @samp
25604 @item E @var{nn}
25605 for an error
25606 @item @r{Any stop packet}
25607 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
25608 @item OK
25609 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
25610 @end table
25611
25612 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
25613 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
25614 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
25615 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
25616 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
25617 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
25618 in their current state in non-stop mode.
25619 Specifying multiple
25620 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
25621 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
25622
25623 Currently supported actions are:
25624
25625 @table @samp
25626 @item c
25627 Continue.
25628 @item C @var{sig}
25629 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
25630 @item s
25631 Step.
25632 @item S @var{sig}
25633 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
25634 @item t
25635 Stop.
25636 @item T @var{sig}
25637 Stop with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
25638 @end table
25639
25640 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
25641 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
25642 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
25643
25644 The @samp{t} and @samp{T} actions are only relevant in non-stop mode
25645 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
25646 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
25647 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
25648 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
25649 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
25650 as an implementation detail.
25651
25652 Reply:
25653 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25654
25655 @item vCont?
25656 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
25657 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
25658
25659 Reply:
25660 @table @samp
25661 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
25662 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
25663 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
25664 @item
25665 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
25666 @end table
25667
25668 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
25669 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
25670 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
25671 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
25672
25673 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
25674 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
25675 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
25676 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
25677 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
25678 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
25679 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
25680 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
25681 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
25682 packet is received.
25683
25684 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
25685 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
25686 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
25687 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
25688 @var{thread-id}.
25689
25690 Reply:
25691 @table @samp
25692 @item OK
25693 for success
25694 @item E @var{NN}
25695 for an error
25696 @end table
25697
25698 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
25699 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
25700 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
25701 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
25702 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
25703 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
25704 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
25705 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
25706 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
25707 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
25708 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
25709 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
25710
25711
25712 Reply:
25713 @table @samp
25714 @item OK
25715 for success
25716 @item E.memtype
25717 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
25718 @item E @var{NN}
25719 for an error
25720 @end table
25721
25722 @item vFlashDone
25723 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
25724 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
25725 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
25726 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
25727 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
25728 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
25729 request is completed.
25730
25731 @item vKill;@var{pid}
25732 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
25733 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
25734 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
25735 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
25736 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
25737
25738 Reply:
25739 @table @samp
25740 @item E @var{nn}
25741 for an error
25742 @item OK
25743 for success
25744 @end table
25745
25746 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
25747 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
25748 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
25749 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
25750 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
25751 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
25752 state.
25753
25754 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
25755
25756 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
25757
25758 Reply:
25759 @table @samp
25760 @item E @var{nn}
25761 for an error
25762 @item @r{Any stop packet}
25763 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
25764 @end table
25765
25766 @item vStopped
25767 @anchor{vStopped packet}
25768 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
25769
25770 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
25771 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
25772
25773 Reply:
25774 @table @samp
25775 @item @r{Any stop packet}
25776 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
25777 @item OK
25778 if there are no unreported stop events
25779 @end table
25780
25781 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
25782 @anchor{X packet}
25783 @cindex @samp{X} packet
25784 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
25785 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
25786 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
25787
25788 Reply:
25789 @table @samp
25790 @item OK
25791 for success
25792 @item E @var{NN}
25793 for an error
25794 @end table
25795
25796 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
25797 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
25798 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
25799 @cindex @samp{z} packet
25800 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
25801 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
25802 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
25803 @var{length} bytes.
25804
25805 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
25806 separately.
25807
25808 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
25809 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
25810 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
25811 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
25812 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
25813 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
25814
25815 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
25816 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
25817 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
25818 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
25819 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
25820 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
25821
25822 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
25823 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
25824 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
25825 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
25826 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
25827
25828 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
25829 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
25830 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
25831 target, is not defined.}
25832
25833 Reply:
25834 @table @samp
25835 @item OK
25836 success
25837 @item
25838 not supported
25839 @item E @var{NN}
25840 for an error
25841 @end table
25842
25843 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
25844 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
25845 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
25846 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
25847 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
25848 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
25849
25850 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
25851 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
25852
25853 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
25854 movement.}
25855
25856 Reply:
25857 @table @samp
25858 @item OK
25859 success
25860 @item
25861 not supported
25862 @item E @var{NN}
25863 for an error
25864 @end table
25865
25866 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
25867 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
25868 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
25869 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
25870 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
25871
25872 Reply:
25873 @table @samp
25874 @item OK
25875 success
25876 @item
25877 not supported
25878 @item E @var{NN}
25879 for an error
25880 @end table
25881
25882 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
25883 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
25884 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
25885 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
25886 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
25887
25888 Reply:
25889 @table @samp
25890 @item OK
25891 success
25892 @item
25893 not supported
25894 @item E @var{NN}
25895 for an error
25896 @end table
25897
25898 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
25899 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
25900 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
25901 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
25902 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
25903
25904 Reply:
25905 @table @samp
25906 @item OK
25907 success
25908 @item
25909 not supported
25910 @item E @var{NN}
25911 for an error
25912 @end table
25913
25914 @end table
25915
25916 @node Stop Reply Packets
25917 @section Stop Reply Packets
25918 @cindex stop reply packets
25919
25920 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
25921 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
25922 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
25923 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
25924 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
25925 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
25926 @value{GDBN} source code.
25927
25928 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
25929 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
25930 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
25931 components.
25932
25933 @table @samp
25934
25935 @item S @var{AA}
25936 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
25937 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
25938 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
25939
25940 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
25941 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
25942 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
25943 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
25944 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
25945 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
25946 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
25947 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
25948
25949 @itemize @bullet
25950 @item
25951 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
25952 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
25953 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
25954 two-digit hex number.
25955
25956 @item
25957 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
25958 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
25959
25960 @item
25961 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
25962 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
25963 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
25964 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
25965
25966 @item
25967 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
25968 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
25969 future.
25970 @end itemize
25971
25972 The currently defined stop reasons are:
25973
25974 @table @samp
25975 @item watch
25976 @itemx rwatch
25977 @itemx awatch
25978 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
25979 hex.
25980
25981 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
25982 @item library
25983 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
25984 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
25985 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
25986
25987 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
25988 @item replaylog
25989 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
25990 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
25991 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
25992 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
25993 for more information.
25994
25995
25996 @end table
25997
25998 @item W @var{AA}
25999 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
26000 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
26001 applicable to certain targets.
26002
26003 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
26004 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
26005 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
26006 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
26007
26008 @item X @var{AA}
26009 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
26010 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
26011
26012 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
26013 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
26014 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
26015 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
26016
26017 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
26018 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
26019 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
26020 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
26021 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
26022
26023 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
26024 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
26025 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
26026 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
26027 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
26028 system calls.
26029
26030 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
26031 this very system call.
26032
26033 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
26034 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
26035 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
26036 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
26037 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
26038 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
26039
26040 @end table
26041
26042 @node General Query Packets
26043 @section General Query Packets
26044 @cindex remote query requests
26045
26046 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
26047 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
26048 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
26049 sending information to and from the stub.
26050
26051 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
26052 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
26053 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
26054 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
26055 conventions:
26056
26057 @itemize @bullet
26058 @item
26059 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
26060 @item
26061 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
26062 letter.
26063 @item
26064 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
26065 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
26066 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
26067 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
26068 @end itemize
26069
26070 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
26071 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
26072 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
26073 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
26074 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
26075 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
26076 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
26077 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
26078 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
26079 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
26080 packet.}.
26081
26082 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
26083 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
26084 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
26085 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
26086 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
26087
26088 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
26089
26090 @table @samp
26091
26092 @item qC
26093 @cindex current thread, remote request
26094 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
26095 Return the current thread ID.
26096
26097 Reply:
26098 @table @samp
26099 @item QC @var{thread-id}
26100 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
26101 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26102 @item @r{(anything else)}
26103 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
26104 @end table
26105
26106 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
26107 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
26108 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
26109 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
26110 Reply:
26111 @table @samp
26112 @item E @var{NN}
26113 An error (such as memory fault)
26114 @item C @var{crc32}
26115 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
26116 @end table
26117
26118 @item qfThreadInfo
26119 @itemx qsThreadInfo
26120 @cindex list active threads, remote request
26121 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
26122 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
26123 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
26124 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
26125 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
26126 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
26127 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
26128 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
26129
26130 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
26131
26132 Reply:
26133 @table @samp
26134 @item m @var{thread-id}
26135 A single thread ID
26136 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
26137 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
26138 @item l
26139 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
26140 @end table
26141
26142 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
26143 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
26144 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
26145 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
26146 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
26147 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
26148 fields.
26149
26150 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
26151 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
26152 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
26153 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
26154 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
26155
26156 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
26157 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
26158
26159 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
26160 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
26161 information associated with the variable.)
26162
26163 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
26164 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
26165 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
26166 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
26167 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
26168 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
26169
26170 Reply:
26171 @table @samp
26172 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
26173 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
26174 local storage requested.
26175
26176 @item E @var{nn}
26177 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
26178
26179 @item
26180 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
26181 @end table
26182
26183 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
26184 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
26185 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
26186 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
26187 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
26188 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
26189 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
26190
26191 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
26192
26193 Reply:
26194 @table @samp
26195 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
26196 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
26197 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
26198 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
26199 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
26200 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
26201 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
26202 @end table
26203
26204 @item qOffsets
26205 @cindex section offsets, remote request
26206 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
26207 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
26208 image.
26209
26210 Reply:
26211 @table @samp
26212 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
26213 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
26214 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
26215 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
26216 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
26217 segments by the supplied offsets.
26218
26219 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
26220 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
26221 to the @code{Bss} section.}
26222
26223 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
26224 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
26225 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
26226 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
26227 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
26228 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
26229 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
26230 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
26231 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
26232 @end table
26233
26234 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
26235 @cindex thread information, remote request
26236 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
26237 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
26238 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
26239 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
26240
26241 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
26242 (see below).
26243
26244 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
26245
26246 @item QNonStop:1
26247 @item QNonStop:0
26248 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
26249 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
26250 @anchor{QNonStop}
26251 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
26252 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
26253
26254 Reply:
26255 @table @samp
26256 @item OK
26257 The request succeeded.
26258
26259 @item E @var{nn}
26260 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
26261
26262 @item
26263 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
26264 the stub.
26265 @end table
26266
26267 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26268 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26269 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
26270 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
26271
26272 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
26273 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
26274 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
26275 @anchor{QPassSignals}
26276 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
26277 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
26278 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
26279 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
26280 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
26281 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
26282 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
26283 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
26284 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
26285
26286 Reply:
26287 @table @samp
26288 @item OK
26289 The request succeeded.
26290
26291 @item E @var{nn}
26292 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
26293
26294 @item
26295 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
26296 the stub.
26297 @end table
26298
26299 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
26300 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
26301 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26302 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26303
26304 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
26305 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
26306 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
26307 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
26308 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
26309 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
26310 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
26311 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
26312 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
26313
26314 Reply:
26315 @table @samp
26316 @item OK
26317 A command response with no output.
26318 @item @var{OUTPUT}
26319 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
26320 @item E @var{NN}
26321 Indicate a badly formed request.
26322 @item
26323 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
26324 @end table
26325
26326 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
26327 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
26328 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
26329 packets.)
26330
26331 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
26332 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
26333 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
26334 @anchor{qSearch memory}
26335 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
26336 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
26337 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
26338
26339 Reply:
26340 @table @samp
26341 @item 0
26342 The pattern was not found.
26343 @item 1,address
26344 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
26345 @item E @var{NN}
26346 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
26347 @item
26348 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
26349 @end table
26350
26351 @item QStartNoAckMode
26352 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
26353 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
26354 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
26355 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
26356
26357 Reply:
26358 @table @samp
26359 @item OK
26360 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
26361 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
26362 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
26363 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
26364 @item
26365 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
26366 @end table
26367
26368 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
26369 @cindex supported packets, remote query
26370 @cindex features of the remote protocol
26371 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
26372 @anchor{qSupported}
26373 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
26374 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
26375 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
26376 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
26377 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
26378 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
26379 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
26380 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
26381 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
26382 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
26383 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
26384 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
26385 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
26386 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
26387
26388 Reply:
26389 @table @samp
26390 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
26391 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
26392 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
26393 possible forms).
26394 @item
26395 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
26396 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
26397 @end table
26398
26399 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
26400 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
26401 are:
26402
26403 @table @samp
26404 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
26405 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
26406 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
26407 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
26408 @item @var{name}+
26409 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
26410 need an associated value.
26411 @item @var{name}-
26412 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
26413 @item @var{name}?
26414 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
26415 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
26416 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
26417 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
26418 @end table
26419
26420 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
26421 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
26422 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
26423 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
26424 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
26425
26426 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
26427 are defined:
26428
26429 @table @samp
26430 @item multiprocess
26431 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
26432 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
26433 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
26434 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
26435 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
26436 @end table
26437
26438 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
26439 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
26440 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
26441 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
26442 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
26443 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
26444 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
26445 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
26446 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
26447 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
26448 all the features it supports.
26449
26450 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
26451 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
26452
26453 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
26454 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
26455 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
26456 form response.
26457
26458 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
26459 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
26460 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
26461 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
26462
26463 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
26464 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
26465 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
26466 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
26467 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
26468
26469 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
26470
26471 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
26472 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
26473 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
26474 @item Feature Name
26475 @tab Value Required
26476 @tab Default
26477 @tab Probe Allowed
26478
26479 @item @samp{PacketSize}
26480 @tab Yes
26481 @tab @samp{-}
26482 @tab No
26483
26484 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
26485 @tab No
26486 @tab @samp{-}
26487 @tab Yes
26488
26489 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
26490 @tab No
26491 @tab @samp{-}
26492 @tab Yes
26493
26494 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26495 @tab No
26496 @tab @samp{-}
26497 @tab Yes
26498
26499 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26500 @tab No
26501 @tab @samp{-}
26502 @tab Yes
26503
26504 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
26505 @tab No
26506 @tab @samp{-}
26507 @tab Yes
26508
26509 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
26510 @tab No
26511 @tab @samp{-}
26512 @tab Yes
26513
26514 @item @samp{QNonStop}
26515 @tab No
26516 @tab @samp{-}
26517 @tab Yes
26518
26519 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
26520 @tab No
26521 @tab @samp{-}
26522 @tab Yes
26523
26524 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
26525 @tab No
26526 @tab @samp{-}
26527 @tab Yes
26528
26529 @item @samp{multiprocess}
26530 @tab No
26531 @tab @samp{-}
26532 @tab No
26533
26534 @end multitable
26535
26536 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
26537
26538 @table @samp
26539 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
26540 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
26541 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
26542 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
26543 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
26544 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
26545 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
26546 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
26547 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
26548 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
26549
26550 @item qXfer:auxv:read
26551 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
26552 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
26553
26554 @item qXfer:features:read
26555 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
26556 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
26557
26558 @item qXfer:libraries:read
26559 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
26560 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
26561
26562 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
26563 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
26564 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
26565
26566 @item qXfer:spu:read
26567 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
26568 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
26569
26570 @item qXfer:spu:write
26571 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
26572 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
26573
26574 @item QNonStop
26575 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
26576 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
26577
26578 @item QPassSignals
26579 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
26580 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
26581
26582 @item QStartNoAckMode
26583 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
26584 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
26585
26586 @item multiprocess
26587 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
26588 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
26589 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
26590 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
26591 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
26592 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
26593 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
26594 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
26595 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
26596 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
26597 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
26598
26599 @item qXfer:osdata:read
26600 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
26601 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
26602
26603 @end table
26604
26605 @item qSymbol::
26606 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
26607 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
26608 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
26609 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
26610
26611 Reply:
26612 @table @samp
26613 @item OK
26614 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
26615 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
26616 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
26617 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
26618 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
26619 below.
26620 @end table
26621
26622 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
26623 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
26624
26625 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
26626 target has previously requested.
26627
26628 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
26629 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
26630 will be empty.
26631
26632 Reply:
26633 @table @samp
26634 @item OK
26635 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
26636 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
26637 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
26638 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
26639 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
26640 @end table
26641
26642 @item QTDP
26643 @itemx QTFrame
26644 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
26645
26646 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
26647 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
26648 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
26649 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
26650 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
26651 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
26652 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
26653 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
26654 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
26655 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
26656 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
26657
26658 Reply:
26659 @table @samp
26660 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
26661 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
26662 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
26663 the thread's attributes.
26664 @end table
26665
26666 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
26667 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
26668 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
26669 packets.)
26670
26671 @item QTStart
26672 @itemx QTStop
26673 @itemx QTinit
26674 @itemx QTro
26675 @itemx qTStatus
26676 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
26677
26678 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
26679 @cindex read special object, remote request
26680 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
26681 @anchor{qXfer read}
26682 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
26683 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
26684 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
26685 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
26686 additional details about what data to access.
26687
26688 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
26689 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
26690 formats, listed below.
26691
26692 @table @samp
26693 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
26694 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
26695 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
26696 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
26697
26698 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26699 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26700
26701 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
26702 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
26703 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
26704 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
26705 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
26706
26707 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26708 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26709
26710 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
26711 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
26712 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
26713 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
26714 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
26715
26716 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
26717 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
26718 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
26719
26720 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26721 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26722
26723 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
26724 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
26725 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
26726 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
26727 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
26728
26729 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26730 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26731
26732 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
26733 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
26734 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
26735 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
26736 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
26737 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
26738 in that context to be accessed.
26739
26740 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26741 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
26742 (@pxref{qSupported}).
26743
26744 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
26745 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
26746 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
26747 @xref{Operating System Information}.
26748
26749 @end table
26750
26751 Reply:
26752 @table @samp
26753 @item m @var{data}
26754 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
26755 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
26756 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
26757 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
26758 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
26759 request.
26760
26761 @item l @var{data}
26762 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
26763 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
26764 than the @var{length} in the request.
26765
26766 @item l
26767 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
26768 There is no more data to be read.
26769
26770 @item E00
26771 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
26772
26773 @item E @var{nn}
26774 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
26775 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
26776
26777 @item
26778 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
26779 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
26780 @end table
26781
26782 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
26783 @cindex write data into object, remote request
26784 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
26785 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
26786 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
26787 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
26788 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
26789 to access.
26790
26791 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
26792 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
26793 formats, listed below.
26794
26795 @table @samp
26796 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
26797 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
26798 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
26799 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
26800 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
26801 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
26802 in that context to be accessed.
26803
26804 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26805 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26806 @end table
26807
26808 Reply:
26809 @table @samp
26810 @item @var{nn}
26811 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
26812 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
26813
26814 @item E00
26815 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
26816
26817 @item E @var{nn}
26818 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
26819 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
26820
26821 @item
26822 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
26823 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
26824 @end table
26825
26826 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
26827 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
26828 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
26829 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
26830 must respond with an empty packet.
26831
26832 @end table
26833
26834 @node Register Packet Format
26835 @section Register Packet Format
26836
26837 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
26838 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
26839 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
26840 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
26841 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
26842 most-significant - least-significant.
26843
26844 @table @r
26845
26846 @item MIPS32
26847
26848 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
26849 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
26850 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
26851
26852 @item MIPS64
26853
26854 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
26855 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
26856 as @code{MIPS32}.
26857
26858 @end table
26859
26860 @node Tracepoint Packets
26861 @section Tracepoint Packets
26862 @cindex tracepoint packets
26863 @cindex packets, tracepoint
26864
26865 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
26866 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
26867
26868 @table @samp
26869
26870 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
26871 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
26872 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
26873 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
26874 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
26875 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
26876 tracepoint's actions.
26877
26878 Replies:
26879 @table @samp
26880 @item OK
26881 The packet was understood and carried out.
26882 @item
26883 The packet was not recognized.
26884 @end table
26885
26886 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
26887 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
26888 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
26889 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
26890 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
26891 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
26892 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
26893
26894 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
26895 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
26896 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
26897 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
26898 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
26899 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
26900 tracepoint actions.
26901
26902 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
26903 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
26904 following forms:
26905
26906 @table @samp
26907
26908 @item R @var{mask}
26909 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
26910 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
26911 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
26912 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
26913 not fit in a 32-bit word.
26914
26915 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
26916 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
26917 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
26918 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
26919 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
26920 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
26921 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
26922
26923 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
26924 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
26925 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
26926 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
26927 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
26928 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
26929 packet).
26930
26931 @end table
26932
26933 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
26934 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
26935 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
26936 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
26937 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
26938 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
26939 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
26940 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
26941
26942 Replies:
26943 @table @samp
26944 @item OK
26945 The packet was understood and carried out.
26946 @item
26947 The packet was not recognized.
26948 @end table
26949
26950 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
26951 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
26952 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
26953 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
26954
26955 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
26956 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
26957 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
26958 one of the following forms:
26959
26960 @table @samp
26961 @item F @var{f}
26962 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
26963 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
26964 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
26965
26966 @item T @var{t}
26967 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
26968 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
26969
26970 @end table
26971
26972 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
26973 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
26974 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
26975 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
26976
26977 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
26978 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
26979 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
26980 is a hexadecimal number.
26981
26982 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
26983 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
26984 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
26985 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
26986 numbers.
26987
26988 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
26989 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
26990 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
26991
26992 @item QTStart
26993 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
26994 hits in the trace frame buffer.
26995
26996 @item QTStop
26997 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
26998
26999 @item QTinit
27000 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
27001
27002 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
27003 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
27004 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
27005 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
27006
27007 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
27008 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
27009 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
27010 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
27011
27012 @item qTStatus
27013 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
27014
27015 Replies:
27016 @table @samp
27017 @item T0
27018 There is no trace experiment running.
27019 @item T1
27020 There is a trace experiment running.
27021 @end table
27022
27023 @end table
27024
27025
27026 @node Host I/O Packets
27027 @section Host I/O Packets
27028 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
27029 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
27030
27031 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
27032 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
27033 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
27034 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
27035 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
27036 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
27037 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
27038 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
27039 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
27040 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
27041
27042 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
27043 its arguments. They have this format:
27044
27045 @table @samp
27046
27047 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
27048 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
27049 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
27050 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
27051 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
27052 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
27053 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
27054 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
27055 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
27056
27057 @end table
27058
27059 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
27060
27061 @table @samp
27062
27063 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
27064 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
27065 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
27066 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
27067 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
27068 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
27069 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
27070 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
27071 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
27072 @var{attachment}.
27073
27074 @item
27075 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
27076
27077 @end table
27078
27079 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
27080
27081 @table @samp
27082 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
27083 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
27084 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
27085 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
27086 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
27087 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
27088 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
27089
27090 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
27091 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
27092 -1 if an error occurs.
27093
27094 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
27095 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
27096 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
27097 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
27098 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
27099 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
27100 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
27101 @var{count} was zero.
27102
27103 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
27104 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
27105 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
27106 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
27107 some characters were escaped.
27108
27109 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
27110 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
27111 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
27112 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
27113 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
27114 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
27115 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
27116 error occurred.
27117
27118 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
27119 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
27120 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
27121
27122 @end table
27123
27124 @node Interrupts
27125 @section Interrupts
27126 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
27127
27128 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
27129 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
27130 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
27131 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
27132
27133 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
27134 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
27135 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
27136 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
27137 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
27138
27139 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
27140 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
27141 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
27142 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
27143 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
27144 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
27145 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
27146 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
27147
27148 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
27149 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
27150 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
27151 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
27152 currently-executing threads and processes.
27153 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
27154 running program, it should send one of the stop
27155 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
27156 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
27157 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
27158 Interrupts received while the
27159 program is stopped are discarded.
27160
27161 @node Notification Packets
27162 @section Notification Packets
27163 @cindex notification packets
27164 @cindex packets, notification
27165
27166 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
27167 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
27168 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
27169 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
27170 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
27171 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
27172 is not a problem.
27173
27174 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
27175 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
27176 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
27177 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
27178 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
27179 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
27180 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
27181
27182 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
27183 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
27184
27185 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
27186 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
27187 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
27188 not they understand it.
27189
27190 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
27191 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
27192 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
27193 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
27194 recipients.
27195
27196 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
27197 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
27198 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
27199 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
27200 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
27201
27202 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
27203 defined:
27204
27205 @table @samp
27206 @item Stop: @var{reply}
27207 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
27208 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
27209 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
27210 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
27211 @value{GDBN}.
27212 @end table
27213
27214 @node Remote Non-Stop
27215 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
27216
27217 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
27218 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
27219 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
27220 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27221
27222 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
27223 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
27224 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
27225 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
27226 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
27227 probe the target state after a mode change.
27228
27229 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
27230 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
27231 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
27232 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
27233 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
27234 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
27235 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
27236 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
27237 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
27238 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
27239 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
27240
27241 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
27242 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
27243 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
27244 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
27245 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
27246 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
27247 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
27248 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
27249 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
27250 sending any queued stop events.
27251
27252 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
27253 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
27254 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
27255 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
27256 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
27257 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
27258 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
27259
27260 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
27261 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
27262 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
27263 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
27264 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
27265 process normally.
27266
27267 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
27268 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
27269 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
27270 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
27271 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
27272 should process normally.
27273
27274 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
27275 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
27276 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
27277 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
27278 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
27279
27280 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
27281 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
27282 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
27283 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
27284 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
27285 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
27286 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
27287 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
27288 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
27289 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
27290 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
27291 @samp{OK}.
27292
27293 @node Packet Acknowledgment
27294 @section Packet Acknowledgment
27295
27296 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
27297 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
27298 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
27299 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
27300 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
27301 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
27302 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
27303
27304 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
27305 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
27306 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
27307 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
27308 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
27309
27310 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
27311 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
27312 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
27313 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
27314
27315 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
27316 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
27317 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
27318 @pxref{qSupported}.
27319 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
27320 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
27321 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
27322 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
27323 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
27324 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
27325 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
27326
27327 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
27328 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
27329 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
27330 connection.
27331 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
27332 new connection is established,
27333 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
27334 for the current connection, once disabled.
27335
27336 @node Examples
27337 @section Examples
27338
27339 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
27340 does not get any direct output:
27341
27342 @smallexample
27343 -> @code{R00}
27344 <- @code{+}
27345 @emph{target restarts}
27346 -> @code{?}
27347 <- @code{+}
27348 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
27349 -> @code{+}
27350 @end smallexample
27351
27352 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
27353
27354 @smallexample
27355 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
27356 <- @code{+}
27357 -> @code{s}
27358 <- @code{+}
27359 @emph{time passes}
27360 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
27361 -> @code{+}
27362 -> @code{g}
27363 <- @code{+}
27364 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
27365 -> @code{+}
27366 @end smallexample
27367
27368 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
27369 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
27370 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
27371
27372 @menu
27373 * File-I/O Overview::
27374 * Protocol Basics::
27375 * The F Request Packet::
27376 * The F Reply Packet::
27377 * The Ctrl-C Message::
27378 * Console I/O::
27379 * List of Supported Calls::
27380 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
27381 * Constants::
27382 * File-I/O Examples::
27383 @end menu
27384
27385 @node File-I/O Overview
27386 @subsection File-I/O Overview
27387 @cindex file-i/o overview
27388
27389 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
27390 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
27391 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
27392 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
27393 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
27394 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
27395
27396 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
27397 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
27398 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
27399 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
27400 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
27401
27402 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
27403 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
27404 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
27405 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
27406 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
27407 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
27408 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
27409
27410 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
27411 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
27412 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
27413 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
27414 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
27415
27416 @smallexample
27417 (@value{GDBP}) continue
27418 <- target requests 'system call X'
27419 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
27420 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
27421 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
27422 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
27423 @end smallexample
27424
27425 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
27426 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
27427 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
27428 system are not supported by this protocol.
27429
27430 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
27431
27432 @node Protocol Basics
27433 @subsection Protocol Basics
27434 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
27435
27436 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
27437 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
27438 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
27439 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
27440 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
27441 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
27442 to call the appropriate host system call:
27443
27444 @itemize @bullet
27445 @item
27446 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
27447
27448 @item
27449 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
27450 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
27451 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
27452 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
27453
27454 @end itemize
27455
27456 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
27457
27458 @itemize @bullet
27459 @item
27460 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
27461 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
27462 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
27463 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
27464 packet.
27465
27466 @item
27467 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
27468 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
27469
27470 @item
27471 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
27472
27473 @item
27474 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
27475
27476 @item
27477 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
27478 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
27479 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
27480 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
27481 packet.
27482
27483 @end itemize
27484
27485 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
27486 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
27487
27488 @itemize @bullet
27489 @item
27490 Return value.
27491
27492 @item
27493 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
27494
27495 @item
27496 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
27497
27498 @end itemize
27499
27500 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
27501 the latest continue or step action.
27502
27503 @node The F Request Packet
27504 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
27505 @cindex file-i/o request packet
27506 @cindex @code{F} request packet
27507
27508 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
27509
27510 @table @samp
27511 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
27512
27513 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
27514 This is just the name of the function.
27515
27516 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
27517 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
27518 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
27519 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
27520 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
27521 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
27522 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
27523
27524 @end table
27525
27526
27527
27528 @node The F Reply Packet
27529 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
27530 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
27531 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
27532
27533 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
27534
27535 @table @samp
27536
27537 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
27538
27539 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
27540
27541 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
27542 representation.
27543 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
27544
27545 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
27546 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
27547 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
27548
27549 @smallexample
27550 F0,0,C
27551 @end smallexample
27552
27553 @noindent
27554 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
27555
27556 @smallexample
27557 F-1,4,C
27558 @end smallexample
27559
27560 @noindent
27561 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
27562
27563 @end table
27564
27565
27566 @node The Ctrl-C Message
27567 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
27568 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
27569
27570 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
27571 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
27572 the target should behave as if it had
27573 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
27574 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
27575 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
27576 packet.
27577
27578 It's important for the target to know in which
27579 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
27580
27581 @itemize @bullet
27582 @item
27583 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
27584
27585 @item
27586 The system call on the host has been finished.
27587
27588 @end itemize
27589
27590 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
27591 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
27592 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
27593 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
27594 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
27595 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
27596
27597 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
27598 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
27599 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
27600 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
27601 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
27602 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
27603 or the full action has been completed.
27604
27605 @node Console I/O
27606 @subsection Console I/O
27607 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
27608
27609 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
27610 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
27611 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
27612 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
27613 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
27614 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
27615 conditions is met:
27616
27617 @itemize @bullet
27618 @item
27619 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
27620 @code{read}
27621 system call is treated as finished.
27622
27623 @item
27624 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
27625 newline.
27626
27627 @item
27628 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
27629 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
27630
27631 @end itemize
27632
27633 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
27634 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
27635 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
27636 is stopped at the user's request.
27637
27638
27639 @node List of Supported Calls
27640 @subsection List of Supported Calls
27641 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
27642
27643 @menu
27644 * open::
27645 * close::
27646 * read::
27647 * write::
27648 * lseek::
27649 * rename::
27650 * unlink::
27651 * stat/fstat::
27652 * gettimeofday::
27653 * isatty::
27654 * system::
27655 @end menu
27656
27657 @node open
27658 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
27659 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
27660
27661 @table @asis
27662 @item Synopsis:
27663 @smallexample
27664 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
27665 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
27666 @end smallexample
27667
27668 @item Request:
27669 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
27670
27671 @noindent
27672 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
27673
27674 @table @code
27675 @item O_CREAT
27676 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
27677 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
27678 are concerned.
27679
27680 @item O_EXCL
27681 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
27682 an error and open() fails.
27683
27684 @item O_TRUNC
27685 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
27686 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
27687 truncated to zero length.
27688
27689 @item O_APPEND
27690 The file is opened in append mode.
27691
27692 @item O_RDONLY
27693 The file is opened for reading only.
27694
27695 @item O_WRONLY
27696 The file is opened for writing only.
27697
27698 @item O_RDWR
27699 The file is opened for reading and writing.
27700 @end table
27701
27702 @noindent
27703 Other bits are silently ignored.
27704
27705
27706 @noindent
27707 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
27708
27709 @table @code
27710 @item S_IRUSR
27711 User has read permission.
27712
27713 @item S_IWUSR
27714 User has write permission.
27715
27716 @item S_IRGRP
27717 Group has read permission.
27718
27719 @item S_IWGRP
27720 Group has write permission.
27721
27722 @item S_IROTH
27723 Others have read permission.
27724
27725 @item S_IWOTH
27726 Others have write permission.
27727 @end table
27728
27729 @noindent
27730 Other bits are silently ignored.
27731
27732
27733 @item Return value:
27734 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
27735 occurred.
27736
27737 @item Errors:
27738
27739 @table @code
27740 @item EEXIST
27741 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
27742
27743 @item EISDIR
27744 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
27745
27746 @item EACCES
27747 The requested access is not allowed.
27748
27749 @item ENAMETOOLONG
27750 @var{pathname} was too long.
27751
27752 @item ENOENT
27753 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
27754
27755 @item ENODEV
27756 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
27757
27758 @item EROFS
27759 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
27760 write access was requested.
27761
27762 @item EFAULT
27763 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
27764
27765 @item ENOSPC
27766 No space on device to create the file.
27767
27768 @item EMFILE
27769 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
27770
27771 @item ENFILE
27772 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
27773 has been reached.
27774
27775 @item EINTR
27776 The call was interrupted by the user.
27777 @end table
27778
27779 @end table
27780
27781 @node close
27782 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
27783 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
27784
27785 @table @asis
27786 @item Synopsis:
27787 @smallexample
27788 int close(int fd);
27789 @end smallexample
27790
27791 @item Request:
27792 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
27793
27794 @item Return value:
27795 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
27796
27797 @item Errors:
27798
27799 @table @code
27800 @item EBADF
27801 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
27802
27803 @item EINTR
27804 The call was interrupted by the user.
27805 @end table
27806
27807 @end table
27808
27809 @node read
27810 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
27811 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
27812
27813 @table @asis
27814 @item Synopsis:
27815 @smallexample
27816 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
27817 @end smallexample
27818
27819 @item Request:
27820 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
27821
27822 @item Return value:
27823 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
27824 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
27825 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
27826
27827 @item Errors:
27828
27829 @table @code
27830 @item EBADF
27831 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
27832 reading.
27833
27834 @item EFAULT
27835 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
27836
27837 @item EINTR
27838 The call was interrupted by the user.
27839 @end table
27840
27841 @end table
27842
27843 @node write
27844 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
27845 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
27846
27847 @table @asis
27848 @item Synopsis:
27849 @smallexample
27850 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
27851 @end smallexample
27852
27853 @item Request:
27854 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
27855
27856 @item Return value:
27857 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
27858 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
27859 is returned.
27860
27861 @item Errors:
27862
27863 @table @code
27864 @item EBADF
27865 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
27866 writing.
27867
27868 @item EFAULT
27869 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
27870
27871 @item EFBIG
27872 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
27873 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
27874
27875 @item ENOSPC
27876 No space on device to write the data.
27877
27878 @item EINTR
27879 The call was interrupted by the user.
27880 @end table
27881
27882 @end table
27883
27884 @node lseek
27885 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
27886 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
27887
27888 @table @asis
27889 @item Synopsis:
27890 @smallexample
27891 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
27892 @end smallexample
27893
27894 @item Request:
27895 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
27896
27897 @var{flag} is one of:
27898
27899 @table @code
27900 @item SEEK_SET
27901 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
27902
27903 @item SEEK_CUR
27904 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
27905 bytes.
27906
27907 @item SEEK_END
27908 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
27909 bytes.
27910 @end table
27911
27912 @item Return value:
27913 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
27914 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
27915 value of -1 is returned.
27916
27917 @item Errors:
27918
27919 @table @code
27920 @item EBADF
27921 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
27922
27923 @item ESPIPE
27924 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
27925
27926 @item EINVAL
27927 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
27928
27929 @item EINTR
27930 The call was interrupted by the user.
27931 @end table
27932
27933 @end table
27934
27935 @node rename
27936 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
27937 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
27938
27939 @table @asis
27940 @item Synopsis:
27941 @smallexample
27942 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
27943 @end smallexample
27944
27945 @item Request:
27946 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
27947
27948 @item Return value:
27949 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
27950
27951 @item Errors:
27952
27953 @table @code
27954 @item EISDIR
27955 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
27956 directory.
27957
27958 @item EEXIST
27959 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
27960
27961 @item EBUSY
27962 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
27963 process.
27964
27965 @item EINVAL
27966 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
27967 of itself.
27968
27969 @item ENOTDIR
27970 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
27971 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
27972 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
27973
27974 @item EFAULT
27975 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
27976
27977 @item EACCES
27978 No access to the file or the path of the file.
27979
27980 @item ENAMETOOLONG
27981
27982 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
27983
27984 @item ENOENT
27985 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
27986
27987 @item EROFS
27988 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
27989
27990 @item ENOSPC
27991 The device containing the file has no room for the new
27992 directory entry.
27993
27994 @item EINTR
27995 The call was interrupted by the user.
27996 @end table
27997
27998 @end table
27999
28000 @node unlink
28001 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
28002 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
28003
28004 @table @asis
28005 @item Synopsis:
28006 @smallexample
28007 int unlink(const char *pathname);
28008 @end smallexample
28009
28010 @item Request:
28011 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
28012
28013 @item Return value:
28014 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28015
28016 @item Errors:
28017
28018 @table @code
28019 @item EACCES
28020 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28021
28022 @item EPERM
28023 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
28024
28025 @item EBUSY
28026 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
28027 being used by another process.
28028
28029 @item EFAULT
28030 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28031
28032 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28033 @var{pathname} was too long.
28034
28035 @item ENOENT
28036 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
28037
28038 @item ENOTDIR
28039 A component of the path is not a directory.
28040
28041 @item EROFS
28042 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
28043
28044 @item EINTR
28045 The call was interrupted by the user.
28046 @end table
28047
28048 @end table
28049
28050 @node stat/fstat
28051 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
28052 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
28053 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
28054
28055 @table @asis
28056 @item Synopsis:
28057 @smallexample
28058 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
28059 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
28060 @end smallexample
28061
28062 @item Request:
28063 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
28064 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
28065
28066 @item Return value:
28067 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28068
28069 @item Errors:
28070
28071 @table @code
28072 @item EBADF
28073 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
28074
28075 @item ENOENT
28076 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
28077 path is an empty string.
28078
28079 @item ENOTDIR
28080 A component of the path is not a directory.
28081
28082 @item EFAULT
28083 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28084
28085 @item EACCES
28086 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28087
28088 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28089 @var{pathname} was too long.
28090
28091 @item EINTR
28092 The call was interrupted by the user.
28093 @end table
28094
28095 @end table
28096
28097 @node gettimeofday
28098 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
28099 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
28100
28101 @table @asis
28102 @item Synopsis:
28103 @smallexample
28104 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
28105 @end smallexample
28106
28107 @item Request:
28108 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
28109
28110 @item Return value:
28111 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
28112
28113 @item Errors:
28114
28115 @table @code
28116 @item EINVAL
28117 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
28118
28119 @item EFAULT
28120 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28121 @end table
28122
28123 @end table
28124
28125 @node isatty
28126 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
28127 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
28128
28129 @table @asis
28130 @item Synopsis:
28131 @smallexample
28132 int isatty(int fd);
28133 @end smallexample
28134
28135 @item Request:
28136 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
28137
28138 @item Return value:
28139 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
28140
28141 @item Errors:
28142
28143 @table @code
28144 @item EINTR
28145 The call was interrupted by the user.
28146 @end table
28147
28148 @end table
28149
28150 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
28151 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
28152 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
28153 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
28154 needed.
28155
28156
28157 @node system
28158 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
28159 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
28160
28161 @table @asis
28162 @item Synopsis:
28163 @smallexample
28164 int system(const char *command);
28165 @end smallexample
28166
28167 @item Request:
28168 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
28169
28170 @item Return value:
28171 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
28172 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
28173 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
28174 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
28175 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
28176 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
28177 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
28178
28179 @item Errors:
28180
28181 @table @code
28182 @item EINTR
28183 The call was interrupted by the user.
28184 @end table
28185
28186 @end table
28187
28188 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
28189 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
28190 the host is simplified before it's returned
28191 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
28192 is discarded, and the return value consists
28193 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
28194
28195 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
28196 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
28197 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
28198
28199 @table @code
28200 @item set remote system-call-allowed
28201 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
28202 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
28203 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
28204
28205 @item show remote system-call-allowed
28206 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
28207 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
28208 protocol.
28209 @end table
28210
28211 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
28212 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
28213 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
28214
28215 @menu
28216 * Integral Datatypes::
28217 * Pointer Values::
28218 * Memory Transfer::
28219 * struct stat::
28220 * struct timeval::
28221 @end menu
28222
28223 @node Integral Datatypes
28224 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
28225 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
28226
28227 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
28228 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
28229 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
28230
28231 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
28232 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
28233
28234 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
28235
28236 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
28237 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
28238
28239 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
28240
28241 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
28242 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
28243 byte order.
28244
28245 @node Pointer Values
28246 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
28247 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
28248
28249 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
28250 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
28251 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
28252 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
28253
28254 @smallexample
28255 @code{1aaf/12}
28256 @end smallexample
28257
28258 @noindent
28259 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
28260 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
28261 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
28262 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
28263
28264 @smallexample
28265 @code{123456/d}
28266 @end smallexample
28267
28268 @node Memory Transfer
28269 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
28270 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
28271
28272 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
28273 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
28274 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
28275 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
28276 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
28277 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
28278 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
28279
28280
28281 @node struct stat
28282 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
28283 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
28284
28285 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
28286 is defined as follows:
28287
28288 @smallexample
28289 struct stat @{
28290 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
28291 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
28292 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
28293 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
28294 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
28295 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
28296 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
28297 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
28298 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
28299 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
28300 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
28301 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
28302 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
28303 @};
28304 @end smallexample
28305
28306 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
28307 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
28308 structure is of size 64 bytes.
28309
28310 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
28311 range of values.
28312
28313 @table @code
28314
28315 @item st_dev
28316 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
28317
28318 @item st_ino
28319 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
28320
28321 @item st_mode
28322 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
28323 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
28324
28325 @item st_uid
28326 @itemx st_gid
28327 @itemx st_rdev
28328 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
28329
28330 @item st_atime
28331 @itemx st_mtime
28332 @itemx st_ctime
28333 These values have a host and file system dependent
28334 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
28335 support exact timing values.
28336 @end table
28337
28338 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
28339 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
28340 continuing.
28341
28342 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
28343 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
28344 get truncated on the target.
28345
28346 @node struct timeval
28347 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
28348 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
28349
28350 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
28351 is defined as follows:
28352
28353 @smallexample
28354 struct timeval @{
28355 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
28356 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
28357 @};
28358 @end smallexample
28359
28360 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
28361 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
28362 structure is of size 8 bytes.
28363
28364 @node Constants
28365 @subsection Constants
28366 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
28367
28368 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
28369 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
28370 values before and after the call as needed.
28371
28372 @menu
28373 * Open Flags::
28374 * mode_t Values::
28375 * Errno Values::
28376 * Lseek Flags::
28377 * Limits::
28378 @end menu
28379
28380 @node Open Flags
28381 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
28382 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
28383
28384 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
28385
28386 @smallexample
28387 O_RDONLY 0x0
28388 O_WRONLY 0x1
28389 O_RDWR 0x2
28390 O_APPEND 0x8
28391 O_CREAT 0x200
28392 O_TRUNC 0x400
28393 O_EXCL 0x800
28394 @end smallexample
28395
28396 @node mode_t Values
28397 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
28398 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
28399
28400 All values are given in octal representation.
28401
28402 @smallexample
28403 S_IFREG 0100000
28404 S_IFDIR 040000
28405 S_IRUSR 0400
28406 S_IWUSR 0200
28407 S_IXUSR 0100
28408 S_IRGRP 040
28409 S_IWGRP 020
28410 S_IXGRP 010
28411 S_IROTH 04
28412 S_IWOTH 02
28413 S_IXOTH 01
28414 @end smallexample
28415
28416 @node Errno Values
28417 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
28418 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
28419
28420 All values are given in decimal representation.
28421
28422 @smallexample
28423 EPERM 1
28424 ENOENT 2
28425 EINTR 4
28426 EBADF 9
28427 EACCES 13
28428 EFAULT 14
28429 EBUSY 16
28430 EEXIST 17
28431 ENODEV 19
28432 ENOTDIR 20
28433 EISDIR 21
28434 EINVAL 22
28435 ENFILE 23
28436 EMFILE 24
28437 EFBIG 27
28438 ENOSPC 28
28439 ESPIPE 29
28440 EROFS 30
28441 ENAMETOOLONG 91
28442 EUNKNOWN 9999
28443 @end smallexample
28444
28445 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
28446 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
28447
28448 @node Lseek Flags
28449 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
28450 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
28451
28452 @smallexample
28453 SEEK_SET 0
28454 SEEK_CUR 1
28455 SEEK_END 2
28456 @end smallexample
28457
28458 @node Limits
28459 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
28460 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
28461
28462 All values are given in decimal representation.
28463
28464 @smallexample
28465 INT_MIN -2147483648
28466 INT_MAX 2147483647
28467 UINT_MAX 4294967295
28468 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
28469 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
28470 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
28471 @end smallexample
28472
28473 @node File-I/O Examples
28474 @subsection File-I/O Examples
28475 @cindex file-i/o examples
28476
28477 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
28478 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
28479
28480 @smallexample
28481 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
28482 @emph{request memory read from target}
28483 -> @code{m1234,6}
28484 <- XXXXXX
28485 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
28486 -> @code{F6}
28487 @end smallexample
28488
28489 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
28490 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
28491
28492 @smallexample
28493 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
28494 @emph{request memory write to target}
28495 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
28496 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
28497 -> @code{F6}
28498 @end smallexample
28499
28500 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
28501 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
28502
28503 @smallexample
28504 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
28505 -> @code{F-1,9}
28506 @end smallexample
28507
28508 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
28509 host is called:
28510
28511 @smallexample
28512 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
28513 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
28514 <- @code{T02}
28515 @end smallexample
28516
28517 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
28518 host is called:
28519
28520 @smallexample
28521 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
28522 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
28523 <- @code{T02}
28524 @end smallexample
28525
28526 @node Library List Format
28527 @section Library List Format
28528 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
28529
28530 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
28531 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
28532 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
28533 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
28534 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
28535 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
28536 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
28537 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
28538 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
28539 are loaded.
28540
28541 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
28542 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
28543 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
28544 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
28545
28546 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
28547 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
28548 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
28549 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
28550 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
28551 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
28552
28553 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
28554 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
28555
28556 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
28557 offset, looks like this:
28558
28559 @smallexample
28560 <library-list>
28561 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
28562 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
28563 </library>
28564 </library-list>
28565 @end smallexample
28566
28567 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
28568 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
28569
28570 @smallexample
28571 <library-list>
28572 <library name="sharedlib.o">
28573 <section address="0x10000000"/>
28574 <section address="0x20000000"/>
28575 <section address="0x30000000"/>
28576 </library>
28577 </library-list>
28578 @end smallexample
28579
28580 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
28581
28582 @smallexample
28583 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
28584 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
28585 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
28586 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
28587 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
28588 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
28589 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
28590 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
28591 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
28592 @end smallexample
28593
28594 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
28595 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
28596 section for each library.
28597
28598 @node Memory Map Format
28599 @section Memory Map Format
28600 @cindex memory map format
28601
28602 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
28603 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
28604 memory map.
28605
28606 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
28607 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
28608 lists memory regions.
28609
28610 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
28611 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
28612
28613 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
28614
28615 @smallexample
28616 <?xml version="1.0"?>
28617 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
28618 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
28619 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
28620 <memory-map>
28621 region...
28622 </memory-map>
28623 @end smallexample
28624
28625 Each region can be either:
28626
28627 @itemize
28628
28629 @item
28630 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
28631 bytes from there:
28632
28633 @smallexample
28634 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
28635 @end smallexample
28636
28637
28638 @item
28639 A region of read-only memory:
28640
28641 @smallexample
28642 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
28643 @end smallexample
28644
28645
28646 @item
28647 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
28648 bytes in length:
28649
28650 @smallexample
28651 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
28652 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
28653 </memory>
28654 @end smallexample
28655
28656 @end itemize
28657
28658 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
28659 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
28660 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
28661
28662 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
28663
28664 @smallexample
28665 <!-- ................................................... -->
28666 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
28667 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
28668 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
28669 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
28670 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
28671 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
28672 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
28673 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
28674 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
28675 and its type, or device. -->
28676 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
28677 start CDATA #REQUIRED
28678 length CDATA #REQUIRED
28679 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
28680 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
28681 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
28682 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
28683 @end smallexample
28684
28685 @include agentexpr.texi
28686
28687 @node Target Descriptions
28688 @appendix Target Descriptions
28689 @cindex target descriptions
28690
28691 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
28692 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
28693 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
28694
28695 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
28696 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
28697 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
28698 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
28699 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
28700 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
28701 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
28702
28703 @itemize @bullet
28704 @item
28705 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
28706 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
28707 @item
28708 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
28709 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
28710 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
28711 @item
28712 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
28713 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
28714 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
28715 @end itemize
28716
28717 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
28718 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
28719 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
28720 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
28721 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
28722
28723 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
28724 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
28725
28726 @menu
28727 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
28728 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
28729 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
28730 descriptions.
28731 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
28732 @end menu
28733
28734 @node Retrieving Descriptions
28735 @section Retrieving Descriptions
28736
28737 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
28738 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
28739 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
28740 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
28741 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
28742 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
28743 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
28744 Format}.
28745
28746 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
28747 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
28748 specify a file are:
28749
28750 @table @code
28751 @cindex set tdesc filename
28752 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
28753 Read the target description from @var{path}.
28754
28755 @cindex unset tdesc filename
28756 @item unset tdesc filename
28757 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
28758 will use the description supplied by the current target.
28759
28760 @cindex show tdesc filename
28761 @item show tdesc filename
28762 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
28763 @end table
28764
28765
28766 @node Target Description Format
28767 @section Target Description Format
28768 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
28769
28770 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
28771 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
28772 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
28773 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
28774 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
28775 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
28776 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
28777
28778 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
28779 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
28780 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
28781 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
28782
28783 Here is a simple target description:
28784
28785 @smallexample
28786 <target version="1.0">
28787 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
28788 </target>
28789 @end smallexample
28790
28791 @noindent
28792 This minimal description only says that the target uses
28793 the x86-64 architecture.
28794
28795 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
28796 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
28797 are explained further below.
28798
28799 @smallexample
28800 <?xml version="1.0"?>
28801 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
28802 <target version="1.0">
28803 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
28804 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
28805 </target>
28806 @end smallexample
28807
28808 @noindent
28809 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
28810 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
28811 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
28812 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
28813 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
28814 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
28815 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
28816 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
28817 the version mismatch.
28818
28819 @subsection Inclusion
28820 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
28821 @cindex XInclude
28822 @ifnotinfo
28823 @cindex <xi:include>
28824 @end ifnotinfo
28825
28826 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
28827 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
28828 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
28829 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
28830 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
28831
28832 @smallexample
28833 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
28834 @end smallexample
28835
28836 @noindent
28837 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
28838 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
28839 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
28840 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
28841 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
28842 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
28843 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
28844 original description.
28845
28846 @subsection Architecture
28847 @cindex <architecture>
28848
28849 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
28850
28851 @smallexample
28852 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
28853 @end smallexample
28854
28855 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
28856 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
28857 Debugging Target}).
28858
28859 @subsection Features
28860 @cindex <feature>
28861
28862 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
28863 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
28864 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
28865 has this form:
28866
28867 @smallexample
28868 <feature name="@var{name}">
28869 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
28870 @var{reg}@dots{}
28871 </feature>
28872 @end smallexample
28873
28874 @noindent
28875 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
28876 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
28877 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
28878 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
28879
28880 @subsection Types
28881
28882 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
28883 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
28884 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
28885 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
28886 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
28887
28888 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
28889 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
28890 Types must be defined before they are used.
28891
28892 @cindex <vector>
28893 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
28894 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
28895 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
28896 @var{count}:
28897
28898 @smallexample
28899 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
28900 @end smallexample
28901
28902 @cindex <union>
28903 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
28904 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
28905 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
28906 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
28907
28908 @smallexample
28909 <union id="@var{id}">
28910 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
28911 @dots{}
28912 </union>
28913 @end smallexample
28914
28915 @subsection Registers
28916 @cindex <reg>
28917
28918 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
28919
28920 @smallexample
28921 <reg name="@var{name}"
28922 bitsize="@var{size}"
28923 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
28924 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
28925 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
28926 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
28927 @end smallexample
28928
28929 @noindent
28930 The components are as follows:
28931
28932 @table @var
28933
28934 @item name
28935 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
28936
28937 @item bitsize
28938 The register's size, in bits.
28939
28940 @item regnum
28941 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
28942 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
28943 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
28944 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
28945 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
28946 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
28947 in order of increasing register number.
28948
28949 @item save-restore
28950 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
28951 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
28952 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
28953 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
28954 ABI.
28955
28956 @item type
28957 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
28958 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
28959 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
28960 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
28961 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
28962 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
28963
28964 @item group
28965 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
28966 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
28967 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
28968 in @code{info registers}.
28969
28970 @end table
28971
28972 @node Predefined Target Types
28973 @section Predefined Target Types
28974 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
28975
28976 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
28977 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
28978 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
28979 types. The currently supported types are:
28980
28981 @table @code
28982
28983 @item int8
28984 @itemx int16
28985 @itemx int32
28986 @itemx int64
28987 @itemx int128
28988 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
28989
28990 @item uint8
28991 @itemx uint16
28992 @itemx uint32
28993 @itemx uint64
28994 @itemx uint128
28995 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
28996
28997 @item code_ptr
28998 @itemx data_ptr
28999 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
29000 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
29001 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
29002 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
29003 may be marked as data pointers.
29004
29005 @item ieee_single
29006 Single precision IEEE floating point.
29007
29008 @item ieee_double
29009 Double precision IEEE floating point.
29010
29011 @item arm_fpa_ext
29012 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
29013
29014 @end table
29015
29016 @node Standard Target Features
29017 @section Standard Target Features
29018 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
29019
29020 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
29021 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
29022 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
29023 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
29024 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
29025 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
29026 can recognize them.
29027
29028 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
29029 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
29030 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
29031 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
29032 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
29033 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
29034 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
29035 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
29036
29037 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
29038 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
29039 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
29040
29041 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
29042 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
29043 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
29044 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
29045
29046 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
29047 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
29048 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
29049
29050 @menu
29051 * ARM Features::
29052 * MIPS Features::
29053 * M68K Features::
29054 * PowerPC Features::
29055 @end menu
29056
29057
29058 @node ARM Features
29059 @subsection ARM Features
29060 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
29061
29062 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
29063 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
29064 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
29065
29066 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
29067 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
29068
29069 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
29070 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
29071 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
29072 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
29073
29074 @node MIPS Features
29075 @subsection MIPS Features
29076 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
29077
29078 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
29079 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
29080 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
29081 on the target.
29082
29083 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
29084 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
29085 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29086
29087 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
29088 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
29089 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
29090 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29091
29092 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
29093 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
29094 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
29095
29096 @node M68K Features
29097 @subsection M68K Features
29098 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
29099
29100 @table @code
29101 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
29102 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
29103 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
29104 One of those features must be always present.
29105 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
29106 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
29107 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
29108 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
29109
29110 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
29111 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
29112 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
29113 @samp{fpiaddr}.
29114 @end table
29115
29116 @node PowerPC Features
29117 @subsection PowerPC Features
29118 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
29119
29120 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
29121 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
29122 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
29123 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29124
29125 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
29126 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
29127
29128 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
29129 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
29130 and @samp{vrsave}.
29131
29132 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
29133 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
29134 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
29135 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
29136 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
29137 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
29138
29139 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
29140 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
29141 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
29142 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
29143 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
29144 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
29145 user.
29146
29147 @node Operating System Information
29148 @appendix Operating System Information
29149 @cindex operating system information
29150
29151 @menu
29152 * Process list::
29153 @end menu
29154
29155 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
29156 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
29157 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
29158 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
29159 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
29160 on a different aspect of target.
29161
29162 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
29163 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
29164 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
29165 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
29166
29167 @node Process list
29168 @appendixsection Process list
29169 @cindex operating system information, process list
29170
29171 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
29172 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
29173 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
29174 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
29175
29176 An example document is:
29177
29178 @smallexample
29179 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29180 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
29181 <osdata type="processes">
29182 <item>
29183 <column name="pid">1</column>
29184 <column name="user">root</column>
29185 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
29186 </item>
29187 </osdata>
29188 @end smallexample
29189
29190 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
29191 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
29192 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
29193 displayed by @value{GDBN}. Target may provide additional columns,
29194 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
29195
29196 @include gpl.texi
29197
29198 @raisesections
29199 @include fdl.texi
29200 @lowersections
29201
29202 @node Index
29203 @unnumbered Index
29204
29205 @printindex cp
29206
29207 @tex
29208 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
29209 % meantime:
29210 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
29211 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
29212 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
29213 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
29214 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
29215 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
29216 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
29217 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
29218 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
29219 \page\colophon
29220 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
29221 @end tex
29222
29223 @bye
This page took 0.683523 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.